Dental Mastery Board
Dental Mastery Board
Dental Mastery Board
com/418907227/combo-with-dental-board-mastery-review-questions-and-10-
others-flash-cards/
The functional psychiatric disorder most commonly seen in elderly patients is which of the
following?
1) Older people that seldom experience good social interactions are more prone to develop
antisocial personality disorder or ASPD.
During an initial exam appointment, the dentist should first...
B. Establish rapport
D. Gather informationB. Establish rapport
A. Euphoria
D. Tingling D. Tingling
1) Extremities and lips may experience tingling sensation as the nitrous oxide gas starts to take
effect.
To put the patient at east and increase the general comfort of the patient while at the dentist. The
dentist should....
1) inhibiting pain signals from reaching the brain by blocking the nociceptive pathways help to
reduce pain
2) raise the pain threshold using medications like analgesics and sedatives
3) Psychosomatic hypnosis helps condition the mind and body of a patient to handle painful
stimuli better
4 minutes following the administration of an inferior alveolar nerve block. The patient develops
paralysis of their forehead muscles, eyelids, and upper and lower lips o nthe same side of their
face as the injection. These clinical signs are most associated with the flowing of the anesthetic
into which of the following structures.
1) Deposition of anesthesia near the parotid gland caused a block of the facial nerve which
resulted to the drooping of the face, paralysis of the forehead muscles and eyelid paralysis.
Which of the following is typically prescribed to treat anxiety?
A. Haloperidol
B. Lorazepam
C. Methohexital
D. Zaleplon
E. PentazocineB. Lorazepam
1) Benzodiazepine effects:
a. anxiolysis
b. anterograde amnesia
c. sedation/hypnosis
d. anticonvulsion
e. antiemesis
f. muscle relaxation
Disabled and Medically Compromised Disabled and Medically Compromised Answers
Which of the following antibiotic regimens is indicated for a 20-kg pediatric patient with a
congenital heart defect requiring prophylaxis according to American Heart Association
standards?
A. 1 g oral amoxicillin 1 hour prior to dental treatment and 500mg 4x per day for 2 days
following the procedure
B. 1 g oral amoxicillin 1 hour prior to dental treatment and 500mg 6 hours after the procedure is
the antibiotic regimen recommended for a 20-kg B. 1 g oral amoxicillin 1 hour prior to dental
treatment and 500mg 6 hours after the procedure is the antibiotic regimen recommended for a
20-kg
Hospitalization is the MOST RECOMMENDED option to treat which of the following patients?
B. A patient being treated with anticoagulants with a prothrombin time of 3.5x the control time
requiring a single tooth extraction
D. A severe developmentally disable patient requiring a full mouth gingivectomy to treat
medication induced gingival hyperplasia D. A severe developmentally disable patient
requiring a full mouth gingivectomy to treat medication induced gingival hyperplasia
A. Myopia
B. Narrow angle glaucoma
C. Presbyopia
D. Wide angle glaucoma
E. Cataract removal E. Cataract removal
B. Prevalence
D. Incidence B. Prevalence
Prevention of Oral Disease Prevention of Oral Disease Answers
Addition to tobacco products is caused by which of the following agents?
D. Nicotine D. Nicotine
1) Nicotine
a. induces body to release epinephrine from the adrenal glands
b. stimulate the body thereby increasing heart rate, respiration, and blood pressure
To prove clinical effectiveness for American Dental Association (ADA) approval, an
antimicrobial agent must demonstrate.....
1) Oral microflora of younger people is usually more cariogenic than older ones due to the
inclusion of sweets in their daily diet. Older people tend to eat less sweets in their diet making
them less prone to caries.
Evaluation of Dental Literature Evaluation of Dental Literature Answers
Which database contains current electronic dental literature?
A. Dental Absracts
B. index to Dental Literature
C. LEXIS-Nexus
D. Pubmed-MEDLINE D. Pubmed-MEDLINE
1) Pubmed-MEDLINE
a. US National Library of Medcine's (NLM) bibliographic database
2) LEXIS-Nexis
a. legal and public records related information
A clinician correctly classifies a group of patient as being free of disease based on a diagnostic
test results. These results demonstrate high...
A. Generality
B. Precision
C. Repeatability
D. Sensitivity
E. Specificity E. Specificity
2) Sensitivity = show the group of patients which are suffering from a particular disease
Each of the following are advantages to investigating the biocompatibility of a biomaterial using
in vitro testing EXCEPT one. Which is the EXCEPTION?
B. Extent
C. Incidence
E. Prevalence C. Incidence
Which type of failure would describe the situation where a diagnostic test failed to identify
several cases of true disease?
A. False positive
B. True negative
C. True positive
D. False negative D. False negative
1) True Positive: those who test positive for a condition and are positive (have the condition)
2) False Positive: those who test positive for a condition but are false (do not have the condition).
Test indicates presence of the disease when it is absent
4) False Negative: those who test negative but are positive. The test indicates absence of the
disease when it is present.
Infection Control Infection Control Answers
Which of the following intervals does the United States Centers for Disease Control (CDC)
recommend sterilizing units be monitored and tested? weekly
Which of the following types of gloves should be utilized to provide the BEST protection during
the cleaning dental operators?
B. Latex
C. Utility
D. Vinyl C. Utility
OSHA regulates the transport of waste from a dental office. Statement I is a true statement and
Statement II is false.
Which of the following does Occupational Safety and Health Agency (OSHA) "Blood Borne
Pathogens Standard: not regulate?
A. a face mask
B. an apron
C. safety goggles
D. Utility gloves C. safety goggles
1) Wearing safety goggles would be the most effective way to prevent physical injury to a dentist
The Occupational Safety and Health Agency (OSHA) regulates each of the following through
the blood borne pathogen standard EXCEPT one. Which is the EXCEPTION?
A. Depressurization
B. Pressure
C. Retraction
D. Anti-Retraction D. Anti-Retraction
1) Anti-retraction valves
a. prevent retraction of fluid from a patient into the hand piece and water spray hoses.
b. create one way flow of liquids which prevent bodily fluids like saliva from being retracted
from the patient into the hand piece and water hose.
Professional Responsibility/Liability Professional Responsibility/Liability Answers
The ability of the patient to independently choose a treatment option (including no treatment)
represents the ethical concept of Autonomy
1) Autonomy
a. informed consent
b. treated in a manner that fits their personal principles, religion, or beliefs
Which of the following ethical principles requires clinicians to inform their patients about
treatment risks and benefits and to protect their confidentiality? Autonomy
A. Open panel
B. Closed panel
C. Group practice
D. Solo practice A. Open panel
B. Closed panel
2) Prepayment plan
a. group of dentists sharing office facilities that provide stipulated services at a set premium to an
eligible group of patients
When a dentist thinks they know what is best for the patient and tries to control a patients
behavior, it is referred to as...
A. Autonomy
B. Benevolence
C. Competence
D. Justice
E. Paternalism
F. Nonmaleficence E. Paternalism
1) Paternalism
a. is displayed when we decide to follow what we think is best for out patient regardless of the
choice of treatment that the patient has made for themselves, thereby infringing on the patient's
right to autonomy.
American Dental Association (ADA) officially recognizes which of the following as a dental
specialty?
1) dental specialization which focuses on epidemiology, analysis of social health policies, and
the dental needs of the general population
How many years should the dental records of an employee who just terminated their employment
in your office be kept?
A. 10 years
B. 20 years
C. 30 years
D. 5 years
E. 1 year C. 30 years
1) Dentists use suction to remove mercury vapor coming from the removal of amalgam. Cutting
of amalgam without water spray should be avoided.
Healthcare professionals who provide emergency treatment at the scene of an accidents are
legally protected by which of the following laws?
1) Attached gingiva
a. function is to keep the free gingiva in close contact with the tooth while also protecting the
soft and free moving alveolar mucosa
b. insufficient attached gingiva makes the mucosa more prone to trauma during function and
compromises the periodontal support of teeth
c. width of the attached gingiva must be preserved
Each of the following characterizes the experimental gingivitis model EXCEPT one. Which is
the EXCEPTION?
A. Gingival abscess
B. Lateral periodontal cyst
C. Osteogenic sarcoma
D. Periodontal abscess
E. External root resorption B. Lateral periodontal cyst
1) Periodontal treatments through nonsurgical and surgical root debridement become more
successful when administered with systemic antibiotics.
2) Aggressive periodontitis is a rapidly progressing disease that can be better managed with
complete root debridement and antibiotic therapy.
3) Systemic antibiotics ensure that the antibiotic molecule reaches the site as compared with
local application.
4) Local antibiotics are not effective since it may not reach the deep pockets of the periodontal
disease
Which of the following does a 2-day-old plaque biofilm consist primarily of?
A. Bacteroides species
B. Filamentous organisms
C. Gram-positive cocci and rods
D. Treponema species
E. A non-mineralized pellicle without organization C. Gram-positive cocci and rods
1) During the initial formation of an undisturbed plaque, majority of bacteria present are gram
positive cocci and rods like streptococcus and actinomyces species.
2) Within the 2 day period of undisturbed plaque format, the gram positive cocci and rods cling
to each other and increase in number
3) Approximately 25% of other bacterial species may include gram negative rods and coci which
eventually will increase as plaque remains undisturbed.
A. Root resorption
B. Root sensitivity
C. Root surface remineralization
D. Epithelial attachment levelC. Root surface remineralization
1) Cleaning root surface on a daily basis with fluoride identifies may result in root surface
remineralization.
2) Consistent plaque removal prevents root demineralization by bacteria and enables the root
surface to remineralize.
3) Presence of minerals in saliva and fluoride from toothpaste also aid in the remineralization of
root surfaces
Each of the following devices are effective in removing surface plaque EXCEPT one. Which one
is the EXCEPTION?
1) The use or oral irrigation devices like Water-Pik helps remove plaque in shallow periodontal
pockets
2) Irrigation devices propel a pulsating, high pressure steam of water to flush sub gingival plaque
and debris out of shallow pockets.
3) They are ineffective if the periodontal pocket is too deep to be reached by toothbrush bristles
or a toothpick.
4) Dental floss is the most recommended oral hygiene method for proximal plaque removal, but
not capable of reaching deep into a pocket.
True/False: New junctional epithelium can form on either cementum or dentin after periodontal
surgery
Junctional epithelium is re-established as early as one week. Both are true statements
1) Junctional epithelium re-attached back to cementum and dentin after an apically repositioned
flap by re-establishing tight junctions
3) Regeneration of junctional epithelium may occur even after its surgical detachment as along
as the root surface is completely derided of plaque and calcular deposits.
Diagnosis Diagnosis Answers
Which of the following distinguishes periodontitis from gingivitis?
1) Gingivitis
a. inflammation of the gingiva
2) Periodontitis
a. inflammation of the gingiva associated with attachment loss
A patient has a 5mm probing depth on the medial of their maxillary first molar. 2mm of
recession was also charted in that area. Which of the following describes the attachment loss in
that area?
B. 3mm
E. 7mm E. 7mm
1) CAL = PD - (FGM-CEJ)
= 5 - (-2)
= 7mm
A. Attached gingiva
B. Gingival col
C. Marginal gingiva
D. Outer gingival epithelium B. Gingival col
1) Gingival tissue
a. 75% parakeratinized epithelium
b. 15% keratinized epithelium
c. 10% nonkeratinized epithelium
2) Keratinized epithelium
a. attached gingiva
b. some portions of the outer gingival epithelium
3) Parakeratinized gingiva
a. marginal gingiva
b. portions of the outer gingival epithelium
4) Nonkeratinized gingiva
a. gingiva col
b. junctional epithelium
c. sulcular epithelium
Which of the following describes how the width of keratinized gingiva is measured. It is the
distance from the ...
2) Attached gingiva
a. free gingival groove to the mucogingival junction
A. Diet
B. Drugs
C. Fluoride ingestion
D. Poor oral hygiene
E. Trauma D. Poor oral hygiene
1) Prolonged poor oral hygiene allows the organic compounds from the food or drinks we ingest
to adhere to tooth pellicle. Once these colored compounds are oxidized, they remain as tooth
stains.
2) Organic compounds that adhere to tooth surfaces through oxidation are known as chromogens.
Stains can only be removed through professional dental prophylaxis.
3) Tetracycline stains are permanent bands of brown and gray NOT orange and green.
4) Dental trauma cause pulp necrosis and create a dull darkly colored tooth.
Each of the following is a clinical sign of gingivitis EXCEPT one. Which one is the
EXCEPTION?
A. Bleeding on probing
B. Erythema
C. Gingival stippling
D. Swollen tissues A. Bleeding on probing
1) Bleeding
a. probing erythematous inflamed tissue typically results in bleeding
2) Stippling
a. numerous small depressions in the surface of healthy gum tissue
3) Gingivitis causes
a. edema, which creates a loss of stippling
b. erythema
Which of the following is NOT an indication for posterior maxillary osteotoy?
A. Dehiscence
B. Interental crater defect
C. Trough
D. Hemiseptum A. Dehiscence
1) Infrabony defect
a. bone level is apical to the base of the periodontal pocket
2) Root dehiscence
a. bone defect where the root surface is covered only with soft tissue after bone destruction
occurred on the facial or the lingual aspect of the tooth
3) Interdental crater
a. bone defect where a concavity is found in the crystal bone
4) Trough
a. bone defects where a crater is formed on the proximal surfaces of the tooth
5) Hemiseptum
a. vertical or angler bone defects where one surface of the tooth root has bone support remaining
Which of the following is the MOST COMMON sign of occlusal trauma?
A. Abrasion
B. Attrition
C. Migration
D. Mobility
E. Tipping D. Mobility
1) Mobility
a. describes the amount a tooth moves when pressure is applied to it
b. fremitus describes tooth mobility when under function
c. another sign of occlusal trauma is a widened periodontal ligament
Sinus tract are MOST COMMONLY found in the gingiva of children because of which of the
following reasons?
1) Sinus tracts
a. commonly found due to the development of chronic periodical abscesses in the gingival of
children.
b. Dental abscesses can also be associated with trauma.
2) Acute periodical abscess are not abscessed long enough to create a sinus tract
3) Lateral periodontal cysts and periapical cysts DO NOT contain a tract, but are an epithelial
lined pocket.
4) Periodontal abscesses have room to expand into the gingiva, but do NOT commonly result in
a sinus tract.
Which of the following types of gingival periodontal disease is most prevalent in high school
aged children?
1) Adolescence induce a series of metabolic and hormonal changes that may affect periodontal
tissues.
2) Hormonal changes can affect the capillary permeability and thereby increase the fluid
accumulation in the gingiva.
3) Adolescents demonstrate a tendency to largely disregard good oral hygiene practices.
Which of the following is necessary to determine the exact form of an osseous defect?
A. Examining the gingival architecture in detail
B. Expose the area surgically
C. Make multiple radiographs from different angulations
D. Measure pocket depths from the cemento-enamel junction
E. Measure pocket depths from the free gingival margin B. Expose the area surgically
1) Surgically exposing an intrabony defect allows the examiner a complete access to evaluate all
the dimensions of an osseous defect directly.
2) Gingival architecture may appear normal radiographically despite the presence or a large
intrabony defect due to the nature of a radiograph being a 2-dimensional representation of a 3-
dimensional object.
Which of the following periodontal diagnoses is MOST COMMON in adults?
2) Treatment
a. debridement of the affected gingiva
b. chlorhexidine 0.12%
Miller Classification
1) Class I
a. Recession does NOT extend to the mucogingival junction
2) Class II
a. Recession that extends to or beyond the mucogingival junction, but demonstrates NO loss of
inter proximal clinical attachment
3) Class III
a. Recession that extends to or beyond the mucogingival junction, with either loss of inter
proximal clinical attachment or tooth rotation
4) Class IV
a. Recession that extends to or beyond the mucogingival junction, with either loss of inter
proximal clinical attachment or tooth rotation that is severe
Which of the following are the classic signs of bruxism. Select all that apply.
A. Muscle soreness
B. Occlusal wear
C. Thickened lamina dura
D. Tooth mobility
E. Wear facets A. Muscle soreness
B. Occlusal wear
C. Thickened lamina dura
D. Tooth mobility
E. Wear facets
1) Bruxism
a. repetitive behavior of grinding of clenching or a person's teeth
b. induced by
1) stress
2) masseter tension
3) premature occlusion
4) medications
Etiology Etiology Answers
Each of the following is associated with acute herpetic gingivostomatitis EXCEPT one. Which is
the EXCEPTION?
A. Actinomyces viscosus
B. Aggregatibacter Actinomycetemcomitans
C. Bacteroids forsythus
D. Porphyromonas gingivalis
E. Treponema denticola E. Treponema denticola
2) Aggregatibacter Actinomycetemcomitans
a. localized aggressive periodontitis
3) Porphyromonas gingivalis
a. chronic periodontitis
4) Actinomyces viscosus
a. healthy gingiva
5) Bacteroids forsythus
a. chronic periodontitis
Which cell is least associated with the chronic periodontitis?
3) B lymphocytes become activated and mature into plasma cells which produce antibodies
C. Occlusal trauma
D. Toothbrush abrasion D. Toothbrush abrasion
C. Leukemia
D. Medication
E. Puberty D. Medication
1) Plaque formation
a. within the 2 day period of undisturbed plaque formation, the gram positive cocci and rods
cling to each other and increase in number
2) S. Sanguinis
a. first bacterial species to adhere to tooth structure
Which of the following bacterial species is the most associated with localized aggressive
periodontitis?
C. Streptococcus mutans
D. Treponema denticola
E. Aggregatibacter Actinomycetemcomitans E. Aggregatibacter Actinomycetemcomitans
3) Streptococcus mutans is the most common oral bacteria and is highly associated with caries
4) Lactobacillus casei is commonly founding the intestines and oral cavity and produces acid
critical in enamel demineralization.
If a patient has not brushed for 2 days, the most common bacterial species found in the plaque
is...
A. Aggrigatibacter
B. Gram negative rods
C. Gram positive rods and cocci
D. Spirochetes
E. Fusobacterium C. Gram positive rods and cocci
1) As plaque matures, more gram positive rods and cocci popular the teeth creating gingival
irritation and gingivitis.
2) When tartar or calculus deposits --> gram negative bacteria increase in number
Which of the following medications may cause gingival overgrowth?
A. Carbamazipine
B. Hydrochlorothiazide
C. Phenytoin
D. Venlafaxine
E. Valproic acid C. Phenytoin
1) Phenytoin
a. antiepileptic agent that may induce gingival hypertrophy, increased hair growth, and coarse
facial features
b. used to treat trigeminal neuralgia if carbamazipine is contraindicated
2) Valproic acid
a. anticonvulsant
b. mood-stabilizing drug
c. major depression
3) Venlafaxine (Effexor)
a. serotonin-norepinephrine reuptake inhibitor (SNRI) used to treat depression
Which of the following periodontal fibers are putatively responsible for relapse of orthodontic
rotation of teeth?
A. Diagonal
B. Horizontal
C. Oblique
D. Supracrestal
E. Transverse D. Supracrestal
1) Supracrestal Fibers
a. Orthodontic treatment of rotated teeth may experience relapse as the supracrestal periodontal
fibers try to revert to its original position.
b. possess a "memory" or tendency to recoil back to their normal position, causing the relapse
Which of the following is considered the primary etiology of gingivitis during pregnancy and
puberty?
A. Calculus
B. Estradiol
C. Estrogen
D. Plaque
E. Progesterone
F. Testosterone D. Plaque
1) Plaque
a. primary etiology of gingival inflammation because the bacterial aggregates from plaque
initiates the inflammatory reaction.
2) Calculus
a. predisposing factor for the formation of plaque
b. on its own DOES NOT cause gingivitis
A. Aggregatibacter Actinomycetemcomitans
B. Porphyromonas gingivalis
C. Streptococcus gordinii
D. Tannerela forsythia C. Streptococcus gordinii
1) Streptococcus gordinii
a. gram positive cocci
b. belongs to normal oral flora that adheres to tooth pellicle
c. considered one of the initial colonizers of the dental biofilm
d. creates a binding site for other bacteria to adhere = congregation
e. in normal amounts, helps maintain the balance between gram positive and gram negative
bacteria i nthe mouth
2) Periodontitis
a. Aggregatibacter Actinomycetemcomitans
b. Porphyromonas gingivalis
c. Tannerela forsythia
Which of the following bacteria has been identified as periodontal pathogens?
A. Lactobacillus casei
B. Porphyromonas gingivalis
C. Streptococcus mutans
D. Streptococcus gordinii B. Porphyromonas gingivalis
1) Porphyromonas gingivalis
a. etiologic pathogen of periodontitis
Which of the following conditions is associated with localized aggressive periodontitis?
A. Cyclic eosinophilia
B. Defects in neutrophil chemotaxis
C. Elevated phagocytosis
D. Lysis of neutrophils * D. Lysis of neutrophils
2) Lysis of neutrophils
a. helps to recruit more neutrophils along the infection site
3) Elevated phagocytosis
a. active host defense mechanism
Which class of bacteria that is implicated in odontogenic infections is able to survive in both
high and low oxygen environments?
A. Enteric organisms
B. Facultative organisms
C. Microaerophilic organisms
D. Synergistic organisms
E. Obligate anaerobes B. Facultative organisms
1) Facultative organisms
a. can live with or without oxygen
A. Aggressive periodontitis
B. Cyclic neutropenia
C. Hypophosphatasia
D. Necrotizing ulcerative gingivitis
E. Papillon Lefevre syndromeC. Hypophosphatasia
1) Hypophosphatasia
a. hereditary disease where there is a marked deficiency of the tissue non-specific alkaline
phosphatase enzyme.
b. deficiency in this enzyme affects the development and mineralization of bone and teeth
c. premature primary tooth exfoliation
d. severe destruction of the periodontium of permanent teeth
Acute pyogenic bacterial infections are known to result in a state of...
A. Leukopenia
B. Lymphocytosis
C. Lymphopenia
D. Neutropenia
E. Leukocytosis E. Leukocytosis
1) Leukocytosis
a. white blood cell count above the normal range
b. sign of inflammatory response that is most commonly the result of infection
c. observed with certain parasitic infections, cancer, after strenuous exercise, emotional stress,
pregnancy, anesthesia steroid, and epinephrine administration
Which of the following bacteria are associated with supra gingival plaque?
1) Supragingival plaque
a. consists of gram positive rods and cocci
b. collection of bacteria, proteins, carbohydrates, and glycoproteins
2) Subgingival plaque
a. non calcified mass of bacteria, proteins, and carbohydrates situated inferior to the gingival
margin
Which of the following describes the proper progression of stages of the pathogenesis of
periodontal lesions?
1) Initial lesion
a. presence of acute inflammatory reaction as the normal healthy gingiva reacts to plaque
accumulation
2) Early lesion
a. occur when an infiltrate of lymphoid cells, particularly T lymphocytes appear on the site of
injury of accumulation
3) Establish lesion
a. B lymphocytes and plasma cells suddenly predominates the site of inflammation
4) Advance lesion
a. manifests itself a periodontitis and physiologically irreversible loss of bone
* The most rapid destruction of alveolar bone is caused by which of the following periodontal
diseases?
1) The most rapid destruction of alveolar bone occurs in the presence of a periodontal abscess
2) Periodontal abscesses
a. occurs when pus accumulates, causing pressure build up within the bone, resulting in bone
destruction
b. as the periodontal abscess increases in size, the area affected by the abscess is resorbed
Which of the following is the MOST numerous cell type observed in inflammatory infiltrate of
an acute periodontal abscess?
A. B-lymphocytes
B. CD-4 T-lymphocytes
C. CD-8 T-lymphocytes
D. Macrophages
E. Neutrophils
F. Plasma cells E. Neutrophils
1) Neutrophils (PMNs)
a. first to arrive at the site of inflammation
b. first line of defense against any foreign invader of the body
c. comprise about 50-60% of the total number of leukocytes circulating in the bloodstream
Which of the following antibodies is MOST prevalent?
A. IgA
B. IgD
C. IgE
D. IgG
E. IgM A. IgA
1) IgA
a. more prevalent in saliva
b. prevent adhesion of the bacteria to the oral tissues because it is bound to IgA instead.
c. known as the agglutinating antibody because it clumps or "glues" bacteria together
2) IgG
a. more associated with sulcular fluid
Which of the following does plaque accumulation DIRECTLY affect?
A. Accumulation of calculus
B. Gingivitis severity
C. Herpes outbreak severity
D. Materia alba level
E. Periodontitis severity B. Gingivitis severity
1) Plaque
a. The severity of gingival inflammation is directly related to the amount of plaque accumulation
b. when bacterial toxins are released by plaque, the gingiva become irritated, initiating a
defensive reaction through an inflammatory response
2) Material alba
a. soft debris on the tooth surface which is easily removed and does NOT cause gingivitis
1) Calculus
a. dental plaque that has become calcified and is often covered by a layer of uncalcified plaque
which releases exotoxins and other chemicals that cause inflammation
How many hours after mechanical debridement with a toothbrush is a mature dental plaque
found?
A. 1-2 Hours
B. 12-24 Hours
C. 24-48 Hours
D. 3-5 Hours
E. 6-10 Hours C. 24-48 Hours
1) Mature dental plaque is usually reformed on the teeth within 24-48 hours after plaque removal
2) 1st bacteria to attach to the pellicle glycoproteins are gram positive aerobic cocci such as
Streptococcus sanguinis.
3) After 24 hours, anaerobic gram negative cocci, rods, and filaments begin to colonize the
plaque.
Which of the following statements does NOT describe the experimental gingivitis model?
1) Unstable teeth that cannot contain normal position during centric occlusion need additional
support to maintain position and therefore must be splinted to the adjacent teeth.
1) Diabetes Mellitus is considered a risk factor for the progression of periodontal disease which
must be addressed during the initial periodontal therapy.
2) 1st phase
a. remove causative factors, risk factors, and predisposing factors that may worsen the
periodontal condition of the patient.
Each of the following may be considered as an indication for gingivectomy EXCEPT one.
Which is the EXCEPTION?
1) Gingivectomy
a. reduce redundant or hyperplastic gingival tissues and are indicated when there is excess
gingiva, preventing the patient from cleaning their mouth properly
2) Infrabony defects would NOT be helped by removing gum tissue, they can only be resolved
by bone augmentation
At which of the following sites is an apically repositioned flap procedure generally impossible to
perform?
A. Mandibular lingual
B. Maxillary facial
C. Maxillary Palatal
D. Mandibular facial C. Maxillary Palatal
1) Thickness of the gingival epithelium and its supporting attached gingiva make apically
repositioned flap procedures impossible for the maxillary palatal area.
2) Attached gingiva in the palatal area is difficult to differentiate with the palatal mucosa because
there is an unclear demarcation between the two.
Which of the following anatomical structures is the primary reason why the buccal aspect of
posterior teeth are difficult to surgically treat for periodontal defects?
1) Wide sulcus
a. indicates attachment loss
1) Prognosis
a. BEST prognosis for regenerative periodontal therapies or osseous grafting is associated with
defects possessing more walls
2) Craters
a. 2-walled defects where the buccal and lingual walls remain while the proximal wall is
destroyed
3) Furcations
a. have the worst prognosis
Ideal bone grating material should perform each of the following roles EXCEPT one. Which is
the EXCEPTION?
A. Induce osteogenesis
B. Produce an immunologic response
C. Withstand mechanical forces
D. Be replaced by host bone B. Produce an immunologic response
1) Immobilization
a. enables the formation of blood vessels and better diffusion of nutrients from the recipient site
to the graft
b. donor tissue can gain attachment to the recipient site as long as the graft is adapted and placed
properly at the recipient site
c. formation of new capillaries from the recipient site to the do not site will only occur within 2-3
days after the surgical procedure in the process known as capillary inosculation
A patient should control the amount of plaque in their mouth before undergoing any periodontal
surgery; BECAUSE plaque-infected teeth demonstrate a higher incidence of disease recurrence
after surgery?
1. Plaque
a. aggregation of bacterial species that may infect the surgical wound after a surgical procedure
b. plaque accumulation along the tooth surface predisposes the open wound to pathogens and
opportunistic bacteria
2. Surgical Procedure
a. patients should strictly follow a proper daily oral hygiene regimen to ensure that they are
capable of maintaining good dental health after surgery
b. surgical wounds are open areas where bacterial species can easily penetrate and infect the
body
Which of the following variables is considered the MOST important for determining the
prognosis of a tooth?
3) Variable connection between alveolar bone height and clinical attachment level.
Autogenous tooth transplants most commonly fail by their 3rd year in which of the following
ways?
After an apically re-positioned flap procedure is performed, junctional epithelium can establish
itself on both cementum and dentin
1) Junctional epithelium
a. re-attached back to cementum and dentin after an apically repositioned flap by re-establishing
tight junctions
b. takes about 10-14 days to complete after surgical procedure
2) Incidence
a. as well as severity of chronic inflammatory periodontal disease is lessened by taking proper
oral hygiene measures regularly
Which method of treatment should be utilized to increase the rate of success in case of localized
aggressive periodontitis?
1) Systemic antibiotics
a. periodontal treatments through nonsurgical and surgical root debridement are more successful
when administered with systemic antibiotics
b. ensure that the antibiotic molecule reaches the site as compared with local application
3) Local antibiotics
a. sometimes ineffective because it might not reach the deep pockets of the periodontal disease
Which of the following is the MOST critical factor determining the prognosis of a periodontally
involved tooth?
A. Mobility of tooth
B. Presence of furcation involvement
C. Probing depth
D. Amount of attachment loss D. Amount of attachment loss
1) Attachment Loss
a. determines the prognosis of periodontally compromised teeth
b. higher the quantity of attachment, the better the prognosis
c. teeth with severe attachment loss and vertical mobility presents a hopeless prognosis and must
be extracted to avoid infection that may compromise other teeth
Freeze dried bone is characterized by which of the following?
A. 2
B. 3
C. 4
D. 1 A. 2
1) Furcation Classes
Grade I
a. incipient bone loss
b. Nabor's probe can feel the depression of the furcation opening
Grade II
a. partial bone loss
b. Nabor's probe enters under the ceiling of the furcation
c. have the best prognosis for guided tissue regeneration because they are the least severe of
pathos's
Grade III
a. total bone loss
b. through and through opening of the furcation
c. entrance to the furcation is not able to be seen clinically
Grade IV
a. through-and-through
b. furcation where entrance is clinically visible
Which of the following defects has the WORST prognosis for bone grafting?
1) Furcation Defects
Class I
a. concavity just above the furcation entrance can be felt with the probe tip
b.furcation probe (Nabor's) cannot enter the furcation area
Class II
a. probe is able to partially enter the furcation - extending approximately 1/3 of the width of the
tooth = but it is NOT abel to pass completely through the furcation
Class III
a. in mandibular molars, the probe passes completely through the furcation between the medial
and distal roots
b. in maxillary molars, the probe passes between the mesiobuccal and distobuccal roots and
toughs the palatal root.
Class IV
a. same as Class III furcation involvement except that the entrance to the furcation is visible
clinically due to tissue recession
Therapy Therapy Answers
Which of the following describes the BEST approach a dentist should use to elevate a flap to
prevent exposure of a dehiscence or fenestration on a prominent root?
1) Concept: Using a partial thickness flap, a dentist may utilize use the elevate flap to cover up
the dehiscence or fenestration of a root.
4) Full thickness flaps are NOT a good choice since they will expose the whole bone surface
including the dehiscence and fenestration of tooth.
If a hygienist in your office leaves an ultrasonic tip on one spot on a tooth for too long which of
the following is most likely result?
1) Concept: Vibrations of ultrasonic instruments may cause damaged to the tooth when the
ultrasonic tip is left on one spot for prolonged period of time
2) Ultrasonic instruments must be limited 4-6 minutes per tooth; otherwise harm might be
incurred to the surrounding tissues.
1) Concept: Free gingival grafts gain their nutrients from the recipient site through plasmatic
diffusion.
2) During the first 24 hours, there is no vascular connection between the free gingival gray and
the recipient site.
3) The forming capillary anastomoses provides the source of nutrients for free gingival grafts
after 3 days post surgically.
An apically repositioned flap margin on the palatal aspect of molar teeth is allowed for by which
of the following?
1) Concept: Apically repositioned flap margins on the palatal aspect need to be placed exactly to
its predetermined position during the procedure because the palatal mucosa has no unattached
mucosa that can be displaced.
b. An apically repositioned flap usually requires displacement of the gingiva to a more apical
position, requiring vertical releasing incisions except when the flap is made on the palate.
2) Palatal Mucosa
a. firmly attached to the palatal bone and due to its thick nature displacement is not possible
A buccal flap used to cover an oroantral communication associated with tooth #1 would receive
nourishment from which of the following arteries?
A. Facial
B. Greater Palatine
C. Nasopalatine
D. Posterior superior alveolar D. Posterior superior alveolar
1) Concept: The buccal flap will receive its nourishment from the blood vessel that supplies
tooth #1 which is the posterior superior alveolar artery
3) Facial Artery
a. branches out and supplied blood to several parts of the face which includes the lips, portions of
the nose, sub mental areas and some portions of the tonsils.
A. Degeneration
B. Dysplasia
C. Keratohyalin granule formation
D. Orthokeratinization
E. Proliferation A. Degeneration
1) Concept: Free gingival grafts may undergo degeneration since they are harvested from a donor
site and are suddenly transferred to the recipient site
A. Angina pectoris
B. Herpangina
C. Necrotizing ulcerative gingivitis
D. Recurrent aphthous stomatitis
E. Verruca Vulgaris C. Necrotizing ulcerative gingivitis
3) Latest treatment of ANUG involves periodic scaling and root planing accompanied by topical
chlorhexidine gluconate.
Which of the following statements describe the key objective of the internal bevel incision used
in flap procedures?
1) Concept: The internal bevel incision helps reflect the flap to expose the underlying alveolar
bone.
A. 0.12% Chorhexidine
B. 1% Iodine tincture
C. 10% Hydrogen peroxide
D. 3% Hydrogen peroxide
E. Betadine Solution D. 3% Hydrogen peroxide
1) Concept: Debridement of intraoral lesions are performed to remove dead and infected surfaces
through the use of 3% hydrogen peroxide.
3) Prolonged hydrogen peroxide use is NOT advised due to its ability to cause harm and
irritation to oral tissues.
6) Chlorhexidine is an antibiotic rinse that would NOT help to remove dead tissues.
Which of the following describes a decalcified and freeze-dried bone graft donated from a
human to be graft to another human patient?
A. Alloplastic graft
B. Autograft
C. Xenograft
D. Allograft D. Allograft
1) Concepts: Allograft are grafts taken from one person (usually a cadaver) and given to
ANOTHER person. Bone allografts are often freeze-dried.
3) Autografts
a. grafts taken from a part of the body of an individual and is transferred to another area of the
body of the SAME person
4) Alloplasts
a. an inert or non-reactive foreign material which is transplanted or implanted inside the body
5) Xenografts
a. graft taken from a member of a certain species and is transferred to a recipient from a different
species
The apical extent of a gingivectomy procedure should be placed...
1) Concept: gingivectomy is a periodontal surgery that involves excision of the gingiva. The
apical extent of gingivectomy may be equal or apical to th bottom of the periodontal pocket as
long as the termination point is above the mucogingival junction.
3) Extent of the gingiva to be removed is identified with the use of a periodontal probe
Each of the following can occur during scaling and root planing procedures EXCEPT ONE.
Which is the EXCEPTION?
A. Calculus removal
B. Cementum removal
C. Dentin removal
D. Enamel removal
E. Soft tissue Damage D. Enamel removal
1) Concept: Enamel removal during scaling and root planing is NOT possible since enamel is
highly mineralized structure that is too hard to be removed by such dental procedure.
2) The primary role of scaling and root planing is to remove all plaque and calculus that is
attached to the tooth surface and to be able to create a surface and glass-like root surface which is
conducive for good gingival health.
3) Creating a smooth and glass like root surface during the root planing procedure allows the
formation of new cementum and reattachment of the supporting gingiva through the formation of
long junctional epithelium.
4) The scaling and root planing procedure should aways be performed under local anesthesia
since it involves removal of calculus and plaque along the cementum. Soft tissue damage,
removal of some cementum and dentin are some time inevitable during the scaling and root
planing process.
Which of the following statements describe the key objective of surgery as part of a patient's
overall periodontal therapy?
1) Concept: The main goal of respective or regenerative surgery as part of periodontal therapy is
to reduce pocket depths.
2) Osseous surgery
a. includes the recontouring of both hard and soft tissues
3) Resective surgeries
a. include gingivectomy and flap surgeries
4) Regenerative surgeries
a. include grafting and the use of barrier membranes
Dental indications for systemic antibiotics include each of the following EXCEPT one. Which is
NOT an indication for systemic antibiotics?
1) Concept: Localized alveolar osteitis (dry socket) does not necessitate the use of systemic
antibiotics
2) Dry socket is a painful condition that usually occurs after a traumatic extraction and accidental
early dislodgment of the blood clot inside the extraction site.
3) Alveolar osteitis is treated by rinsing the affected tooth socket with warm saline solution and
placement of a sponge with an antiseptic dressing.
Ultrasonic instruments are indicated for each of the following types of patients EXCEPT one.
Which is the EXCEPTION?
1) Concept: Ultrasonic instruments should NOT be used for patients with active infectious
disease because the aerosol created by the instruments serves to spread the infection around the
operator.
2) Diabetes and deep periodontal pockets are indications that ultrasonic instrumentation.
During an ostectomy procedure, the surgeon always...
1) Concept: Ostectomy
a. is a surgical procedure that removes supporting bone in order to help reduce or eliminate
periodontal pockets
2) Osteoplasty
a. a surgical procedure that removes non-supported bone
b. completed before the ostectomy in order to allow for the most conservative removal of bundle
bone (supporting bone) around the teeth
3) When pocket depth is decreased, the effectiveness of oral hygiene measures increases.
Barrier or Teflon membranes are utilized by dentists to treat osseous defects through attempting
to restrict which of the following?
1) The reattachment of gingiva to the cementum through the formation of long junctional
epithelium should be restricted in order to allow the newly formed periodontal ligament fibers to
interlock with the cementum and create new attachments.
2) Barrier or Teflon membranes are placed to allow cultivation and growth of new attachments
without any interference from the long junctional epithelium.
3) Guided tissue regeneration procedure requires the use of barrier membranes in order to guide
or direct the growth of new forming bone and soft tissue.
4) Barrier membranes also stops the possible migration of epithelial cell toward the newly
formed cementum layer, thus preventing the formation of the long junctional epithelium.
Each of the following describe the modes of action for cavitrons EXCEPT one. Which is the
EXCEPTION?
A. Cavitation
B. Lavage
C. Piezo movement
D. Vibration C. Piezo movement
1) Concept: Ultrasonic instruments (cavitrons) move in a rapid pulsating manner that creates
vibration, cavitation, and rinsing water used to cool and lavage tissues.
b. Ultrasonic dental scalers use vibration and pulsation in order to break down the mineralized
plaque.
c. Ultrasonic cleaners produce cavitation, where rapid movement creates tiny vacuum bubbles in
the liquid which burst once they comes in contact with contaminants. This reaction is able to
scrub particles of bacteria and calculus off of tooth surfaces.
d. Ultrasonic lavage action is used for hard to reach areas like endodontic canals.
2) Piezo movement uses different mechanism of action (forward and backward linear motion
instead of ovoid movement).
b. Piezo instruments can create ultrasonic movements.
Which of the following osseous grafting materials is harvested from a human donor and placed
in another human?
A. Allograft
B. Allolastic
C. Autograft
D. Xenograft A. Allograft
1) Concept: Allografts
a. describe bone that is taken from another human being and placed in another person
2) Autografts
a. describe bone taken away from one patient and placed in that very same patient
3) Xenografts
a. describe bone taken from an animal like a horse, pig, or cow, and placed in a human
4) Alloplastic/synthetic grafts
a. describe inert biologic fillers such as hydroxyapatite, different polymers like PMMA
Root planing should be avoided during modified Widman flap procedures BECAUSE the margin
of the modified Widman flap will be placed apically to the level of altered root surfaces?
1) Concept: Modified Widman flaps are a periodontal flap that is performed to reduce
periodontal pockets.
2) The modified Widman flap provides better access and visibility of the root surface, making
the root planing procedure easier as well as also increasing the level of success of the procedure.
3) Pocket depth elimination helps patients maintain better plaque control which will reduce the
chances of disease recurrence.
Each of the following statements about partial thickness flaps is correct EXCEPT one. Which is
the EXCEPTION?
A. Acoustic turbulence
B. Cavitation
C. Lavage
D. Linear movement
E. Vibration D. Linear movement
3) Piezo instruments
a. uses a linear movement to create a back-and-forth motion to crete their ultrasonic movement
Each of the following is associated with full-thickness flaps EXCEPT one. Which is the
EXCEPTION?
A. Apical repositioning
B. Dissection of the tissue with a blunt instrument
C. Osseous recontouring
D. Periosteum stays on the bone D. Periosteum stays on the bone
2) Following placement of the incisions, the flap is dissected using blunt instruments like a #9
molt to separate the soft tissue from the bone.
3) Full thickness flaps are used when recontouring the osseous structures below of when the
gingiva are repositioned apically.
Which of the following procedures should be performed after a dentist reflects a flap, debrides 2
and 3-walled defects, and scales and root planes the teeth of a 55-year old male with deep
fibrotic pockets and angular bone loss?
1) Concept: Bony defects with 2 or 3 walls in the alveolar bone and teeth that exhibit angular
bone loss are considered good candidates for bone grafting.
2) Prognosis of bone grafting success increases for bony defects having 2 or more supporting
walls
3) Apically repositioned flaps and crown lengthening procedures are NOT indicated for cases
having angular bone loss and large bony defects.
4) Gingivectomy is only indicated for patient having excessive gingival exposure and is NOT
used for eliminating deep pockets.
The suggested initial treatment for a patient that presents to your office with HIV associated
necrotizing ulcerative gingivo-periodontitis is which of the following?
2) Necrotizing ulcerative gingivitis and periodontitis usually occurs because of the predominance
of the anaerobic fusobacteria and spirochetes within the oral cavity, specifically underneath the
gingiva.
3) Debridement of the affected gingiva with an adjective prescription of chorhexidine 0.12% rise
will help stop the progression of necrotizing ulcerative disease.
A. Vestibular depth
B. Presence of intrabony defect
C. Probing depth
D. Quantity of attached gingiva
E. Frenum attachment level D. Quantity of attached gingiva
1) Concept: Attached Gingiva
a. maintains a tight contact with the periosteum of the bone and certain areas of the tooth root.
b. its function is to keep the free gingiva in close contact with the tooth while also protecting the
soft and free moving alveolar mucosa.
c. insufficient attached gingiva makes the mucosa more prone to trauma during function and
compromises the periodontal support of teeth
d. in order to avoid periodontal problems after surgery, the width of the attached gingiva must be
preserved.
Prevention and Maintenance Prevention and Maintenance Answers
Which of the following locations does new plaque principally accumulate after a patient brushes
their teeth?
A. Buccal
B. Interproximal
C. Lingual
D. Occlusal B. Interproximal
1) Concept: Plaque usually accumulates along the areas hardly reached by toothbrush like the
inter proximal area.
2) Plaque
a. Newly formed plaque may form on all surface of teeth but typically stays longer within areas
that are rarely disturbed by oral hygiene practices
b. may form alone the buccal and lingual aspects of tooth, but with proper brushing these areas
are easily cleaned
c. occlusal area may demonstrate some plaque accumulation, but most of the time plaque is
dislodged during mastication and brushing
True/False:
The duration a prescribed therapy has an effect on patient compliance. Disease severity as
perceived by the patient has an effect on patient compliance. Both statements are TRUE
1) Concept: Patients undergoing a treatment with a long duration have greater tendencies of
becoming less compliant and less dedicated to treatment procedures due to the lack of a
immediate treatment result
2) Treatments that last for a very long time also make patients tired of routine medication and
causes them to be less compliant.
3) Patients who are hopeful and expect good results from medical treatment are more receptive
to taking medication and are more compliant.
4) Patients who perceive that their disease severity is hopeless tend to be less receptive and less
compliant with their medication.
Cleaning root surfaces daily has been indicated to result in...
A. Root resorption
B. Root sensitivity
C. Root surface remineralization
D. Increased epithelial attachment level C. Root surface remineralization
1) Concept: Cleaning root surfaces on a daily basis with fluoride dentifrices may result in root
surface remineralization.
2) Consistent plaque removal prevents root demineralization by bacteria and enables the root
surface to remineralize.
3) Presence of minerals in saliva and fluoride from toothpaste also aid in the remineralization of
root surfaces
The principal goal of the maintenance phase of periodontal therapy is described by which of the
following?
A. Bone
B. Cementum
C. Epithelium
D. Dentin B. Cementum
1) Concept: Formation of new attachment occurs when the newly formed periodontal ligament
fibers embed themselves into the cementum of a preciously derided root surface.
2) New attachment is the reunion of connective tissue with a root surface that has been deprived
of its periodontal ligament.
3) The formation of periodontal ligament in the new cementum can only be achieved through
guided tissue regeneration.
Which of the following describes the MOST EFFECTIVE method for managing post surgical
root sensitivity after periodontal surgery is performed?
1) Concept: The best way to manage post surgical root sensitivity is to address the central
etiology (dental plaque).
The acidic metabolites from plaque may cause sensitivity to the exposed root surface after
periodontal surgery.
Desensitizing dentifrice may provide a temporary relief from root sensitivity but takes up to 2
weeks to take effect. Adequate removal of plaque along the tooth surface will provide a MORE
permanent solution to sensitivity.
Mineral trioxide aggregates is NOT indicated for addressing root sensitivity but is rather used as
a filling material for endodontic treatment.
When using only standard floss, the mesial root surface of which of the following teeth is
typically NOT totally cleaned?
1) Concept: The mesial root surface of the maxillary 1st premolar is typically NOT thoroughly
cleaned using ONLY the dental floss due to the medial root concavity.
3) Gingival Embrasures
a. Type I: Having NO inter dental papilla loss
b. Type II: Partial loss of inter dental papilla
c. Type III: Complete loss of inter dental papilla
4) The mesial surface of the maxillary 1st premolar typically has a Type II or Type III gingival
embrasure, resulting in moderate to severe recession with exposure of the root concavity.
Interdental brushes clean the root concavity better than dental floss.
Each of the following devices are effective in removing surface plaque EXCEPT one. Which is
the EXCEPTION?
A. Side-to-side
B. Stillman
C. Sulcular
D. Charter C. Sulcular
1) Concept: Sulcular brushing technique
a. The sulcular brushing technique effectively eliminates plaque from the sulcular and cervical
areas of the teeth thereby preventing the occurrence of periodontal disease.
b. Sulcular brushing allows the round ended brush fps o each about 0.5mm subgingivally to
effective disrupt plaque buildup in the cervical area
c. Sulcular brushing reduces the chance for abfraction that may happen from improper brushing
strokes that cause cervical cavities that are prone to plaque retention, tooth sensitivity, and tooth
decay.
Which of the following describes the intended function of a home dental water irrigation systems
(Water Pike)?
1) Concept: home water irrigation systems are designed to reduce the biofilms present on the
gingiva, NOT the tooth surface
2) Gram+ bacteria produce dextrans levs, and glucans which allow them to better adhere to tooth
structure
3) Gram- bacteria produce alginates to help them to adhere to adhere
4) Spirochetes cannot produce the same adherence factors as gram negative and gram positive
bacteria, so they can be flushed from the pocket.
True/False:
A minor traumatic injury can result in enamel breaking-off of the underlying dentin.
1) Enamel fractures are defined as damage to the enamel layer of the tooth causing partial or
total removal of the enamel structure which may expose the dentin layer underneath.
2) Small enamel fractures can be recontoured and smoothened with enameloplasty. Extensive
enamel fractures are better restored with composites, crowns, inlays/onlays, and veneers
3) Trauma to odontoblasts over a very short period of time will not degenerate the pulp.
However, continuous trauma to odontoblasts may result in pulpal irritation and eventually the
initiation of tertiary dentin formation.
Which of the following disorders is associated with a chromosomal abnormality which can occur
as the result of either chromosomal nondisjunction or translocation?
A. Klinefelter syndrome
B. Trisomy 21 (Down syndrome)
C. Turner syndrome
D. Ehler-Danlos syndrome B. Trisomy 21 (Down syndrome)
1) Trisomy 21 occurs because of meiotic nondisjunction, which is a situation where a gamete
from a parent contains excess chromosomes.
2) Patients with Down's syndrome possess 3 copies of chrosome 21 instead of 2 copies. This
condition is considered the most commonly occurring chromosomal abnormality in humans.
Waiting for intruded permanent central incisors to re-erupt in an 8-year-old child will likely
result in
A. Ankylosis
B. Calcific metamorphosis
C. External resorption
D. Hypocalcificaton spots on the tooth upon eruption
E. Internal resorption
F. Re-eruption F. Re-eruption
1) An intruded permanent central incisor will eventually start to re-erupt within a period of
approximately 2-3 weeks.
Pulpal necrosis and damage Intrusive luxation
1) Intrusive luxation
a. of primary teeth among children alway result to pulpal necrosis
b. occurs when tooth is pushed into the socket, directly damaging and severing the vascular
supply of the tooth, immediately results to pulpal necrosis
3) If tooth is replanted after a long period of time, the changes of ankylosis will increase.
In patient suffering from multiple sclerosis
A. A single cartridge of anesthetic will most likely not last as long as it would for a normal
patient
B. Epinephrine is contraindicated in local anesthetic
C. The amount of anesthetic needed for a given procedure is more than for a normal patient
D. The amount of anesthetic needed for a given procedure is less than for a normal patient
B. Epinephrine is contraindicated in local anesthetic
1) Epinephrine should not be used for patients suffering from multiple sclerosis because
epinephrine can aggravate the condition by regulating the activation of blood lymphocytes.
2) Epinephrine is a cetecholamine and neurotransmitter responsible for the body's flight- or flight
response.
3) Elevating the levels of epinephrine also increases blood lymphocyte activity which could
cause further damage to the myelin sheaths of the neurons thereby aggravating multiple sclerosis
condition.
A child presents with a noticeably sore ulceration of their lower lip and no history of obvious
trauma. The ulceration appeared several hours after the patient received dental treatment. Which
of the following is the most probable diagnosis?
A. Herpes labialis
B. Post-anesthetic lip bite
C. Type IV allergic reaction to the latex in the rubber dam
D. Aphthous ulcer secondary to stress B. Post-anesthetic lip bite
1) Due to the feeling of numbness after anesthetic delivery, a child may either intentional or
unintentionally bite on his/her lips.
2) Children under anesthesia should be supervised by their parents and instructed not to eat on
the anesthetized side of the jaw to prevent accidental lip biting while anesthesia is still present.
A clinical examination of a 7-year-old patient reveals a fractured right central incisor with a 2-
mm exposure of a "bleeding pulp" that occured 3 hours ago. The suggested treatment is
1) Pulpotomy procedures prevent unnecessary extraction of central incisors by removing only the
portion of the pulp that was exposed during the trauma.
3) The root apex of developing permanent central incisor is still open. By performing a Cvek
pulpotomy, the root of the central incisor will have extra time to complete its root development.
Which of the following describes an injury where a tooth is damaged but NOT displaced?
Concussion
1) Concussion
a. injury within the supporting structures
b. loosening and possible displacement among traumatized teeth is not observed
2) Subluxation
a. involves displacement of a tooth from its socket and may require additional dental treatment of
the affected tooth
3) Luxation
a. denotes displacement of tooth to any direction away from its original position in the dental
arch
Individual Tooth Pathology Individual Tooth Pathology Answers
A 7-year-old boy presents to you office after fracturing his left central incisor 3 hours ago.
During your examination, you find 2mm o exposed, bleeding pulp tissue. There is no mobility
noted. What treatment is indicated?
2) Cvek pulpotomy
a. a partial pulpotomy for traumatic exposure
3) The root apex of developing central incisor is still open. By performing a Cvek pulpotomy, the
root of the central incisor will have extra time to complete its root development.
4) Pulpotomies
a. performed as a temporary treatment option in permanent teeth while you wait for the roots of
the tooth to fully develop so a root canal treatment can be performed
Of the following anomalies, the one which normally has a bacterial etiology is:
A. Compound odontoma
B. Dentinogenesis imperfecta
C. Fusion
D. Hutchinson's incisors
E. Enameloma D. Hutchinson's incisors
1) Congenital Syphilis
a. associated with Hutchinson's incisors occurring in month 4-6 in utero before calcification
begins.
b. Incisors and 1st molars are most commonly affected because they are the only permanent teeth
at this stage of development
c. incisors : have a notch in the center of the incisal edge, making them appear like a screwdriver
d. 1st molars: typically appear with poorly developed cusps and gnarled enamel, giving arise to
the name "mulberry molars"
e. primary teeth are topically NOT affected
f. esthetics is the primary concern of patients with this condition
1) Concept: Dilaceration describes a severe angular or curve in the root or crown of a tooth that
is thought to result from trauma during development.
2) Dilaceration
a. trauma during tooth development may result in the poison of calcified portion of the tooth
being changed so the remainder of the tooth is formed at an angle.
b. curve or bend occur anywhere along the length of the tooth and depends on the amount of root
that is already formed when the injury is sustained.
c. An injury resulting in dilaceration may often occur when a deciduous predecessor is driven
aplically into the jaw and applies force to the permanent tooth below
d. may make future endodontic procedures more difficult
The alterations in the continuity of the occlusal plane after a tooth is ankylosed is primarily
caused by which of the following?
A. Ankylosed teeth moving apically as the root becomes incorporated into the alveolar bone
B. Differential eruption sequences
C. Localized inhibition of alveolar process growth
D. Continued eruption of nonankylosed teeth and growth of the alveolar process D. Continued
eruption of nonankylosed teeth and growth of the alveolar process
1) Concept: When teeth are ankylosed, they usually lie below the occlusal plane because the
supporting alveolar process does not grow
2) Alveolar process growth occurs simultaneously with the eruption of teeth. Ankylosed teeth do
not experience alveolar process growth because of their failure to erupt the same way as the other
non-anklyosed teeth due to a lack of periodontal ligament.
3) Ankylosed teeth are teeth with roots completely embedded into the bone without periodontal
ligament.
The condition known as "twinning" normally:
2) Fusion
a. where two separate buds join together
b. This leaves one tooth less than normal in the dentition
c. have one less tooth (in the normal dentition) separate root canals
The proper treatment for a tooth with an uncomplicated/incomplete crown fracture (pulp is not
exposed) would be...
1) Concept: It is important to immediately evaluate tooth vitality as well as the extent of the
crack, which in this case is suspected of being an incomplete crown fracture
2) The results of pulp vitality tests will help you to know if the pulp is still vital and unaffected
by the fracture. It is essential to determine extent of the incomplete fracture and its cause.
3) If the tooth is vital an the incomplete fracture cause some discomfort, the fractured tooth
surface must be restored.
4) The patient should regularly visit the dentist for re-evaluation of the tooth structure and the
tooth vitality.
5) Crazing is when there is a fracture line that does not extend to dentin.
Which of the following is the term for when a tooth is traumatized without displacement of the
tooth that increases the mobility of the tooth?
A. Concussion
B. Extrusion
C. Intrusion
D. Subluxation
E. Luxation D. Subluxation
2) Concussion
a. there is an injury within the supporting structures of a traumatized tooth
b. does NOT demonstrate bleeding from the sulcus
c. loosening and possible displacement among traumatized teeth is NOT observed in concussion
cases
d. an injury without increased mobility or displacement of the tooth
e. with pain on percussion
f. without gingival bleeding
3) Luxation
a. used to denote displacement of tooth in any direction away from its original position in the
dental arch
4) Extrusion
a. partial displacement of the tooth out of its socket and that is characterized by partial or total
separation of the periodontal ligament resulting in loosening and displacement of the tooth.
b. alveolar socket bone is intact
5) Intrusion
a. displacement of the tooth into the alveolar bone and is accompanied by comminution or
fracture of the alveolar socket
Loss of a tooth letter L in a 3 year old patient requires...
1) Concept: Placement of a band and loop may help prevent the mesial movement of K into the
space created by extracting L.
2) It is important to keep or maintain this space to prevent tooth crowding when the
succedaneous counterpart erupts.
3) Keeping the remaining teeth in proper position will also guide the eruption of permanent 1st
molar and prevent it from moving medially.
4) The space of tooth letter L can be maintained by placing band/crown loop on tooth K-M. This
should be replaced later with lower lingual holding arch as soon as the other lower permanent
incisors erupt.
An anomaly in which there is a distortion of only the root of a tooth, which may be in the form of
a right angle bend, is:
A. Consecrence
B. Dilaceration
C. Dwarded root
D. Segmented root
E. Flexion E. Flexion
2) Dilaceration:
a. distortion of the root and crown from their normally linear relationship
3) Consecrence
a. union of the root structure of two or more teeth through CEMENTUM ONLY.
4) Dwarfed root
a. exists when normal sized crowns have abnormally short roots
5) Segmented root
a. two separated root segments due to break in Hertwig's sheath
A 9 year old presents to your office after he fracture maxillary 1st molar 3 hours ago. After
testing vital, you noticed an exposed inflamed coronal pulp in Tooth #14. The recommended
treatment of choice is...
1) Concept: Pulpotomy
a. The pulp exposure was caused by the tooth being fractured and its not due to caries making it a
good candidate for pulpotomy
b. exposed and inflamed coronal pulp can be removed and the remaining healthy radicular pulp
will be left unharmed
3) Pulpectomy
a. only indicated for primary teeth having infected coronal and radicular pulp because the apexes
of primary molars are still open
A. Concussion
B. Mid-root horizontal root fracture
C. Intrusive luxation
D. Avulsion C. Intrusive luxation
2) Avulsion
a. avulsed primary tooth will have a better chance of revascularization when implanted
immediately and will not always result in pulp necrosis
b. If the tooth is replanted after a long period of time, the chances of ankylosis will increase.
In the permanent dentition, which of the following injuries is most likely to cause pulp necrosis?
A. Extrusion
B. Intrusion
C. Luxation
D. Subluxation
E. Concussion B. Intrusion
1) Concept: Intrusion of a tooth into its socket may sever the nerve and blood vessels that supply
the tooth, resulting in pulp necrosis
a. Intrusion of teeth due to trauma may also cause replacement resorption of the roots or
ankylosis
2) Concussion, extrusion, luxation, and subluxation are accidents that are less likely to involve
the vascular supply of the tooth.
A 5 year-old presents to your office with spontaneous pain in their maxillary 1st molar and is
responsive to cold. The radiograph shows an intact furcation and caries extending to the pulp
chamber. What is the treatment of choice?
1) Pulpotomy
a. indicated for a primary tooth where infection has reached the coronal pulp but has not yet
reached the radicular pulp
b. removal of coronal portion of infected pulp to prevent bacterial invasion of the radicular pulp
c. coronal pulp is usually excavated with a large spoon excavator or slow speed hand piece with
a large round bur in reverse. The pulp stumps are then dabbed with a cotton pellet soaked in
2.6% NaOCl and the tooth is then restored.
2) Pulpectomy
a. are performed when pulp completely infected by bacteria and involve the complete removal of
pulp tissue
When examining a patient for the first time, the dentist notices that there is an abnormally wide
permanent mandibular incisor, and that there are only three total mandibular incisors, counting
the abnormal wide one. The condition most likely is due to the anomaly:
A. Consecrence
B. Dilaceration
C. Fusion
D. Gemination
E. Flexion C. Fusion
1) Fusion
a. 2 buds fuse
b. must have confluent (connected) dentin
c. less teeth in the mouth than expected
2) Gemination
a. still have a normal number of teeth in the mouth
b. is when ONE tooth bud splits so that there are two crowns but only one shared root (Siamese
twin like)
c. with gemination patients there is an extra tooth
3) Flexion
a. a deviation or bend at the root of tooth
b. less than 90 degree bend
c. results from trauma during development
4) Dilaceration
a. Severe angulation or curve in the root or crown of tooth
b. Bend is at junction of crown and root
c. Usually results from trauma during development.
5) Concrescence
a. a condition where the cementum overlying the roots of at least 2 teeth connects to join the
teeth together
Of the following dental anomalies, the one in which there is great potential for the premature loss
of the affected tooth, is:
A. Consecrence
B. Dwarfed root
C. Flexion
D. Gemination
E. Enameloma B. Dwarfed root
d. has a balanced pH and is known to replenish lost metabolites within the PDL cells of an
avulsed tooth
e. helps to improve the prognosis of replantation and decrease the chances of having replacement
resorption
Tetracycline staining occurs in which stage of tooth development?
A. Histodifferentiation
B. Mineralization
C. Morphodifferentiation
D. Proliferation
E. Apposition B. Mineralization
1) Tetracycline
a. incorporated into the tooth structure during the mineralization of the tooth because it forms a
chelate with calcium
b. tetracycline staining occurs after the ingestion of tetracycline antibiotics during tooth
development and is diagnosed by degrees of horizontal bands of color ranging from gray to gray-
brown and even some shades of green.
c. tetracycline staining is found in both the enamel and dentin
d. when first incorporated into the tooth structure, tetracycline produces a yellow color that
changes to brown and gray with the addition of sunlight over time.
In primary teeth, which of the following is least reliable in assessing the pulp vitality?
A. Extraoral swelling
B. Internal resorption
C. Intraoral swelling
D. Pulp testing
E. Spontaneous pain D. Pulp testing
2) Presence of spontaneous pain and a possible intramural swelling associated with a primary
tooth indicates the presence of irreversible pulp damage and that the infection has probably
reached the periodical region.
3) Extraoral swelling and internal resorption suggests that the pulp has become necrotic and that
the infection has reached the periodical region.
True/False:
A minor trauma to a tooth can lead to enamel fracturing and separating from the dentin beneath it
The trauma to the odontoblasts will eventually result in pulpal degeneration. The first
statement is TRUE, the second is FALSE.
A. Extraction
B. Occlusal caries
C. Pulpal therapy
D. Space maintenance
E. Trauma
F. Interproximal caries A. Extraction
C. Pulpal therapy
D. Space maintenance
E. Trauma
A. Dilaceration
B. Fusion
C. Gemination
D. Hypercementosis
E. Concrescence E. Concrescence
1) Concrescence
a. condition where the cementum overlying the roots of at least 2 teeth connects to join the teeth
together
b. surgical separation of the teeth may be necessary if one is to be extracted, which may result in
damage to the adjacent tooth root
c. incidence of concrescence can sometime be attributed to trauma or crowding of teeth
1) most common in the permanent molars
2) different from fusion because it occurs following eruption and involves ONLY CEMENTUM
A 5-year-old presents to your office complaining of spontaneous pain associated with their
mandibular 2nd molar. Clinical testing suggest that the pulp is necrotic, and radiographs suggest
NO periodical pathosis. What is the best treatment option of this child?
1) Pulpectomy
a. The spontaneous pain from necrotic pulp signifies the presence of infection inside the primary
tooth which can only be treated with a pulpectomy procedure
b. involves the complete removal of necrotic or partially necrotic pulp and placement of
medicaments inside the cavity in order to avoid premature extraction of teeth
c. indicated for primary teeth with infection and inflammation that has already reach beyond the
coronal aspect of the pulp
d. teeth indicated for pulpectomy must also exhibit no pathology resorption along the alveolar
bone and its roots
Fusion of teeth is an anomaly which normally involves:
1) Fusion
a. result of an union of two adjacent tooth buds
b. usually found in anterior teeth
The most likely outcome of waiting for intruded permanent central incisors to erupt in an 8 year
old is...
A. Ankylosis
B. External resorption
C. Hypocalcification spots on the tooth upon eruption
D. Internal resorption
E. Re-eruption E. Re-eruption
1) Concept: Re-eruption
a. An intruded permanent central incisor will eventually start to re-erupt within a period of
approximately 2-3 weeks
b. Deciding for the mode of treatment for an intruded tooth may vary depending upon the
severity of tooth intrusion and the maturity of its roots
c. The modalities of treatment for an intruded tooth include:
1) Passive repositioning (PR): provides enough time for the re-eruption of intruded tooth
2) Active repositioning is performed through surgical repositioning (SR)
3) Orthodontic repositioning is achieved with the use or removable or fixed appliances (OR)
Which of the following tooth surfaces requires the least amount of reduction for a stainless steel
crown for primary mandibular 1st molar?
A. Lingual
B. Mesial
C. Occlusal
D. Buccal A. Lingual
A. Ankylosis
B. Avulsion
C. Subluxation
D. Luxation B. Avulsion
1) Concept: Avulsion
a. happens when a tooth is forcefully dislodged or removed from its socket as a result of an
accident
b. avulsed teeth should be immediately replanted back to its socket and be splinted to adjacent
teeth for increased stability before further procedures are performed on the tooth
2) Ankylosis
a. occurs as the alveolus forms reparative bone (callus) to surround the tooth and replace the
damaged PDL fibers.
Permanent maxillary 1st molars may show evidence of congenital syphilis by exhibiting a
mulberry shape. Which of the following teeth are most likely to exhibit anomalous form due to
congenital syphilis?
A. Leukoedema
B. Leukoplakia
C. Lichen planus
D. White sponge nevus
E. Hairy Leukoplakia A. Leukoedema
1) Leukedema
a. disappears when the mucosa is stretched
b. presents as an asymptomatic blue, grey, or white appearance on the mucosa and is seen
predominantly in the buccal mucosa
c. occurs bilaterally on the buccal mucosa and is less often on the labial mucosa, the palate, or
the floor of the mouth
d. acquired condition caused by local irritation and is found more commonly in black skinned
people and in those who smoke
e. surface of the affect area may appear folded, creating a wrinkled, white streaked lesion
Following receiving dental treatment, a very sore ulceration is noticed on a child's lower lip. The
child has no history of labial trauma before entering the dental office. Which of the following
most likely explains this ulceration?
A. Herpes labialis
B. Post-anesthetic lip bite
C. Type IV allergic reaction to the latex in the rubber dam
D. Aphthous ulcer secondary to stress B. Post-anesthetic lip bite
A. Fibrous dysplasia
B. Osteosarcoma
C. Paget's disease of the bone
D. Florid ossesous dysplasia A. Fibrous dysplasia
1) Fibrous dysplasia
a. normal bone is replaced with fibrous bone tissue causing a "ground glass" appearance
radiographically
b. bones of the skull, thigh, shin, ribs, upper arm and pelvis are most commonly affected
c. 70% of cases is monostotic and involved one bone
d. occurs 50% more frequently in the mandible than in the maxilla
e. Radiographic Features
1) usually unilocular
2) radiopaque (usually) or radiolucent with a ground glass appearance
3) cortex is thinned and may be displaced
4) displaces anatomical structures and may or may not be displace teeth
5) poorly defined with no corticated border
6) loss of lamina dura
Which of the following dental sequelae would be MOST PROBABLE for a child to experience
if they exhibit growth failure "failure to thrive" in the first 6 months of their life?
A. Enamel hypoplasia
B. Mandibular hypoplasia
C. Microdontia
D. Midface hypoplasia
E. Dentinogenesis imperfecta A. Enamel hypoplasia
1) Enamel Hypoplasia
a. having signs and symptoms suggesting failure to thrive like enamel hypoplasia might also be
suffering from ectodermal dysplasia
b. Ectodermal hypoplasia
1) may affect all types of tissues that originated from the ectodermal embryonic layer
2) incomplete development of the following
a. hair
b. nails
c. sweat glands
d. enamel of teeth
e. oil glands
Which of the following types of dental anomalies manifests form a disturbance during the
initiation and proliferation stages of tooth development? Select all that apply.
A. Calcification
B. Mineralization
C. Number
D. Shape
E. Size A. Calcification
C. Number
2) Initiation
a. Hyperdontia = patient has more than the normal amount of teeth = supernumerary teeth
b. cleidocranial dysplasia =
An examination of a 22-year-old healthy patient reveals a solitary, asymptomatic, flat, round
3mm x 3mm brown lesion on the patient's lower lip. The duration of the lesion is unknown.
Which of the following describes the most probable condition?
A. Focal melanosis
B. Malignant melanoma
C. Papilloma
D. Peutz-Jeghers syndrome
E. Compound nevus A. Focal melanosis
1) Focal melanosis
a. flat, asymptomatic brown to black pigmentations of the lip or other oral sites which develop
for unknown reason
3) Melanotic macules
a. oval-shaped brown
b. smooth-bordered and flat lesions
c. less than 8mm in diameter (3-4)
d. mostly on the lower lip near the midline
Which of the following periodical conditions is associated with vital pulps most often?
1) Condensing Osteitis
a. periapical inflammatory disease resulting from a reaction to an infection of PERIODONTAL
origin, leading to bone apposition near root apices
b. common in premolars and molars
c. lesion appears as a radiopacity in the periodical area due to sclerotic reaction
d. sclerotic reaction results from a strong resistance of the patient and a low degree of virulence
of the offending bacteria
A patient who places aspirin directly into the oral vestibule, often sees a well-circumscribed
white patch on the mucosa where the aspirin was placed. What is the most likely description for
disease process in the affected tissue?
A. Atrophy
B. Focal hyperkeratosis
C. Focal hyperplasia
D. Hypertrophy
E. Tissue Necrosis E. Tissue Necrosis
1) Aspirin
a. contains acetyl salicylic acid which can cause acid burns within the mucosa of the oral cavity
b. acid within the aspirin binds to the lining epithelium and causes protein destruction that results
in acid burns of the mucosa
c. affected mucosa experiences burning pain as a result of coagulation necrosis
Which of the following conditions does an anterior crossbite usually indicate is present?
A. A Class II-division I malocclusion
B. A digit sucking habit
C. A self-correcting condition
D. A skeletal growth problem
E. A Class II-division II malocclusion D. A skeletal growth problem
1) Anterior crossbite
a. typically caused by a skeletal growth problem which affects the positioning of upper and lower
front teeth
b. cause by insufficient growth of maxilla while the mandibular growth appears to be normal
c. could also be due to the more forward position and growth of the mandible compared to the
maxilla
A 6-year0old patient presents to your office with acute primary herpetic gingivostomatitis, which
of the following would not help your patient?
1) Gingivostomatitis
a. inflammation of the oral mucosa and gingiva
b. cause by HSV-1 that affects children and leads to painful oral ulcerations
c. often the initial presentation during the primary herpes simplex infection
d. numerous pin-head vesicles, which rupture rapidly to form painful irregular ulcerations
covered by yellow-grey membranes
e. findings
1) sub-mandibular lymphadenitis
2) halitosis
3) refusal to drink
A. Cystic hygroma
B. Hemangioma
C. Hemangiopericytoma
D. Angiosarcoma A. Cystic hygroma
1) Cystic Hygroma
a. lymphatic malformations
b. congenital multiloculated lymphatic lesion that can arise anywhere, found mainly in the left
posterior triangle of the neck in children
c. considered the most common form of lymphangioma
d. contain large cyst-like cavities contain lymph and decrease in size as they approach the surface
of the skin surface
e. benign
f. can be disfiguring
g. Types
1) Macrosystic lymphatic malformations (large cysts)
2) Microcystic (small cysts)
Delayed eruption of permanent teeth can be cause by which of the following conditions?
A. Peutz-Jeghers syndrome
B. Hyperparathyroidism
C. Hyperthyroidism
D. Paget's disease of bone
E. Cherubism E. Cherubism
1) Cherubism
a. bony prominence in the lower portion in the face and uneruption of permanent teeth
b. associated with premature deciduous tooth loss due to the sponge-like quality of bone
c. associated with the uneruption of permanent teeth due to displacement of cysts and lesions
d. loss of bone in the mandible replaced with excessive amounts of fibrous tissue
e. condition should fade as child grows but may continue to disform the patient's face
Dentofacial Variations Dentofacial Variations Answers
Which of the following describes the MOST COMMON reason speech problems associated with
cleft lip and palate are observed?
A. Inability of the soft palate to close airflow into the nasal area; Inability of the tongue to stop
airflow from the epiglottis
B. Missing teeth that are involved in the articulation of sounds formed by the tongue difficult to
make
C. Poor lip musculature or heavy scars of the lips that limit vowel sound production
D. Poor tongue control and producing lisping A. Inability of the soft palate to close
airflow into the nasal area; Inability of the tongue to stop airflow from the epiglottis
1) Concept: In cleft lip and palate patients, an inability of the soft palate to close the nasal
passageways results in speech problems
2) Improper speech sounds are produced if the soft palate fails to prevent the flow of air into the
nasal passageways
3) It is important to close the nasal air passageways for producing distinct and understandable
sound.
4) The soft palate closes the nasal area for sound production.
Which of the following best describes adjunctive orthodontic treatment?
A. Early intervention using orthodontic therapy to prevent a more serious future malocclusion
B. Orthodontic therapies completed with only simple removable appliances
C. Orthodontic treatment to enhance the outcome of periodontal, prosthodontic, or operative
therapies
D. Limited orthodontic treatment of only anterior teeth for esthetics only C. Orthodontic
treatment to enhance the outcome of periodontal, prosthodontic, or operative therapies
3) Adjunctive orthodontics also eliminates unnecessary tooth attractions, tooth preparations, and
other periodontal, pre-prosthetic, or pre-restorative treatment to achieve more optimal outcomes.
A child with a distal step during the primary dentition will most likely develop into which of the
following permanent molar relationships?
A. Class II
B. Class III
C. Class I A. Class II
2) Mesial Step
a. Mesial step occlusion usually results in either Class I or Class III molar relationship after
eruption of permanent teeth
A. Frankfort Horizontal
B. SN-Pog
C. SNA
D. SNB
E. ANB C. SNA
A. 1st premolar
B. Central incisor
C. Lateral incisor
D. 2nd premolar
E. Canine E. Canine
1) Concept: Canines are the anterior teeth that are most likely to be unable to erupt within a
crowded dentition because the canine erupts after the incisors and premolars have already
erupted.
2) Tooth crowding may occur in patients with teeth that are too wide mesiodistally or if their
dental arch is too small to accommodate all the erupted teeth.
3) Tooth crowding carries a genetic predisposition because it is often a matter of tooth size vs.
arch size.
Malocclusion is classified by using which of the following planes of space?
2) All these are the orientation planes or the reference planes used to communicate the
dimensions of orthodontic problems.
A. 2nd trimester
B. 3rd trimester
C. Birth
D. 1st trimester A. 2nd trimester
2) During tooth formation, calcification of dental layers occurs within the 14th to 19th week in
utero.
2) Preventive orthodontics involves the evaluation and monitoring of the developing dentition of
patents ages 6 and below.
3) Normal occlusion can be achieved through the use of appliances to guide the growth and the
development of the developing dentition, bone, and musculature.
4) Crossbites can be corrected immediately during the primary dentition will help gain and
maintain the space for the secondary dentition.
A 9-year-old patient presents to your office with a unilateral posterior crossbite with a functional
shift. What is the appropriate timing for correction of the crossbite?
1) Concept: Unilateral poserior crossbones are best treated immediately after their diagnosis.
2) Treatment is most appropriate for children who are currently in the late deciduous stage or
mixed dentition stage.
3) Correction is suggested at this time because arch expansion is most successful at this age and
more space is created to correct the malalignment.
4) Early orthodontic intervention and treatment of unilateral posterior crossbite offers a better
prognosis and a higher treatment success rate.
In order to effectively translate the roots of teeth, orthodontic appliances must be which of the
following?
2) If the line of action of force passes through the center of resistance of a tooth, the tooth will
respond to pure bodily movement or translation of the roots.
3) All of the PDL is uniformly loaded during the translation movement. Approximately 100-
150g of force is needed to produce this movement.
The closure of which of the following spaces results in the late mesial shift of permanent 1st
molars?
A. Canine
B. Extraction
C. Interocclusal
D. Leeway
E. Primate D. Leeway
1) Concept: Leeway space is closed as the 1st permanent molars move medially after the
exfoliation of the primary 2nd molar and is usually seen among children from 11-12 years of
age.
2) Leeway space:
a. created from the difference of sizes between the primary canine and molars compared to the
erupting premolars and permanent canines
b. The discrepancy in size of primary molars and premolars created a free space that allows the
late medial migration of permanent 1st molar after the exfoliation of the primary 2nd molar.
A 6-year old presents to your office for extraction of L and S. The mandibular incisors have not
yet erupted. The indicated method of space maintenance for this patient is...
A. Band and loop
B. Distal shoe
C. Lower lingual holding arch
D. Nance appliance
E. No treatment needed, only observation A. Band and loop
3) Nance appliances
a. are cemented on the maxillary permanent 1st molars and have an acrylic button that rests on
the palate to resist forward movement
4) Hawley appliances
a. are used to actively move teeth, not necessarily maintain position in the dental arch
In the transitional analysis, which of the following dimensions are compared?
2) Predicting the sizes of unerupted permanent canine and premolars provide important
diagnostic information so the most appropriate treatment can be provided
3) Mixed dentition analysis is performed by determining the space available for the erupting
permanent teeth and comparing it to the appropriate size of the unerupted permanent canine and
premolars.
Which permanent teeth must erupt to prevent the mandibular intercanine width from increasing?
A. 1st premolar
B. 2nd premolar
C. Central Incisor
D. Lateral Incisor
E. Canine E. Canine
1) Concept: When permanent mandibular canine erupts, it moves mesially and maintains a stable
position within the corner of the mandibular arch.
2) Mandibular canines
a. are the corner tooth which, by definition, establishes the inter canine width of the mandibular
arch
b. As the mandibular canine push the lateral incisors in a mesial direction, they also prevent any
further increase in the intercanine width.
Which of the following is a mandibular plane angle that is higher than average associated with?
1) Concept: Because of a vertical growth pattern, the mandibular plane angle becomes steeper
and the lower anterior face height also simultaneously increases
2) Patients with deep overbites and a vertical growth pattern may exhibit steep mandibular plane
angles but NOT a long lower anterior face height due to the type of dental occlusion that the
patient demonstrates.
3) High mandibular plane angles elongate the face because of a lack of distinction between the
jaw line and the jaw angle.
A 10-year-old patient presents to your office with a 2.5mm diastema and low attached maxillary
labial frenum. Which of the following is the best option for this patient?
1) Concept: Eruption of maxillary canines in children ranging from age 11 to 12 usually will
close the diastema between the maxillary central incisors.
2) Diastema
a. Diastemas in between maxillary central incisors normally occur during the mixed dentition
stage.
3) Frenectomy will be indicated if the maxillary canines had already erupted and were unable to
close the diastema due to a lowly attached or fibrous maxillary labial frenum.
Which of the following teeth are measured to predict the size of the unerupted canines and
premolars when performing a Moyers mixed dentition analysis?
A. Depth
B. Height
C. Width C. Width
1) Concept: Of all the facial dimension, the width of the face remains constant throughout life.
2) The depth and height of a face undergo remarkable changes over the course of life due to loss
of teeth, loss in occlusal/vertical dimensions, and skin wrinkling from age.
Space for the mandibular 2nd and 3rd molar eruption is created through the bone...
1) Concept: The anterior border of the ramus undergoes resorption while bone is simultaneously
deposited of at the posterior border of the ramus.
2) Resorption of the ramus along its anterior border creates sufficient space for the eruption of
the 2nd and 3rd permanent molars.
3) The continuous resorption and deposition of bone along the borders of the ramus during the
growth stages helps maintain the ramus width while providing extra alveolar bone space for the
erupting molars.
Approximately what percentage of a permanent tooth's root structure has typically developed
when the tooth first emerges into the oral cavity?
A. 33%
B. 66%
C. 80%
D. 90%
E. 25%B. 66%
1) Concept: Approximately about 2/3 of the root should already be formed before the tooth
erupts into the oral cavity
2) Based on Nolla's stage of tooth eruption, the tooth begins to erupt when the root reaches about
2/3 of its complete form.
Which of the following teeth typically drift mesially?
1) Concept: Permanent maxillary 2nd molars typically drift medially following the loss of the
permanent maxillary 1st molar
2) The permanent maxillary 1st molars are among the first erupting teeth in the oral cavity.
Permanent maxillary 1st molars often decay and become unrestorable, or their extraction is
planned by an orthodontist to relieve crowding.
3) In such cases, permanent maxillary 2nd molars have a tendency to drift medially and take the
space of the permanent maxillary 1st molars. These teen quickly establish good contact with 2nd
premolars.
1) Concept: The cusp of Carabellis is a feature of the primary maxillary 2nd molar.
2) It is usually positioned at the mesiolingual cusp of the primary 2nd molar which could appear
as a small cusp or a triangular protrusion.
4) In PERMANENT dentition, the cusp of Carabelli is associated with the maxillary 1st molar.
How many roots are typically possess by the primary maxillary 1st molar
A. 2
B. 3
C. 4
D. 1 B. 3
1) Concept: Primary maxillary molars like permanent maxillary molars also present with three
roots.
2) The premolars that replace the maxillary molars usually have one of two roots.
1) Concept: Increases in maxillary height are due to the growth of alveolar bone which provides
enough space for the development and the eruption of teeth
2) Alveolar bone support the tooth as it erupts into the oral cavity.
A. 1st molar, central incisor, lateral incisor, 2nd molar, and canine
B. 1st molar, central incisor, lateral incisor, canine, 2nd molar
C. Central incisor, lateral incisor, 1st molar, canine, and 2nd molar
D. Central incisor, lateral incisor, canine, 1st molar, and 2nd molar C. Central incisor, lateral
incisor, 1st molar, canine, and 2nd molar
1) Concept: Central incisor, lateral incisor, 1st molar, canine, and 2nd molar
Note: this is an easy way to remember eruption sequences for deciduous teeth (6 month
intervals). Remember that mandibular dentition is normally before maxillary eruption.
Which of the following cephalometric measurements is likely to increase as a 13-year old child
with a Class III malocclusion ages?
A. SN
B. SNA
C. SNB
D. Y-Axis
E. ANB C. SNB
1) Concept: SNB angle will increase in value when the B point of the mandible extends more
anteriorly as demonstrates in a growing child with Class III malocclusion
2) SNB angle is the angle created by the intersection of Sella - Nasion plane and the B point of
the mandible.
3) SNB angle value is lower among patins with a Class I or Class II skeletal relationship as
compared with skeletal Class III patients.
Using a cervical pull headgear in the case of an 11-year-old prepubertal child should create each
of the following conditions EXCEPT one. Which is the EXCEPTION?
1) Concept: Cervical pull headgear is an appliance used to REDUCE the forward growth of the
maxilla and DOES NOT increase mandibular growth.
2) Cervical pull headgear is composed of the neck strap, and inner and outer face bow
a. The neck strap acts as an extra-oral anchorage
b. The outer bow connects the face bow assembly with the backstrap
c. The inner bow is inserted into the tubes found on the molar bands
d. inhibits the growth of the maxilla and causes the maxillary molars to extrude lessening the
deep bite
e. The headgear must be worn regularly for 14 hours per day for optimum results.
Which proper is most important for defining a tooth's character and individuality?
A. Color
B. Texture of enamel
C. Translucency
D. Shape B. Texture of enamel
1) Concept: Enamel texture is the most important factor in determining the individual character
of teeth.
A. Anterior crossbite
B. Anterior open bite
C. Asymmetric facial appearance
D. Ipsilaeral posterior open bite
E. Unilateral Class III malocclusion B. Anterior open bite
1) Concept: Condylar hypertrophy can affect the occlusal harmony of teeth and could even result
in facial asymmetry
3) With unilateral condylar hypertrophy the enlarged condyle lowers the jaw angle. The
symphysis of the affected jaw will then move towards the non affected side.
4) This can cause unilateral malocclusion, asymmetric facial appearance, possible anterior
crossbite, and ipsilateral posterior open bite
A. 10
B. 12
C. 14
D. 6
E. 8
F. 4 C. 14
1) Concept: Cervical pull headgear is an appliance used to correct Class II malocclusion with
deep bite.
2) Cervical pull headgear is composed of the neck strap, and inner and outer face bow
a. The neck strap acts as an extra-oral anchorage
b. The outer bow connects the face bow assembly with the backstrap
c. The inner bow is inserted into the tubes found on the molar bands
d. inhibits the growth of the maxilla and causes the maxillary molars to extrude lessening the
deep bite
e. The headgear must be worn regularly for 14 hours per day for optimum results.
Which of the following area is primary responsible for the vertical growth of the mandible?
A. Condylar Head
B. Coronoid process
C. Mental protuberance
D. Sigmoid Notch
E. Alveolar Process A. Condylar Head
1) Concept: Growth of the condylar head is most responsible for the increase in mandibular
vertical height
2) Growth of the alveolar process, coronoid process, mental protuberance, and sigmoid notch do
not push the mandible away from the cranium, and therefore are not responsible for the increase
in vertical facial height
The facial profile of most people change as they age and mature through becoming...
A. Less convex
B. More convex
C. The same level of convexity
D. Less concave A. Less convex
1) Concept: The facial profile may vary as we age due to the loss of facial fat, muscle atrophy,
and loss of skin elasticity.
2) The buccal fat pad is gradually lost in the cheeks, causing the skin to adapt itself to the
underlying muscles and bone
3) During the aging process, metabolism slows down and the production of skin, collagen, and
muscle fibers is reduced.
4) The constant pull of gravity also contributes to the sagging of the face.
Behavior Behavior Answers
Alec is hyperactive child that has trouble paying attention, which medication might be prescribed
to help him?
A. Alpraxolam
B. Clonadine
C. Methylphenidate
D. Doxapram C. Methylphenidate
1) Mehylphenidate
a. psychostimulant approved in treating people with attention-deficit hyperactivity (ADHD)
b. reduces the dopamine and norepinephrine reuptake, increasing their levels thereby improving
their function as neurotransmitters in the brain.
c. similar pharmacological effect to cocaine but lower potency and the duration is longer
When communicating with pediatric patients which principle should be employed?
A. Both parent and dentist communicate with the child at the time
B. IM ketamine 20mg/kg
C. Immediately use voice control so that you can establish a power dynamic from the beginning
that the child will respect
D. Substitute easily understandable words and concepts for dental terminology (e.g. make your
tooth fall asleep for anesthesia)
E. Only have the parent answer questions since they know what is happening and can accurately
report D. Substitute easily understandable words and concepts for dental terminology (e.g. make
your tooth fall asleep for anesthesia)
Which of the following agents is the MOST APPROPRIATE to administer to a 5-year-old child
that is shy, fearful, and timid?
A. Promethazine only
B. Fentanyl
C. Hydroxyzine hydrochloride
D. Nitrous oxide/oxygen
E. Promethazine and meperidine D. Nitrous oxide/oxygen
A. Empathetic
B. Overindulgent
C. Overprotective
D. Under-affectionate
E. Under-attentive C. Overprotective
1) Overprotective parents
a. overprotective nature of parents leads to shyness in children
b. show submissive behavior in society and their social circle
c. personality development of these children remains incomplete
d. produce a lack of confidence in their children which results a permanent psychological trauma
in them which they carry with them forever
Which of the following is NOT one of the 5 domains of pediatric patient management?
A. Aversive (punishments)
B. Linguistic
C. Pharmacological
D. Physical
E. Reward oriented
F. Authoritative D. Physical
1) Physical
a. physical means to control patient misbehavior and promote positive behavior of pediatric
patient
b. usually achieved using papoose boards, belts, tape and cloth wraps to keep them restrained
2) Pharmacological
a. anesthetics, sedative drugs and inhalers to make a child calm during dental treatment
3) Rewards
a. uses rewards to reinforce good behavior from pediatric patients
4) Aversive
a. parental spanking and the hand-over-mouth technique
5) Linguistic
a. requires the dentist to be a good communicator, a coach and a friend for the pediatric patient to
promote good patient behavior
b. necessitates that the child be able to comprehend language
Which of the following is a general description of children exhibiting what is classified as
defiant behavior?
1) Defiant behavior
a. too much pampering by parents makes their children act spoiled and stubbornly
b. want to get things done in their own way in spite of the consequences
c. do NOT like to be advised by their elders
d. must be death with positive reinforcement
Which of the following methods describes the MOST CONVENIENT way to conduct an
examination of an 18-month-old child?
A. A parent sitting in the dental chair with the child sitting on their lap facing forward
B. This child sitting in the dental chair with a parent sitting chair side
C. The clinician and a parent in a knee-to-knee position with the child's head in the clinician's lap
D. The clinician and a parent in a knee-to-knee position with the child's head in the parent's lap
C. The clinician and a parent in a knee-to-knee position with the child's head in the
clinician's lap
1) Knee-to-knee position
a. helps to build a relation of trust and confidence between the clinician and the patient
b. child feels more comfortable and safe while facing his/her parent
c. dentist gets maximum visibility to examine the oral cavity and facial structures
d. most convenient way for carrying out examination of an infant
Familiarization is a technique to best manage fearful pediatric patients who
1) Familiarization
a. psychological behavior management technique meant to help children relax while inside the
dental clinic
b. introducing the dental setting and the common instrument that are used in the clinic in order to
remove the fear from pediatric patients
c. demonstrates the dental instruments and that there is not anything to fear by their use is the
child's mouth
Systemic Pathology Systemic Pathology Answers
Which of the following is NOT a MAJOR sign/symptom of rheumatic fever based on Jones
criteria?
A. Carditis
B. Chorea/dyskinesia
C. Fever
D. Polyarthritis
E. Erythema marginatum C. Fever
1) Concept: Rheumatic fever is an inflammatory disease that occurs after a Strep progenies
infection or scarlet fever and is caused by antibody cross reactivity from the Strep M protein
2) Fever is considered a MINOR criteria under the Jones classification, not a MAJOR criteria.
1) Polyarthritis
a. a temporary migrating inflammation of the large joints, usually starting in the legs and
migrating upwards
2) Carditis
a. inflammation of the heart muscle (myocarditis) which can manifest as congestive heart failure
with shortness of breath, pericarditis with a rub, or a new heart murmur
3) Subcutaneous nodules
a. painless, firm collections of collagen fibers over bones or tendons.
b. They commonly appear on the back of the writs, the outside elbow, and the front of the knees
4) Erythema marginatum
a. a long-lasting reddish rash that begins on the trunk or arms as macules, which spread outward
and clear in the middle to form rings, which continue to spread and coalesce with other rings,
ultimately taking on a snake-like appearance
A. Atrial fibrillation
B. Cardiovascular collapse
C. Hyperventilation
D. Hypoxia
E. Hypotension B. Cardiovascular collapse
1) Concept: Patients suffering from adrenal insufficiency are at risk of cardiovascular collapse
when subjected to highly stressful situations
2) Continuous low cortisol levels during stressful events, contribute a lower cardiac output and
low blood pressure that could eventually lead to cardiovascular collapse.
3) Adrenal insufficiency occurs when the adrenal glands produce insufficient amount of steroid
hormones like cortisol and aldosterone
4) Cortisol
a. stimulate gluconeogenesis in the liver. Cortisol also helps maintain normal blood pressure
during stressful situations and creates additional energy to cope up with such stress.
b. increases blood pressure by increasing the vasculature sensitivity to epinephrine and
norepinephrine which stimulate cardiac output
A patient's radiographs display bulbous crowns, obliterated pulps, and shortened roots. Which of
the following conditions is described by these findings?
A. Gardner's syndrome
B. Osteogenesis imperfecta
C. Pierre Robin syndrome
D. Scleroderma
E. Amelogenesis imperfecta B. Osteogenesis imperfecta
2) Types
1) Type I
a. collagen is of normal quality but is produced in insufficient quantities
b. blue sclera
c. bones fracture easily
2) Type II
a. collagen is not of a sufficient quality of quantity
b. most cases die within the first year of life due to respiratory failure or intracerebral
hemorrhage
c. severe respiratory problems due to underdeveloped lungs
d. severe bone deformity and small stature
Which of the following has not been proved to be a causative factor in human pro-facial clefting?
A. Anticonvulsant drugs
B. Malnourishment
C. Tylenol
D. Vitamin imbalance C. Tylenol
2) Cleft lip
a. occurs when the frontomaxillary process and maxillary processes that form the upper lip fail to
fuse together
3) Cleft palate
a. occurs when the palatal shelves that grown medially towards each other fail to fuse
4) During the sixth week in utero, the embryo undergoes these processes ad is very sensitive to
environmental pollutants and malnutrition
For patients suffering from type I diabetes, which of the following precautions should be
observed.
1) Concept: Diabetic patients must maintain a normal serum glucose level before, during and
after the dental treatment to prevent any further complications.
2) The intake of food will prevent the diabetic patient from having hypoglycemia. Severe
hypoglycemia if not properly managed will result in patient's unconsciousness, seizures, and
even death if not managed properly.
A. Cystic fibrosis
B. Diabetes Type I
C. Mercury poisoning
D. Acquired immune deficiency syndrome A. Cystic fibrosis
1) Concept: Cystic fibrosis is a genetic disorder resulting in the inability of the body to bring salt
and water in and out of cells.
2) The situation results in the excessive production of sticky and viscous mucus in the lungs and
digestive tract.
3) Cystic fibrosis also affects the production of digestive enzymes that break down fats, causing
them NOT be absorbed, resulting in a fatty stool called steatorrhea.
4) Cystic fibrosis also affect the reproductive system and alters the function of sweat glands in
the body.
Which of the following disorders is characterized by a delayed ossification of midline structures
and supernumerary teeth?
A. Cleidocranial dysostosis
B. Ectodermal dysplasia
C. Neurofibromatosis
D. Osteogenesis imperfecta
E. Amelogenesis imperfecta A. Cleidocranial dysostosis
A. Beriberi
B. Diabetes Mellitus
C. Pelegra
D. Polycystic kidney disease
E. Systemic lupus erythematosus B. Diabetes Mellitus
1) Concept: Diabetes Mellitus is a systemic disease that lowers the body's immune response
because of an altered cell mediated immune response
2) Effects
a. Impaired neutrophil chemotaxis, causing slower reaction against pathogens and faster rate of
progression of infection
b. Impaired would healing potential since blood flow to tissue is decreased
c. Peripheral and autonomic neuropathy
d. Chronic kidney disease
e. Cardiovascular disease
f. Eye related problems
Which disorder is a considered a chromosomal abnormality that is a result of either chromosomal
nondisjunction or translocation?
A. Ehler-Danlos syndrome
B. Klinefelter syndrome
C. Turner syndrome
D. Trisomy 21 (Down syndrome) D. Trisomy 21 (Down syndrome)
2) Trisomy 21 occurs before of meiotic nondisjunction, which is a situation where a gamete from
a parent contains excess chromosomes.
3) Affected gametes posses 24 chromosomes instead of only 23 which upon combining with a
"normal" gamete, will form an embryo that has 47 chromosomes with three set of chromosomes
21.
Which of the following is not a characteristic of ectodermal dysplasia?
A. Atrophic skin
B. Blue sclera
C. Defective hair
D. Hypoplastic sweat glands
E. Hypodontia (oligodontia) B. Blue sclera
1) Concept: Blue scleras are NOT a characteristic of Ectodermal dysplasia, but are a clinical sign
that usually manifests in diseases like Osteogenesis imperfect, Ehlers-Danlos syndrome, and
Marfan syndrome
2) Ectodermal dysplasia
a. group of genetic disorders which occur due to poor development of organs and body structures
that are ectodermal in origin
b. may cause abnormal development of failure of formation of the structures within the body that
originate from the ectoderm which includes the teeth, skin, hair, and sweat glands
In patients suffering from multiple sclerosis...
A. Anesthetic dosage required for a given procedure is more than for a normal patient
B. Anesthetics do not last as long as it would for a normal patient
C. Epinephrine in local anesthetics are contraindicated
D. Anesthetic dosage required for a given procedure is less than for a normal patient C.
Epinephrine in local anesthetics are contraindicated
1) Concept: Epinephrine should not be used for patients suffering from multiple sclerosis
because epinephrine can aggravate the condition by regulating the activation of blood
lymphocytes.
2) Epinephrine is a cetecholamine and neurotransmitter responsible for the body's flight- or flight
response.
3) Elevating the levels of epinephrine also increases blood lymphocyte activity which could
cause further damage to the myelin sheaths of the neurons thereby aggravating multiple sclerosis
condition.
Which of the following age groups is most likely to incur primary herpetic gingivostomatitis?
A. 11-15 years
B. 16-20 years
C. 21-25 years
D. 6-10 years
E. 1-5 years E. 1-5 years
1) Concept: Vesicles commonly appear on the gingiva, oral mucosa, and vermilion border and
usually affects children 5 years old or less.
2) Herpetic gingivostomatitis
a. an acute viral disease cause by the herpes simplex virus
1) Concept: The canines often erupt before the mandibular premolars and crowding of anterior
teeth may occur if the normal eruption sequence is disrupted.
3) In serial extraction cases, primary canines are extracted when a child reaches age 8 of 9 to
facilitate incisor alignment. The primer 1st molars are extracted after one year to speed up
eruption of 1st premolars. The erupted 1st premolars are then extracted to facilitate canine
eruption and alignment in the arch.
Which of the following clinical signs is indicative of acute herpetic gingivostomatitis?
A. Depression
B. Gastro-intestinal disturbance
C. Moon face
D. Striae
E. Weight gain
F. Buffala Hump B. Gastro-intestinal disturbance
2) Cushing's syndrome describes the signs and symptoms associated with prolonged exposure to
inappropriately high levels of the hormone cortisol
b, can be caused by taking glucocorticoid or diseases that result in excess cortisol,
adrenocorticotropic hormone (ACTH), or CRH levels.
c. Signs and symptoms include:
1) Extreme weight gain
2) Buffalo hump (fat deposition in the upper central back)
3) Moodiness, irritability, or depression
4) Muscle and bone weakness
5) Memory and attention dysfunction
6) Osteoporosis
7) Diabetes Mellitus
8) Hypertension
9) Immune suppresion
10) Sleep disturbances
11) Menstrual disorders such as amenorrhea in women and decreased fertility in men
12) hirsutism
13) baldness
14) hypercholesterolemia
15) edema
C: Cataracts
U: Up all night (sleep disturbances)
S: Suppression of HPA axis
H: Hypertension
I: Infections
N: Necrosis (avascular)
G: Gain Weight
S: Striae
B: Buffalo Hymp
A: Acne
D: Diabetes
M: Myopathy, moon faces
D: Depression and emotional changes
Which of the following describes the MOST common form of leukemia observed in pediatric
patients?
A. Granulocytic
B. Lymphoblastic
C. Monocytic
D. Myelomonocytic
E. Eosinophilic B. Lymphoblastic
1) Concept: Acute lymphoblastic leukemia (ALL) is also called acute lymphocytic leukemia
accounts for 3/4 of the cases of childhood leukemia
2) Almost all cases of childhood leukemia are acute, which means they develop rapidly. A very
low number are chronic and develop slowly.
A. Hemophilia B
B. Hypoparathyroidism
C. Leukemia
D. Sickle cell anemia
E. Hemophilia A C. Leukemia
1) Concept: Leukemia
a. type of cancer of the blood or bone marrow characterized by an abnormal increase of
immature white blood cells
b. white blood cells or leukocytes are involved in the immune response of the body to infection
and inflammation
c. Due to the central role of leukocytes in the development and propagation of inflammation,
defects in leukocyte function often result in a decreased capacity for inflammatory defense with
subsequent vulnerability to infection.
2) Hemophilia
a. describes an abnormality in the clotting pathway, which does not interfere with the
inflammatory process
A. Maxilla
B. Palatine
C. Sphenoid
D. Turbinate
E. Ethmoid D. Turbinate
1) Turbinate
a. narros and sea-shell appearing bone that extends ion the nasal air passage
b. have 4 grooved air channels which divides and forces the inspired air to flow steadily into the
nasal passages
c. responsible for warming, humidifying, and filtering the inhaled air
The major reason for loss of transplanted autogenous 3rd molars is
A. immune rejection
B. inadequate root length
C. traumatic occlusion
D. infection C. traumatic occlusion
1) The failure of autogenous tooth transplants which include chronic root resorption,
inflammatory resorption, marginal and apical periodontitis, dental caries and occlusal trauma.
2) 3rd molars used for autogensou tooth transplant procedures most commonly fail due to their
inability to withstand the heavy occlusal forces that exist in the posterior during mastication
3) Due to the mechanical advantage of a type III lever like the jaw, occlusal forces increases as
you move posteriorly in the mouth (closer to the fulcrum/condyle).
The primary symptoms to demonstrate when midazolam (Versed) has been injected intra-
arterially rather than intravenously is:
1) Intra-arterial injection of midazolam stated that some of the patients experiences moderate to
severe pain within the extremity where it was administered.
2) Adverse reactions from accidental intra-arterial injection can be localized within the site of
injection or systemic.
A 14-year-old patient presents with an indurated and asymptomatic swelling in the mandibular
premolar area. All teeth tested vital. Radiographs reveal a discrete 41mm radiolucency in the
premolar area. Which of the following diagnostic procedures should be done to discern the
proper diagnosis?
1) After evaluating the diagnostic data, the next step is to determine the type of cells within the
lesion through needle biopsy.
2) Histopathologic examination of cells within a lesion can determine if the lesions neoplastic or
not.
3) Combining the radiographic, visual, physical and histopathologic assessment of the lesion
improves the changes of arriving at a correct diagnosis and the proper treatment.
A chronic infection of the mandible of a middle-aged female patient was treated with oral Pen
Vk for 3 weeks. The primary infections appears to be resolved, but the patient now has white
patches on the dorsum of her tongue and buccal mucosa. Which of the following is the suggested
treatment for this patient?
1) Prolonged intake of antibiotics disturbs the balance of the microflora in the mouth by killing
the "normal" bacteria, allowing the fungal species like Candida albicans to grow unhindered by
competition.
2) The white patches on the dorsal surface of the tongue that appeared after prolonged antibiotic
uses are caused by the increased number of Candida albicans.
Surgery Surgery Answers
Which of the following does a clinician place a mucosal graft onto in order to directly increase
the anterior mandibular vestibular depth?
A. Bone
B. Epithelium
C. Mucosa
D. Muscle
E. Periosteum E. Periosteum
1) Mucosal Grafts
a. clinicians place a mucosal graft directly onto the periosteum in order to increase the anterior
mandibular vestibular depth
b. have good prognosis with minimal chances of graft rejection
c. periosteum has a rich blood supply that promotes healing and a quick connection to the graft
d. less successful when placed directly over the bone, mucosa, muscle, or epithelium
Which of the following portions of a forceps is most likely to accidentally crush the lip of a
patient?
A. Beak
B. Balde
C. Handle
D. Hinge
E. Shank D. Hinge
1) Hinge
a. of the forceps lies nearest to the lips during the extraction procedure and is the most likely
portion to cause lip injury
b. adaptation of the forces beak and blade into the tooth will have the hinge approximating the
lower lip, especially during the extraction of posterior teeth
2) Handle
a. is held by the dentist and will less likely cause lip damaged when properly handled.
A patient presents with a large facial laceration with irregular/necrotized wound margins. Which
of the following surgical principles should you follow when making an elliptical incision to
achieve primer closure?
1) Incision lines should be made parallel to the dermatologic skin tension lines
a. to reduce scar visibility after wound healing
b. necrotized margin should be removed minimally
c. enables the most optimal primary wound closure and will not distort the skin's normal flow,
allowing the scar to blend in better
d. length of the elliptic incision should be 3 times its width in an ideal guide for making an
elliptical incision
e. will create a better esthetic appearance after wound healing
Which of the following describes the structure where the beaks of extraction forceps are
designed to transmit extraction pressure to?
A. Cementoenamel junction
B. Crowns of teeth being extracted
C. Roots of the tooth
D. Alveolar bone C. Roots of the tooth
1) Roots of tooth
a. optimal place to apply apical force in order to not fracture the crown during the extraction
procedure
b. enables the apical force to be transmitted effectively along the long axis of the tooth, which
results in the expansion of the alveolar bone and the eventual extraction of the tooth
Which of the following describes an alveoloplasty procedure?
1) Alveoloplasty
a. smoothing and recontouring of alveolar bone to create a typography favorable for proper
wound healing and denture support
2) Types
3) Post extraction alveoloplasty
a. removes the alveolar ridge to remove knife edge residual ridges and spiny bony projections
which are not good denture stress bearing areas
b. remove undesirable ridge undercuts which alter the path of denture placement and
consequently affect retention
4) Cortical alveoloplasty
a. recontours and smooths bone so that no spiny bone projections or sharp bone margins are
present to ensure optimal healing
5) Intraseptal alveoloplasty
a. removes labial undercuts, reduces maxillary over-ject and recontours cortical bone by
removing interradicular bone and collapsing the cortical plates preserving dentures stress bearing
area
Which of the following is the goal of alveoloplasty procedure?
C. To make sure that undercuts that interfere with the denture seating are removed
D. To make the residual ridge as broad as possible even if undercuts are still present C. To
make sure that undercuts that interfere with the denture seating are removed
1) Alveoloplasty
a. promote better denture support and stability during function be creating an ideal alveolar ridge
form
b. removes undesirable undercuts that impede proper seating of dentures and round-off knife
edge alveolar ridges to provide better support during function
If there is insufficient oral mucosa to achieve closure when repairing an alveolar cleft, the most
common method to achieve closure is...
A. Dermal transplant
B. Freeze-dried dura
C. Stem cell pack
D. Teflon-proplast
E. A tongue/pedicle flap E. A tongue/pedicle flap
1) Pedicle Flap
a. indicated in cases where mucosa quantity is insufficient to securely cover the wound opening
or cleft
b. created with a portion of its base remaining attached from the original site so that a blood
supply is still present within the flap even after repositioning it to cover the wound opening
c. best option for wound closures and carry a high rate of success
10 days following an incision and drainage of a submandibular space abscess, the patient returns
to your office. The swelling has slightly increased even though the patient was prescribed high
dose antibiotics. Which of the following treatments is indicated for this patient?
1) Cortical plates can be compressed after the interradicular bone is removed to remove ridge
undercuts
2) Interradicular bone provides the thickness of separation between the labial and palatal cortical
bone
A vestibuloplasty procedure is performed by...
1) Vestibuloplasty
a. procedure performed to lengthen the residual ridge and deepen the oral vestibule
b. relocating or repositioning the muscle attachments and mucous membranes covering it into a
deeper or more apical position
c. also accompanied with the use of a mucosal graft or a skin graft
Which of the following surgical procedures is MOST COMMONLY used to correct maxillary
retrognathia?
A. Inverted L osteotomy
B. LeFort I Osteotomy
D. Bilateral sagittal-split ostetomy
E. Lefort III Osteotomy B. LeFort I Osteotomy
1) LeFort I Osteotomy
a. most commonly used surgical treatment intervention for maxillary repositioning
b. complete mobilization of the maxillary segments is carried out and repositioning is done
c. bleeding control and vascular preservation are important to avoid macular necrosis during the
procedure
d. characterized by an abnormal growth of jaws in which the maxillary growth becomes retarded.
Maxilla becomes short and mandible looks forward in relation to it.
Skin grafts provide which of the following functions after a vestibuloplasty procedure is
completed?
1) Vestibuloplasty
a. surgeon displaces the muscle attachments in the periosteum of the jaw to deepen the vestibule
and expose more alveolar bone needed to create a residual ridge that will provide more denture
support
b. in detaching a portion of these muscles, more residual ridge becomes more exposed and a new
vestibular depth is established
c. muscles that were detached have a tendency to readapt to the previous location within the
periosteum. In order to maintain the new positioning and prevent muscular reattachment as the
previous spot, a skin graft is placed that attaches to the periosteum of the exposed alveolar bone.
The graft with the greatest osteogenic potential is which of the following?
C. Hemopoietic marrow
D. Corticocencellous block C. Hemopoietic marrow
1) Hemopoietic marrow
a. contains cells that possess osteogenic potential and can differentiate into bone or cartilage
depending on what is needed by the body
Procedures
1) Facture maxillary tuberosity can be repositioned and held in place with a suture provided that
there is evidence of an intact blood supply
2) Recovery rates of fracture bone fragments are higher if they are properly repositioned within
the fracture site with an adequate blood supply
3) Bone fragments that are completely detached and devoid of blood supply will result in bone
necrosis
Paraympathetic innerviation is carried by which of the following cranial nerves?
A. II, V, IX, X
B. III, V, VII, IX
C. III, VII, IX, X
D. IV, VII, VIII, X
E. II, III, VII, IX C. III, VII, IX, X
3) CN IX = glossopharyngeal nerve
a. innervate the parotid salivary gland
4) CN X = vagus nerve
a. innervation to the digestive organs and the heart
What type of flap is most commonly indicated for the surgical removal of a mesiodens?
Steps
a. evaluate all the diagnostic data, the next step in diagnosis is to determine the type of cells
within the lesion through needle biopsy
b. histopathologic examination of cells within a lesion can determine if the lesion is neoplastic or
not
c. combine the radiographic, visual, physical, and histopathologic assessment of the lesion
improves the chances of arriving at correct diagnosis and the proper treatment
A periosteal elevator is NOT normally used to...
B. luxate teeth
C. protect the tissue flap from instruments B. luxate teeth
1) Periosteal elevator
a. not designed to adapt to the tooth deep in the alveolar socket
b. tips of periosteal elevators are thin and wide and are designed to elevate the soft tissue from
the bone
c. used to elevate the interdental papilla during surgical and non-surgical extractions
d. can also be used as retractors and protect tissue flaps from other dental instruments during an
operation
When removing a mandibular lingual torus from the premolar region of a patient, the flap should
include which of the following?
A. Incised at the junction of the attached gingival tissue and free mucosa
B. No vertical components
C. Possess only a posterior component
D. Anterior and Posterior vertical components B. No vertical components
1) Vertical incision
a. is NOT necessary because the small amount of attached gingiva on the lingual aspect as well
as the proximity of the tori to the floor of the mouth
b. placed along the lingual aspect are difficult to suture due to the thickness of mucosa and its
proximity to the tongue and accessibility of the incision
c. contraindicated within areas that have inferior concavities or bony prominences
d. full thickness envelope flaps are sufficient to provide adequate access for the removal of the
mandibular tori
The most common postoperative concern following bilateral sagittal split osteotomy procedures
is...
A. Increased retention
B. Increased rigidity
C. Increased strength
D. More tooth structure is conserved D. More tooth structure is conserved
1) External splints
a. always recommended for use when conservation of tooth structure is of prime importance
b. less retention
c. less rigidity compared to the internal splints
2) Internal splints
a. require removal of tooth structure in order to be used
During the extraction of a mandibular molar, he medial root is fractured. The coronal portion,
distal root, and half of the medial root were delivered intact. What instrument should be used to
remove the remnants of the medial root?
A. Crane pick
B. Cryer elevator
C. Rongeurs
D. Straight elevator
E. Lower universal forceps B. Cryer elevator
1) Cryer elevator
a. can be used to gain access by easily removing the intraradicular bone and elevating the
remaining root fragment
2) Crane picks
a. indicated for the delicate removal of smaller root fragments
3) Rongeurs
a. indicated for bone removal, not extraction of teeth
Which of the following correctly describes the position of the mandibular condyle during a
procedure to correct mandibular prognathism?
A. Advanced
B. Intruded
C. Protruded
D. Retruded
E. Unaltered E. Unaltered
1) Condyle Position
a. Recording of the position of the mandibular condyle during correction of mandibular
prognathism should be done without any alteration
b. In normal practice, the mandibular condyle position is recorded in protrusion.
c. Patients of mandibular prognathism have condyles already in a protruded state.
Elevators are instruments that are designed to...
1) Elevators
a. instruments used to elevate the tooth out of its socket
b. designed to engage the root portion of the tooth below the cementoenamel junction
c. inserted into the periodontal ligament space, create more room for tooth movement, and help
elevate the tooth out of its socket
Which of the following is the principal reason dressings are used to treat localized alveolar
osteitis (dry socket)?
A. to enhance blood clot formation
B. to prevent salivary contamination of the surgical site
C. to promote epithelial growth
D. to provide a vehicle for the obtundent medication
E. to stimulated osteoblastic reconstruction of the surgical site E. to stimulated osteoblastic
reconstruction of the surgical site
1) Dressings
a. placed inside the dry socket to stimulate the osteoblastic reconstruction of the surgical site
b. promote clot formation in the socket and enhance healing
c. changed on alternate days to speed up the healing process
A. #1 Woodson
B. Bone file
C. Highspeed handpiece
D. Rongeur
E. Finger * C. Highspeed handpiece
1) Non surgical extractions with sharp bone margins and spiny interseptal bone present indicate
cortical alveoloplasty should be performed.
2) Bone is recontoured and smoothened into a more desirable contour to enable a better wound
healing, using a surgical hand piece.
Bone marrow grafts for jaw defects are typically harvested from which of the following sites?
A. A cadeaver
B. A rib
C. Illiac crest
D. Mandibular parasymphysis
E. Maxillary tuberosity C. Illiac crest
1) Iliac crest
a. most suitable location for harvesting grafts for jaw defects because of its large size as well as
the fact that it contains both cortical as wells the cancellous bone
2) Cortical bone
a. present on the outside while cancellous bone is located inside
b. best for load bearing areas
3) Cancellous bone
a. has a rich blood supple
b. high surface area
Each of the following should be used by a dentist to assess the dental fears of a patient EXCEPT
ONE. Which is the EXCEPTION?
A. Personality
B. Physical response
C. Verbal statements
D. Behavior A. Personality
1) Personality
a. gives the dentist an idea of the patient's character and capacity to cooperate or interact but
cannot be used to assess their dental fears
2) Behavior
a. provides relevant information on their perception of dental treatment
3) Physical response
a. provides significant cues to their dental fears
4) Verbal cues
a. may directly or indirectly suggest the patient's fears and concerns before and during dental
procedures
Which of the following instruments can be used to hold soft tissue that is not to be excised?
A. Adson forceps
D. Allis forceps A. Adson forceps
1) Adson forceps
a. designed with a small tip used to hold tissue that will not undergo excision
b. have a fine tip, they are best used in holding soft tissues that are located along the small spaces
inside the mouth
c. have small teeth that allows it to hold and grip the soft tissues in a precise manner
d. can be used in holding suture during suture cutting and removal
Which of the following is NOT an oral surgery technique/principle that can be used to minimize
the likelihood of a buccal plate fracture?
1) Buccal plate
a. brittle cortical plate that fractures during oral surgical procedure when too much and abrupt
force during lunation is applied in a buccal direction
2) Cortical bone
a. cannot withstand too much pressure during the luxation of tooth, unlike cancellous bone that
expands with pressure
1) Caldwell-Luc operation
a. incision is made in the area of canine fossa above the canine or premolar roots
b. an opening or window is made in the anterior wall of the maxillary sinus.
c. root is retrieved through this opening and the opening is sutured
d. Indications for
1) retrieval of a broken tooth root from the maxillary sinus
2) removal of abnormal tissue growths
3) treatment of maxillary infections
The primary etiology of for the failure of tooth replantation is which of the following:
B. external resorption
C. infection
D. internal resorption
E. pulp necrosis
F. ankylosis B. external resorption
1) External Resorption
a. most common cause of failure of tooth replantation
b. Types
1) External replacement resorption
2) External inflammatory resorption
a. caused by infection following a failed root canal treatment
b. external resorption also depends upon the degree of PDL damage
Loops and helices are incorpated into arch wire to...
1) Needle holder
a. beaks are shorter and thicker
b. designed to provide grip and stability while holding the needle in place during suturing
2) Hemostats
a. beaks are a bit longer and thinner
b. designed to hold the tissues together to control bleeding
All or part of which of the following muscles is detached when a clinician lowers the floor of the
mouth of a patient?
2) Mylohyoid muscle
a. paired muscle running from the mandible to the hyoid bone, forming the oral cavity
3) Genioglossus
a. muscle which runs from the chin to the tongue
Which of the following methods should NOT be used in the extraction of a mandibular 1st molar
with severe coronal decay?
1) Diazepam
a. good sedative but a very addictive drug as well
b. prolonged use may lead to dependency, tolerance, and physical dependence
2) Pentobarbital
a. barbiturates and is known as depressant of the nervous system
b. due to its potent effect, it is used in sedation and for people suffering from insomnia and even
reported seizures
c. its continuous use could cause drug dependency and is therefore prescribed in a well
controlled and limited period
3) Meperidine
a. opiate sedative drug that is less addictive but still could pose a tendency for dependency when
used frequently
b. it could also cause euphoria making it more tempting to be abused
Administration of a schedule 2 narcotic with an anti-psychotic drug creates...
A. Conscious sedation
B. Neuroleptic analgesia
C. Psychotomimetic analgesia
D. Dissociative anesthesia B. Neuroleptic analgesia
1) Neuroleptic analgesia
a. combined effect of using narcotics with antipsychotic agents
b. patients under neuroleptic analgesia show some degree of quiescence (quietness), alteration of
awareness, and some analgesia
Which of the following patient health histories would make the use of nitrous oxide sedation
CONTRAINDICATED?
A. Controlled hypertension
B. Dental anxiety
C. Diabetes Type I
D. Diabetes Type II
E. Psychotic care E. Psychotic care
A. Lidocaine
B. Lisinopril
C. Propranolol
D. Quinidine
E. Verapamil A. Lidocaine
1) Lidocaine
a. Intravenous injection of lidocaine may be useful to suppress symptomatic ventricular
arrhythmias.
b. Routine lidocaine use can reduce the occurrence rate of primary ventricular fibrillation to
some extent.
c. intravenous lidocaine prophylaxis for patients with acute myocardial infarction in a coronary
care unit is not recommended
The settings for the nitrous oxide oxygen sedation devices are: 4 liters/min oxygen and 3
liters/min nitrous oxide. At what concentration is the oxygen being administered?
A. 43%
B. 57%
C. 75%
D. 98%
E. 33%B. 57%
1) The nitrous oxide and oxygen ratio having 4 liters/min oxygen and 3 liters/min nitrous oxide
shows a 57% oxygen concentration.
2) In order to determine the percentage of oxygen use in the nitrous oxide administration, you
must divide the liters/min of the gas desired by the total amount of gas being delivered/minute.
A. 25%
B. 50%
C. 95%
D. 100% B. 50%
1) The pressure regulator measure the gas pressure of the cylinder, and when the pressure shows
50% because oxygen remains as a gas when it is compressed at room temperature and does NOT
become a liquid like N2O.
2) Oxygen cylinders come in a variety of sizes and each use and size is designated by a series of
numbers and letters.
3) The number on the side of the tank denotes the number of liters of oxygen the cylinder holds.
The letters A, B, C, D, and E designate the size of the cylinder.
The "A" cylinder is the smallest cylinder with 34 liters of compressed oxygen; and E cylinder is
one of the largest (680 liters).
Nitrous oxide sedation of a patient should always be concluded with the administration of 100%
oxygen to prevent...
A. Hypercarbia
B. Hyperventilation
C. Hypoxia
D. Tachycardia
E. Hypotension C. Hypoxia
1) Hypoxia
a. Administering oxygen immediately after nitrous oxide sedation increases the concentration of
oxygen in the blood thereby diminishing the occurrence of hypoxia.
b. Hypoxia may occur with patients sedated with nitrous oxide with the gas mixture administered
has a low oxygen concentration.
c. After being sedated with nitrous oxide, 100% oxygen is administered to completely clear the
nitrous oxide in the system and help the patient recover faster from sedation.
Which of the following does NOT describe nitrous oxide sedation?
A. Deep sedation
B. General anesthesia
C. Conscious sedationC. Conscious sedation
1) Conscious sedation
a. can independently act and respond to verbal instructions
b. allows the patient to relax and remain calm and cooperative by reducing their sensitivity to
pain
c. patient is awake but feeling lightly drowsy
d. patient maintains a patient airway independently
2) Deep sedation
a. characterized by a depressed consciousness such that the patient is unable to continuously and
independently maintain a patent airway and experiences a partial loss of protective reflexes and
ability to respond to verbal commands or physical stimulation.
3) General anesthesia
a. medically induced coma leading to a loss of protective reflexes resulting from the
administration of one of more general anesthetic agents.
Which of the following agents is NOT an opioid utilized in outpatient anesthesia?
A. Fentanyl
B. Meperidine
C. Sufentanil
D. Diazepam D. Diazepam
1) Diazepam
a. anxiolytic
b. anticonvulsant
c. hypnotic
d. sedative
e. skeletal muscle relaxant
f. amnestic properties
g. has several pharmacologically active metabolites, thus has a long pharmacologic half-life
h. has a long duration of action, this drug is available in low doses to prevent drug accumulation
and an unnecessarily prolonged effect
2) Opioids
a. molecules that are known to bind to the opioid receptors to cause
b. anesthesia
c. sedation
d. respiratory depression
e. constipation
f. strong sense of euphoria in patients
The duration of action for a single IV bolus dose of diazepam is most dependent on...
A. Alpha half-life
B. Beta half-life
C. Enzymatic degradation
D. Hepatic biotransformation
E. Renal excretion D. Hepatic biotransformation
1) Diazepam
a. undergoes oxidative metabolism by demethylation, hydroxylation, and glucuronidation in the
liver as part of the cytochrome P450 system
b. has several pharmacologically active metabolites, the chief one being desmethyldiazepam
c. metabolites are conjugated with glucuronide and are excreted in urine
d. highly lipid-soluble
e. widely distributed throughout the body after administration
f. primarily distributes to muscle and adipose tissue
A posterior superior alveolar nerve block performed correctly will not anesthetize...
2) Posterior superior alveolar nerve block only affects the structures that are innervated by the
posterior superior alveolar nerve:
a. Maxillary sinus mucosa
b. Buccal plate and the overlying gingival tissue posterior to the premolar area
c. All the upper molars except the mesiobuccal root of the permanent 1st molar which is
innervated by the middle superior alveolar nerve.
Immediately following a procedure with prolonged high levels of nitrous oxide, a patient
immediately removes the breathing apparatus. What is the most likely consequence?
1) Diffusion hypoxia
a. may occur when a patient is recovering from N2O anesthesia, large quantities of this gas cross
from the blood into the alveolus (down its concentration gradient) and so for a short period of
time, the O2 and CO2 in the alveolus are diluted by this gas.
b. Diluting the O2 and CO2 can cause the partial pressure of oxygen to decrease, temporarily
inducing hypoxia. The decrease in CO2 could also potentiate this effect as ventilation would be
suppressed, leading to potential hypoxemia.
Which of the following can a clinician modify with nitrous oxide administration?
A. Pain stimulus
B. Pain threshold
C. Referred pain
D. Pain reaction B. Pain threshold
1) Pain threshold
a. modified by nitrous oxide because it sedates patients, thereby relieving them of the pain from
the operation
b. reduces patient anxiety by inducing a temporary state of euphoria which makes them less
aware of the sensations of dental treatment
A. 2
B. 3
C. 4
D. 1 A. 2
1) Phenobarbital
a. IV drug that is used to control seizures and convulsions and also shortens the time in passing
through stage 2 of general anesthesia
b. Barbiturate with longest duration
c. most widely used anticonvulsant drug in the world
d. used in general anesthesia to limit stage 2 anesthesia
2) Stage 2 anesthesia
a. patients may exhibit involuntary excitement, delirium, apnea, and exaggerated reflect response
leading to possible vomiting
Which of the following is NOT an endogenous opioid?
A. Dynorphin
B. Endorphin
C. Enkephalin
D. Bardykinin D. Bradykinin
1) Endogenous Opioid
a. Endorphine
b. enkephalin
c. dynorphin
d. endomorphine
e. all the above are endogenous opioid peptides created naturally within the human body
f. help increase the pain threshold and also have a potent analgesic effect in the body
2) Bradykinin
a. is NOT an endogenous opioid but rather a kinin, or active polypeptide in the body that is
created in the blood
b. is a mediator of the inflammatory reaction that can also induce vasodilation and increase
vascular permeability
While diazepam is being administered via I.V. to a patient for sedation, the patients begins to
displays ptosis of the upper eye-lid (Verrill's sign). Which of the following should the clinician
think?
1) Verill's sign
a. indicates that the effective sedative drug dose has already reached and dose must be kept
unchanged to maintain the level of sedation
b. during this stage of sedation, the patient can still understand verbal cues and can still respond
to them
c. administering additional diazepam during the displaying of verill's sign would cause overdose
of the drug
d. benzodiazepine receptor antagonist like flumazenil must be administered in cases of diazepam
drug overdose.
If a patient that is sedated with nitrous oxide suddenly becomes irrationally excited, which of the
following is the most likely explanation?
A. It is not recommended since few patients are adequately sedates at that level
B. It is not recommended since it can indicate a too-deeply sedated patient
C. It is recommended as an end-point
D. It is usually not attainable with diazepam alone C. It is recommended as an end-point
1) Verill's sign
a. during IV sedation helps the anesthesiologist determine the depth and adequacy of sedation
b. helps in determining a safe limit in administering the IV conscious sedation drug such as
diazepam
c. is similar to Ptosis, a condition where there is drooping of the upper or lower eyelid
d. the level of sedation can be evaluated by checking several parameters including the Verill's
sign or the dropping of the eyelid which signified the effect of anesthesia to the muscles that
controls the eyelid
e. presence of Verill's sign indicates that the anesthesia needed for the procedure is already
adequate and the safely limit has already been reached.
Each of the following is indicative of an intra-arterial injection EXCEPT one. Which is the
EXCEPTION?
1) It is recommended to fill the reservoir bag up to 1/3-2/3 of the total volume. This amount
produces the necessary vacuum required for the optimum flow of nitrous oxide and oxygen.
2) Keep some portion of the reservoir bag empty and free from air to produce the current flow of
nitrous oxide and oxygen.
Which of the following is NOT an advantage of oral sedation?
1) Differences in the rate of gastrointestinal drug absorption among patients account of the
greatest disadvantage of oral sedation
2) Drug absorption and metabolism varies widely between individuals, so the duration of effect
can only be estimated.
A. Buccal space
B. Masseteric space
C. Pterygopalatine space
D. Retropharyngeal space
E. Pterygomandibular space C. Pterygopalatine space
1) From the foramen rotundum, the maxillary division of the trigeminal nerve (V2) passes
through the pterygopalatine fossa
2) During the maxillary nerve (V2) block, the needle is bent at a 45 degree angle to facilitate
insertion into the pterygopalatine space located medially and posterior to the maxillary 2nd
molar.
3) The needle is inserted medially into the pterygopalatine fossa and about 0.9 to 1.8cc of
anesthesia is deposited to ensure efficacy of the maxillary nerve block technique.
Seizures induced by a lidocaine overdose can be treated by which of the following options?
A. Epinephrine (EpiPen)
B. Flumazenil (Roamzicon)
C. Meperidine (Demerol)
D. Naloxone (Narcan)
E. Diazepam (Valium) E. Diazepam (Valium)
1) Diazepam
a. rapid acting and highly efficacious anticonvulsant drug indicated to treat anxiety, panic, and
acute seizure attacks such as those induced by lidocaine
b. injecting lidocaine which may reach a concentration beyond 8 to 9 ug/mL is said to pose
greater risk for acute convulsions.
c. intravascular Diazepam administration can stop a seizure attack triggered by lidocaine
d. intramuscular injection of diazepam one hour prior to lidocaine injection can help prevent
lidocaine induced-seizure attacks
The purpose of a reservoir bag in an anesthesia machine is to
1) Reservoir bag
a. part of the anesthesia machine that allows accumulation of gas and serves as a gas reservoir
that can be used to supply gas when controlling the ventilation manually.
b. act as a visual guide to evaluate the breathing depth and the rate of depression of the patient
c. balances the difference between the patient's breathing pattern and the available gas that is
constantly flowing from the machine.
d. manages to balance off the difference between the patient's breathing pattern and the available
gas that is constantly flowing from the machine.
Each of the following drugs are used for IV conscious sedation in dental offices EXCEPT one
due to its unusually long duration. Which drug is the EXCEPTION?
A. Lorazepam
B. Diazepam
C. Hydroxyzine
D. Midazolam
E. Propofol A. Lorazepam
1) Lorazepam
a. very potent intermediate acting benzodiazepine anxiolytic agent with a very long duration that
makes it less useful in the dental setting
b. ideal sedative and anti-anxiety drugs used in dental settings are those that are short-acting and
allows for rapid recovery of the patient
c. sometimes prefer proposal over benzodiazepines because of its unique ability to provide a
recovery time of about 5 minutes of less.
Nitrous oxide abuse may result in...
1) Sedation
a. can diminish the stress and fear of the patient but does NOT affect the amount of anesthesia
that should be administered to the patient
b. used to relax or calm anxious patients through the use of medication or a sedative agent
c. is induced for uncooperative patients or those with anxiety or fear of the treatment
d. allows the patient to have a higher pain threshold, allowing them to be capable of tolerating
painful treatment procedures
When your nitrous oxide an oxygen tanks have been half emptied, what is the pressure in psi of
each cylinder? (The starting gas pressure are O2 [2,000]; N2O [800])?
A. 1,000 400
B. 2,000 400
C. 2,000 800
D. 1,000 800 D. 1,000 800
1) N2O tank
a. gas pressure in the N2O tank remains constant due to the amount of gas in each cylinder that it
still in liquid for, exerting no pressure
b. as the tank is emptied, the liquid gas vaporizes into gas as per Boyle's law, keeping the gas
pressure constant
c. at room temperature, N2O will exist as a liquid in the bottom of the tank whereas oxygen
exists as a gas making the pressure decrease directly over emptying
d. Because the starting pressure is 2000psi O2 and 800psi N2O, they remain at 1000psi O2 and
800psi N2O.
Which of the following explains the MOST probable reason for a patient to experience truisms
following an inferior alveolar nerve block?
A. Accidental injection of the anesthetic near a motor branch of the V3 trigeminal nerve
B. Failure to aspirate
C. Injection of the anesthetic between the periosteum and the bone
D. Piercing the medial pterygoid muscle with the needle D. Piercing the medial pterygoid
muscle with the needle
1) Trismus
a. can occur following administration of an inferior alveolar nerve block if the needle is placed
too medially
b. is given in the space within the pterygomandibular fossa
c. limited ability to open one's mouth
d. Normal mouth opening ranges from 35 to 45mm
e. Males usually have slightly greater mouth opening than females (40-60mm) = average is
35mm
f. The normal lateral movement is 8-12mm
2) Trismus Classifications
a. Mild Trismus: 20-30mm
b. Moderate: 10-20mm
c. Severe: > 10mm
3) Placing the needle too far medially can inject the anesthetic solution in the medial pterygoid
muscle
4) Impairment of the movement of medial pterygoid muscle results in inability to open the
mouth.
Assessment and Emergency Care Assessment and Emergency Care Answers
What should you do first if you happen upon a collapsed or unconscious person?
1) Concept: If you see a collapsed or unconscious person, the most important step is to make sure
that the patient is truly unconscious.
2) Conscious
a. can be determined by the person's reaction to your voice or through the coordination of their
movements
3) Unconscious
a. cannot be roused and is unaware of his or her surroundings
b. will not remember what has happened to them and may not be coherent
c. one way to check is by tapping them on their shoulder and asking "Hey, are you okay?"
4) Next Steps
a. after establishing unconsciousness, assess the person's airway, breathing, and pulse before
providing first aid
In which of the following patients is inhalation of 100% oxygen CONTRAINDICATED?
A. Acute bronchitis
B. Acute viral pneumonia
C. Chronic obstructive pulmonary disease (COPD)
D. Pneumonthorax D. Pneumonthorax
1) Concept: Pneumonthorax: Inhalation of pure 100% oxygen or any other gas is contraindicated
in a patient of pneumothorax because it can worsen the condition of the patient and can be life-
threatening.
a. is basically an abnormal collection of air or gas in the pleural space.
2) It is advised to insert a needle with an underwater seal to get rid of the entrapped air.
A. Neurogenic
B. Orthostatic
C. Vasovagal
D. Hyperventilation Syndrome D. Hyperventilation Syndrome
3) HVS patients
a. have roughly the same oxygenation in the arterial blood (98% for hemoglobin saturation) and
insufficient CO2 in their blood and other tissues.
b. while oxygen is abundant in the bloodstream, HVS reduces effective delivery of that oxygen
to vital organs due to low-CO2-induced vasoconstriction and the suppressed Bohr effect.
Which of the following patient health histories would be more prone to postoperative bleeding
after multiple extractions? Select all that apply.
A. Angina
B. Asthma
C. Cirrhosis
D. Diabetes Type I
E. Diabetes Type II
F. Renal disease C. Cirrhosis
E. Diabetes Type II
1) Concept: Patients with diabetes type II and liver cirrhosis are more prone to undergo
postoperative bleeding in such cases.
3) Cirrhosis
a. impairment of vitamin K dependent clotting factors and prolonged prothrombin time occurs in
liver cirrhosis
b. Vitamin K dependent clotting factors II, VII, IX, and X are formed and stored in the liver.
Fabrication of an "emergency" occlusal separator device is indicated for patient with...
A. Degenerative arthritis
B. Hemarthrosis
C. Myositis
D. Unilateral condylar hyperplasia B. Hemarthrosis
1) Concept: Further damage and bleeding of the joint is avoided through the use of an occlusal
separator to relieve the injured TMJ from contact.
2) Hemarthrosis
a. a condition wherein bleeding occurs in the joint or joint space.
b. injuries to joints are the most usual cause of hemarthrosis which results in joint pain and
inflammation
Methanol poisoning can be treated by administration of ethanol because ethanol...
2) Alcohol Dehydrogenase
a. has higher affinity for ethanol than methanol
1) Concept: Verill's sign is similar to Ptosis, a condition where there is drooping of the upper or
lower eyelid.
2) The level of sedation can be evaluated by checking several parameters including the Verill's
sign or the drooping of the eyelid which signifies the effect of anesthesia to the muscles that
controls the eyelid.
3) Ptosis
a. occurs when the eyelid muscles becomes incapable of holding or raising the eyelids properly.
It can be due to trauma, aging or degenerative diseases that can be neurogenic or myogenic or
may even be genetic.
If during a large MOD caries removal, your patient loses consciousness. You should first
assess...
2) Airway
a. check for obstruction
3) Breathing
a. check for rise and fall of chest
4) Circulation
a. check the person's pulse
5) Diabetes
a. check blood sugar if patient is diabetic
6) It is important for the doctor to not feel panic when a person loses consciousness, they must
think clearly and decisively to properly restore the person to health and consciousness.
A patient presents with an odontogenic infection evidence by a temperature of 102oF and
fluctuant mass in their submandibular space. Which of the following is indicated course of
treatment?
1) Concept: The increased number of bacteria built-up by the infection results to its spread into
the submandibular space causing the fever of the patient.
A. Levonordefrine
B. Norepinephrine
C. Phenylephrine
D. Epinephrine
E. Nitrous oxide E. Nitrous oxide
1) Concept: Nitrous oxide is converted into nitric oxide, which is known to induce
vasoDILATION not vasoCONSTRICTION.
1) Concept: Patients suffering from oxygen deprivation will demonstrate dilated pupils without
light reflex because the brainstem that controls pupillary response lacks oxygen, causing the cells
to die or be damaged.
3) Lack of pupillary reflex or an unusual abnormal pupillary reflex could be a result of brainstem
cell damage, optic nerve damage, occulomotor nerve damage or due to depressant drugs like the
barbiturates.
Fluoride ions are most likely to be inactivated by which of the following dentifrice components.
A. Dicalcium phosphate
B. Monofluorophosphate
C. Polyacrylic spheres
D. Anionic detergents A. Dicalcium phosphate
1) Concept: The interaction of fluoride ion and dicalcium phosphate dehydrate results in the
formation of insoluble fluoride compounds that reduce the amount of free and available fluoride
ions.
2) Fluoride ions that interact with dicalcium phosphate dehydrate form calcium fluoride.
3) IN order to make more fluoride ions interact with teeth, incorporating dicalcium phosphate
dehydrate within the fluoride pastes must be limited.
Which of the following is the primary characteristics indicating an intra-arterial injection of
midazolam (Versed)?
1) Concept: Some accounts of intra-arterial injection of midazolam stated that some of the
patients experienced moderate to severe pain within the extremity where it was administered.
2) There are some isolated reports which noted seizure activity occurring after intra-arterial
injection of midazolam. However, the reason for such reaction was not established.
3) Limited reports have been documented with regards to the effects of intra-arterial injection of
midazolam. Adverse reaction from accidental intra-arterial injection can be localized within the
its of injection or systemic.
Which muscle is responsible of the displacement of the proximal portion of the mandible
following an unfavorable angle fracture.
A. Hyoglossus
B. Medial pterygoid
C. Mylohyoid
D. Lateral pterygoid B. Medial pterygoid
1) Concept: The medial pterygoid muscle inserts into the lower posterior portion of the
mandibular ramus and the angle of the mandible and serves to help close the jaw.
2) Medial pterygoid
a. pulls on the angle of the mandible and posterior ramus in order to help facilitate jaw closure
b. during an unfavorable mandibular fracture, the medial pterygoid that inserts at the mandibular
angle pulls in the same direction as the vector of the displacement
A patient in your chair is suffering from xerostomia, tachycardia, and gastrointestinal inactivity,
and you are suspecting atropine poisoning. What should you administer to your patient to treat
this condition?
A. Physostigmine
B. Pilocarpine
C. Prednisone
D. Romazicon
E. Epinephrine A. Physostigmine
2) Atropine
a. competitive inhibitor of muscarinic receptors M1-M5
3) Physostigmine
a. is an agent that can reverse atropine overdose
In which order should an airway obstruction be managed in an unconscious patient?
A. Clear the pharynx, check breathing, extend the patient's neck, protrude the tongue and
mandible
B. Extend the patient's neck, Protrude the tongue and mandible, clear the pharynx
C. Extend the patient's neck, clear the pharynx, protrude the tongue and mandible
D. Protrude the mandible and tongue, clear the pharynx, extend the neck A. Clear the pharynx,
check breathing, extend the patient's neck, protrude the tongue and mandible
1) Concept: The prolonged numbness of the mandible after a lower molar extraction in children
may cause accidental cheek and lip biting.
2) Children experiencing numbness of the mandible after tooth extraction also have a tendency to
experiment and play around their numb lips and cheeks.
3) In order to avoid lip and cheek biting, it is best to instruct the parents to guide their child and
teach them to refrain from chewing foods while the lower arch is still numb.
Treatment Plan Treatment Plan Answers
Which two preoperative tests should be performed before deciding if general anesthesia should
be administered to a patient?
1) Concept: Preoperative tests are essential to ensure optimal health conditions of the patients
prior to any surveil procedure
A. Ephedra
B. Garlic
C. Ginseng
D. Resveratrol
E. Echinacea A. Ephedra
1) Concept: Reports of serious side effects and ephedra-related deaths caused the U.S. Food and
Drug administration (FDA) to ban the sale of ephedra-containing supplements on April 12, 2004.
2) The stimulant and thermogenic effects of Ephedra are due to the presence of ephedrine and
pseudo ephedrine, which stimulate the brain, increase heart rate, and constrict blood vessels
(increasing blood pressure).
A 36 year old woman, Betsy, presents with a badly broken down #19 with a necrotic pulp and an
acute apical abscess. Which of the following medical histories would create the most
complication in her surgical extraction treatment?
A. Asthma
B. Epilepsy
C. Hypertension
D. Mitral valve prolapse
E. Undergoing chemotherapy
F. Chronic Obstructive Pulmonary Disorder (COPD) B. Epilepsy
2) Epileptic seizures occur because of excessive or abnormal neuronal activity in the brain.
Epilepsy can be treated but not cured with medication. Approximately 30% of medicated
epileptic patients cannot control seizure attacks.
3) Anticonvulsant side-effects may differ among individuals. Epileptic seizures may manifest
differently with different signs and symptoms, so this should be taken into consideration prior to
performing procedures.
2) Excisional Biopsy
a. involve the complete removal of lesions and is most appropriate for small and accessible
lesions amenable to surgery
b. should be performed to rule out malignancies and avoid involvement of other structures in the
mouth
c. should be performed instead of incisional biopsies if:
1) Concept: Stone casts are accurate positive copies of a patient's oral structures that enable
dentists to study and diagnose the oral conditions of the patient even when the patient is not
present.
2) Stone casts
a. study models for diagnostic purposes and is used to pan and practice the surgical procedure
b. good visual aid to explain the oral condition and proposed procedure to the patient
c. models for fabrication of occlusal splints
d. limited to providing information of the intraoral structures, and can't provide information on
skeletal deformities not the final curve of Wilson of a patient
The most common procedure for treating chronic recurrent TMJ dislocation is...
2) Coronoidectomy
a. also performed to manage trismus and pseudoankylosis
When treating Actinomycosis of the jaw, which of the following is the most accepted dosage
schedule?
A. 10 million units IV per day for 10-14 days followed by a long-term oral antibiotic
B. 250 mg oral tablets q6H, 7 days
C. 500 mg oral tablets q6h, 7 days
D. 600,000 units IM Q12H, 14 days followed by an oral antibiotic A. 10 million units IV per
day for 10-14 days followed by a long-term oral antibiotic
1) Concept: Actinomycosis of the jaw is best treated with penicillin antibiotics intravenously for
a period of 2-6 weeks
2) Actionmycosis
a. requires long term antibiotic treatment in oral doses that may last form 6-12 months depending
on the disease severity
b. Actinomycosis infection elicits suppuration and inflammation
c. Swellings caused by actinomycosis drain pus containing sulfur granules
Each of the following is a reason a clinician may section an impacted 3rd molar during the
extraction procedure EXCEPT one. Which is the EXCEPTION?
1) Sectioning
a. Sectioning an impacted molar makes the extraction procedure easier and faster for both the
clinic and the patient
b. By sectioning the roots of the impacted 3rd molar, each root can be easily luxated and
removed in the best manner possible without exerting too much force, thereby preventing trauma
to hard and soft tissues
c. Too much bone reduction can also be avoided with a planned root resectioning procedure of
impacted teeth
Which of the following orthognathic surgeries is LEAST stable?
A. Genioplasty
B. Inferior movement of the maxilla
C. Mandibular advancement
D. Maxillary advancement B. Inferior movement of the maxilla
1) Concept: Inferior movement of the maxilla is the LEAST stable because the vertical occlusal
force of the masticatory muscles often cause it to relapse.
2) Maxillary orthognathic surgeries like LaFort I, II, and III typically have a higher relapse rate
than mandibular orthognathic surgeries because the bone of the maxilla is thinner and less sold
than the mandible.
Diagnosis Diagnosis Answers
Bleeding under the conductive may indicate...
2) Clinical features
a. flattened malar eminence
b. facial bruising/swelling
c. bleeding under the conjuctiva
d. facial sensation loss below the orbit in an infraorbital nerve involvement and trismus
Which of the following teeth responds the LEAST to rotational forces during extraction
procedures due to its root structure?
1) Concept: The buccal and lingual placement of the roots and tendency to fracture decreases the
usefulness of rotational extraction forces.
A. Angioneurotic edema
B. Congestive heart failure
C. Hematoma formation
D. An acute anaphylactoid reaction A. Angioneurotic edema
A. Maxillary sinus
B. Nasal bone
C. Zygomatic arch
D. Infraorbital rim D. Infraorbital rim
1) Concept: Paresthesia of the upper lip, cheek, and left nose is due to the damage incurred by
the infraorbital nerve.
2) Infraorbital nerve exits the infraorbital foramen and branches out to innervate the upper lips,
cheeks and nose up the nasal vestibule.
3) A fracture along the infraorbital rim may result in damaged to the infraorbital nerve which
causes paresthesia of the structures it innervates
The predominant cause for failure of autgenous 3rd molar transplants is...
A. Immune rejection
B. Inadequate root length
C. Infection
D. Traumatic occlusion D. Traumatic occlusion
1) Concept: Autogenous tooth transplantation is the process of utilizing the freshly extracted
impacted or erupted teeth from its original position in the arch and transferring them into the
recipient site of the same person.
2) There are several reason to explain the failure of autogenous tooth transplants which include
chronic root resorption, inflammatory resorption, marginal and apical periodontitis, dental caries,
and occlusal trauma.
3) 3rd molars used for autogenous tooth transplant procedures most commonly fail due to their
inability to withstand the heavy occlusal forces that exist in the posterior during mastication.
4) Due to the mechanical advantage of a Type III lever like the jaw, occlusal force increases as
you move posteriorly in the mouth (closer to the fulcrum/condyle)
Trochlear nerve dysfunction is indicated by...
1) Concept: The trochlear nerve (CN IV) is a motor nerve which innervates the superior oblique
muscle.
2) The superior oblique muscle allows rotation of the eyes within the vertical plane and the
rotational movement of the eyeball towards and away from the medial plane.
3) Trochlear nerve dysfunction will prevent the eyes from moving up and down.
Following a difficult surgical extraction, a patient was diagnosed with a postoperative infection
and has been placed on oral penicillin for three weeks. At her exam today, you notice that the
surgical site is well healed, but there are white patches on the dorsum of her tongue that scrapes
off. What is the recommended course of treatment?
1) Concept: Prolonged intake of antibiotics disturbs the balance of microflora in the mouth by
killing the "normal" bacteria, allowing the fungal species like Candida albicans to grow
unhindered by competition.
2) The white patches on the coral surface of the tongue that appeared after prolonged antibiotic
use are caused by the increased use are caused by the increased number of Candida albicans.
3) Nystatin troches are considered an effective treatment modality for Candida infections.
Acute suppurative osteomyelitis is commonly associated with each of the following EXCEPT
ONE. Which if the following is the one EXCEPTION?
1) Concept: Loose teeth with suppurative drainage from the periodontium is caused by
periodontitis, NOT acute osteomyelitis.
2) Acute osteomyelitis
a. a disease that mostly affects children and is usually correlated with a Staphylococcus aureus
infection.
b. may also occur in adults with compromised immune system, immunosuppressive therapy, or
steroid therapy.
Each of the following is a characteristic of advanced osteoarthritis of the TMJ EXCEPT one.
Which is the EXCEPTION?
A. Antegonial notching
B. Crepitus
C. Tendency toward apertognathia
D. Tendency toward prognathism
E. Flattening of articular surface C. Tendency toward apertognathia
1) Concept: Advanced cases of osteoarthritis of the TMJ may exhibit crepitus, flattening of the
articular surface of the condyle, limited jaw movement, and pain on mouth opening.
2) Advanced osteoarthritis
a. could not cause apertognathia which is the dental malocclusion whee the posterior teeth
occlude prematurely resulting in an open bite.
b. could result to a pseudoprognathic appearing mandible and could also cause deviation of jaw
movement, further aggravating the condition
Clinical signs/symptoms of insulin shock do NOT include...
A. Cold sweat
B. Nausea
C. Seizures
D. Weakness
E. Confusion C. Seizures
A. Atelectasis
B. Subacute Bacterial Endocarditis
C. Urinary tract infection
D. Wound infection D. Wound infection
1) Concept: Sudden increases in body temperature is an indication of fever which are typically
initiated when infection is present in the body
2) A patient experiencing fever one week after a surgical procedure indicates a presence of
infection.
3) After one week, the surgical wound should have reduction or total absence of swelling and
should demonstrate a decrease in the redness of the wound.
4) Patients who experiences swelling and fever that does not subside after the 3rd or 4th day after
the surgical procedure should seek care as it may be due to infection.
Which bone makes up all or part of the inferior concha?
A. Ethmoid
B. Maxilla
C. Palatine
D. Sphenoid
E. Turbinate E. Turbinate
1) Concept: Tubrinates are narrow and sea-shell appearing bone that extends into the nasal air
passage.
2) Turbinates
a. have four grooved air channels which divides and forces the inspired air to flow steadily into
the nasal passages.
b. responsible for warming, humidifying, and filtering the inhaled air.
Which of the following anatomical spaces would a needle tract infection following an inferior
alveolar nerve block infection involve initially?
A. Pterygomandibular
B. Pterygopalatine
C. Sublingual
D. Submandibular
E. Lateral pharyngeal A. Pterygomandibular
1) Concept: The pterygomandibular space will most probably be affected by a needle tract
infection after an IAN nerve block.
2) The pterygomandibular space is the anatomical space containing several blood vessels and the
mandibular branch of the trigeminal nerve.
3) In order to anesthetize the jaw, the inferior alveolar nerve block is performed with the needle
passing into the pterygomandibular space, which may serve later as an opening for infection to
set in.
What structure(s) must be cut in order to enter the superior joint space of the TMJ?
1) Concept: The superior joint space is encompassed by the capsular ligament and must be cut in
order to access the superior joint space.
2) The capsular ligament completely encircles the temporomandibular joint and prevents over
extensive movements that may cause the TMJ to dislocate.
Which of the following is the most like fracture site if a patient present to you after receiving a
heavy blow to the chin that causes their mandible to deviate to the left upon opening?
1) Concept: Suncondylar fractures are diagnosed in trauma cases by a deviation of the mandible
to the side of a fracture because subcondylar fractures leads to improper translation of the
mandible, creating deviation.
2) Protrusive, extrusive, and opening movements can be produced by the contraction of the
lateral pterygoid muscles.
3) During right excursive movements when the mandible moves to the right, the left lateral
pterygoid contacts pushing the mandible downward and forward. The right lateral pterygoid is
relaxed and does not antagonize the voce, causing the asymmetrical depression and protrusion of
the mandible.
The classification of an impacted mandibular 3rd molar is usually based on which of the
following factors? Select all that apply.
1) Concept: The classification of 3rd molar impaction is based on their spatial positioning in
relation with the long axis of the adjacent 2nd molar and the amount of tooth structure covered
by bone or soft tissue.
A. Auriculotemporal
B. Deep temporal
C. Mandibular division of the trigeminal (V3)
D. Marginal mandibular
E. Masseteric D. Marginal mandibular
1) Concept: The marginal mandibular branch is located within the anterior aspect of the face and
neck and supplies the lower lip muscles and chin.
2) The mental is, depressor anguli iris, and depressor labii inferiors are muscles that are
innervated by the marginal mandibular branch of the facial nerve.
3) The masseteric nerve, auriculotemporal nerve, and mandibular division of the trigeminal nerve
have branches that innervate the TMJ.
How many days will it usually take for a patient to notice post extraction alveolar osteitis (dry
socket) if it occurs?
A. 3
B. 5
C. 7
D. 9
E. 1 A. 3
1) Concept: Dry socket (Localized Alveolar Osteitis) is a painful condition that occurs 2-3 days
following tooth extraction and is self limiting in nature.
2) Dry socket
a. have several predisposing conditions but usually occurs due to the dislodgment of the blood
clot in the extraction site.
b. elicits pain that may last for 2-3 days and may even radiate to other areas of the face.
What is the only structure in the TMJ to exert posterior traction on the articular disc?
1) Concept: Superior retrodiscal lamina functions by pulling the articular discs posteriorly
against the lateral pterygoid that pulls it forward.
2) Superior retrodiscal lamina provides posterior traction as it connects the articular disc to the
tympanic plate.
3) During mouth opening, the retrodiscal lamina is extended preventing overextension and
anterior dislocation of the articular disc.
Which of the following directions would a mandibular 2nd molar move if the 1st molar was
extracted?
A. Distally
B. Lingually
C. Mesially
D. Buccally C. Mesially
1) Concept: Teeth may tend to move into an edentulous area recently occupied by an adjacent
tooth.
2) Edentulous spaces exhibit thinner bone support, so the adjacent 2nd molar may tilt or move
medially into the space.
3) Teeth tend to move medially towards the midline, especially when the adjacent tooth is
missing.
Which of the following directions would a mandibular 2nd premolar move if the 1st molar was
extracted
A. Distally
B. Lingually
C. Mesially
D. None A. Distally
1) Concept: Mandibular premolars will move distally because of the presence of space distally
and the resorption of the interseptal bone that separates i from the mandibular molar extraction
site.
2) The alveolar bone between the mandibular 2nd premolar and 1st molar will resorb, causing it
to become thinner and weaker there by providing less support to the mandibular 2nd premolar.
3) The 2nd premolar will have a tendency to collapse into the bony area that is thin, weak, and
less resistant.
A surgical extraction of impacted 3rd molars would be contraindicated if the patient had...
2) Surgical extractions can be performed for the following patients with an appropriate medical
clearance from the patient's physician.
a. Hemophiliacs
a. patients can be managed with medications involving transexamic acid and infusion of clotting
factor VIII or IX prior to extraction improves clotting time and reduces bleeding time
b. Anemic
a. Patients can be managed through prophylactic antibiotics prior to extraction with antibiotics
post extraction to avoid the possibility of having bacterial endocarditis.
A. Autonomic nerves
B. Cervical spinal nerves
C. Ninth cranial nerve
D. Fifth cranial nerve A. Autonomic nerves
1) Concept: Autonomic nerves are related to muscular or motor reflexive functions including
peristalsis, breathing, and heart beat and are not involved in pain perception.
2) Nociception
a. process of transmitting and identifying noxious stimuli from the nociceptors of the peripheral
nervous system
3) Cranial nerve V and IX are both sensory and motor nerves that transmit nociceptive stimuli
from the face.
Contraction of which of the following muscles can cause the forward displacement of the
condylar head if the condyle is fracture off?
A. Lateral pterygoid
B. Medial pterygoid
C. Stylohyoid
D. Temporal
E. Buccinator A. Lateral pterygoid
1) Concept: Protrusive and extrusive movements are produced mostly by the contraction of the
lateral pterygoid muscles.
2) During right lateral excursive movements when the mandible moves to the right, the left
lateral pterygoid contracts pushing the mandible downward and forward. The right lateral
pterygoid is relaxed and does not antagonize the force, causing the asymmetrical depression and
protrusion of the mandible.
3) When both lateral pterygoids contract at the same time, it causes a protrusive movement.
4) The lateral pterygoid originate in the infra temporal fossa and attaches to the TMJ disk and the
neck of the mandible.
Each of the following diagnostic aids is helpful in distinguishing between a case of maxillary
retrusion and mandibular protrusion in cases presenting with a Class III malocclusion EXCEPT
ONE. Which of the following diagnostic aids is the EXCEPTION?
A. Clinical evaluation
B. Photography
C. Study casts
D. Cephalometry C. Study casts
1) Concept: Stone casts are accurate positive copies of a patient's oral structures that enable
dentists to study and diagnose the oral condition of the patient when the patient is not present.
2) Stone casts are used in maxillofacial surgical procedures as:
a. study models for diagnostic purposes and is used to plan and practice the surgical procedure
b. good visual aid to explain the oral condition and proposed procedure to the patient
c. models for fabrication of occlusal splints.
d. are limited to providing information of the intraoral structures, and can't provide information
on skeletal deformities
In which of the following procedures is the dentist least likely to utilize TMJ arthroscopy?
1) Concept: Repairing a disk perforations requires that a flap incision is made in order to fully
access the temporomandibular disk.
2) Lavage of the temporomanidbular joint space, removing adhesions, and disk manipulations
can all be complete using arthroscopy.
A. Distally
B. Lingually
C. Mesially
D. None
E. Buccally C. Mesially
1) Concept: Teeth may tend to move into an edentulous area recently occupied by an adjacent
tooth.
2) Edentulous spaces exhibit thinner bone support, so the adjacent 2nd molar may tilt or move
medially into the space.
Which of the following tooth varieties are most known for susceptibility for fracture during
extraction procedures?
1) Concept: Maxillary 1st premolars are known to fracture during extractions due to the presence
of a very thin root.
b. Maxillary 1st premolars have variable root forms and normally have two root canals and 2
roots.
c. Due to the thinness of the tooth root of maxillary premolars, the roots are easily fracture
during extraction.
When performing incisional biopsies of soft tissue, the clinician should do each of the following
EXCEPT one. Which is the EXCEPTION?
1) Concept: Saline cannot be used as a fixative for the incisional biopsy specimen
2) Incisional biopsy is a procedure that removes a portion of a lesion for laboratory examinations
in cases when complete excision is contraindicated.
a. are performed on lesions > 10mm in size
3) Placing a suture in the specimen is done to localize the areas to be included in the incision and
prevent contamination of the specimen
A longer gray scale of contrast can be achieved in a radiograph by:
1) Increasing the kV causes the radiographic image to have low contrast and longer gray scales
2) Low kV creates low energy x-rays responsible for producing high contrast and shorter gray
scales.
A 35-year-old female patient complains of a painful, rapidly developing ulcer on the left side of
her hard palate. This lesion appears crater-like and measures 3.5cm. Which of the following is
the most likely diagnosis for her current condition?
1) Necrotizing sialometaplasia is a rapidly expanding ulcerative lesion that mostly occurs on the
posterior area of the hard palate.
2) Necrotizing sialometaplasia is usually benign and is often painless, and is usually self-limiting
and resolves in about 6-10 weeks.
3) Trauma to the minor salivary glands located in the hard palate causes this condition.
Mucous retetion cysts 1) Mucous retention cysts
a. dome-shaped radiopaque entities seen on the floor of the maxillary sinus
b. represent focal accumulation of inflammatory exudate that lifts the epithelial lining of the
sinus and the periosteum away from the underlying bone
c. are benign inflammatory reactions, so there is NO need for surgical treatment
A 21-year-old male patient complains of a dull pain in their posterior left mandibular region with
a radiograph that reveals not only a radiolucency around the 1st molar roots, but also a
radiopacity of bone peripheral to this radiolucency. Which of the following is the best diagnosis?
1) Radiolucency is from the tissue destruction that occurred within the periodical area and the
radiopacity that denotes the boundary set by the inflammatory cells as they try to confine the
infection.
2) Once the infection is completely confined by the inflammatory cells, a periodical cyst or a
granulation tissue may form and the damaged bone begins to remodel.
3) The continuous remodeling of the bone creates the solid, well-defined and radiopaque border
around the periphery of the periodical cyst or of the granulation tissue.
Anterior disc displacement 1) Anterior Disc Displacement with Reduction
a. articular disc is attached anteriorly to the superior head of the lateral pterygoid muscle and
posteriorly to the retrodiscal tissue
b. moves anteriorly out from between the condyle and the fossa, so that the mandible and
temporal bone contact is made on something other than the articular disc and the disc slides back
into place
c. sliding of the disc back into place creates the characteristic popping or clicking noise
A. Antrolith
B. Odontoma
C. Osteoma
D. Periapical Cyst
E. Mucus retention pseudocyst D. Periapical Cyst
1) Periapical cyst
a. localized radiolucencies associated with the apex of a tooth that previously suffered chronic
pulpal or periodontal infection
2) Odontomas
a. radiopaque lessons that may occur along the anterior and posterior teeth
3) Osteomas
a. radiopaque benign lesions or bone growth within a membranous bone
4) Antroliths
a. calcified lesions or masses which is usually located along the maxillary sinus
b. clicking sound due to articular disc that slides back and forth.
Nasopalatine duct cyst 1) Nasopalatine duct cyst
a. heart-shaped radiolucency often found in the median aspect of the hard palate anterior to the
1st molars
2) considered the most prominent odontogneic cyst within the oral cavity
Soft Tissue Soft Tissue Answers
Which of the following will provide the MOST ACCURATE diagnosis for a patient with a large
cyst-like lesion (14mm) in area of their posterior mandible?
1) Concept: Histology of the tissue and cystic fluid will aid in the definite diagnosis of the lesion.
Incisional biopsy is indicated because it is a large lesion (>10mm)
2) Incisional biopsy
a. of the large cystic lesion should be carried out and sent to the laboratory for histologic
examination
3) Definitive diagnosis
a. is necessary to determine which treatment should be provided for the best results
Which of the following reactive lesions of gingival tissue histologically reveals bone formation?
A. Fissured tongue
B. Hairy tongue
C. Lingual laceration
D. Oral squamous cell carcinoma
E. Benign migrating glossitis A. Fissured tongue
A. Dermatitis herpetiformis
B. Erytheme multiforme
C. Keratosis follicularis
D. Lichen planus
E. Benign mucus membrane pemphigoid D. Lichen planus
6) Biopys
a. is recommended to rule our precancerous (premalignant) change of persistent lesions similar to
erosive lichen plans that do not respond to topical corticosteroids
Which of the following cancer diagnoses has the best 5-year survival rate?
A. Stage 1 well-differentiated squamous cell carcinoma involving the floor of the mouth
B. Stage 1 well-differentiated squamous cell carcinoma involving the right lateral tongue
C. Stage 1 well-differentiated squamous cell carcinoma involving the soft palate
D. Verrucous carcinoma of the floor of the mouth
E. Verrucous carcinoma of the right lower posterior vestibule E. Verrucous carcinoma of
the right lower posterior vestibule
1) Concept: Gingivostomatitis
a. is an inflammation of the oral mucosa and gingiva caused predominantly by HSV-1
b. Primary herpetic gingivostomatitis is an infection transmitted through direct contact or
through aerosol droplet that clinically apparent as yellow fluid-filled vesicles that leave ulcers
when the vesicles rupture.
c. Secondary herpetic gingivostomatitis is a reactivation of the latent virus due to trauma, stress
or immunsuppression. The vesicles and ulcerations may be found intramurally and extra orally
on keratinized surfaces.
d. Herpes presents as numerous pin-head vesicles, which rupture rapidly to form painful irregular
ulcerations covered by yellow-grey membranes.
A. Lipoma
B. Neurofibroma
C. Nodular melanoma
D. Verrucous carcinoma
E. Cavernous hemangioma E. Cavernous hemangioma
1) Concept: Apthous stomatitis is characterized by the repeated formation of ulcers in the mouth,
in otherwise healthy individuals.
b. Apthous stomatis ulcers occur periodically and heal completely between attacks with pain
symptoms ranging from a minor nuisance to interfering with eating and drinking.
c. Ulcerations present in apthous stomatitis cases are NOT preceded by vesicular lesions.
d. All other conditions listed are characterized by the presence of ulcers with vesicular lesions.
The most serious effects of repeated exposure to X radiation in low doses is characterized by
which of the following?
A. Carcinogenesis
B. Diarrhea
C. Pupura
D. Radionecrosis
E. Alteration of oral microflora A. Carcinogenesis
1) Concept: Carcinogenesis
a. Repeated low doses of ionizing radiate may induce irreparable DNA damage which leads to
errors in replication and transcription that result in carcinogenesis
b. Persistent low dose radiation can induce a type of genomic instability in cells that may trigger
viral interactions leading to pre-mature aging and carcinogenesis
c. Ionizing radiation results in the enhancing of the frequency of mutation and other genetic
changes in the descendants of the irradiated cell after many generations of replication.
d. Gap junction mediated cell-cell communication and activation of the p53 damaged response
pathway may result in carcinogenesis.
Infection, loss of interocclusal (intermaxilary) space, and vitamin B12 deficiency, are all possible
etiologies of which of the following conditions
A. Angular chelitis
B. Apthous stomatitis
C. Atrophic glossitis
D. Media rhomboid glossitis
E. Xerostomia A. Angular chelitis
2) Angular cheilitis is also known as angular cheilosis, commisural cheilitis, angular stomatitis
and perleche.
Each of the following conditions is characterized by an ulcerations that are preceded by a
vesicular lesion EXCEPT ONE. Which condition is the EXCEPTION?
A. Apthous Stomatitis
B. Coxackie virus infection (Hand-foot-and-mouth disease)
C. Herpangina
D. Herpes zoster
E. Herpetic stomatitis A. Apthous Stomatitis
1) Concept: Apthous stomatitis is characterized by the repeated formation of ulcers in the mouth,
in otherwise healthy individuals.
b. Apthous stomatis ulcers occur periodically and heal completely between attacks with pain
symptoms ranging from a minor nuisance to interfering with eating and drinking.
c. Ulcerations present in apthous stomatitis cases are NOT preceded by vesicular lesions.
d. All other conditions listed are characterized by the presence of ulcers with vesicular lesions.
Which of the following is the best treatment of generalized acute herpetic gingivostomatitis?
3) Generalized soreness of the oral cavity results in the interference of eating and drinking
4) The ruptured vesicles are focal sites of pain and are sensitive to touch.
5) The condition is self-limiting and subsides within 1o to 14 days. Pallative treatment includes
a. topical viscous xylocaine
b. benadryl for pain relief
c. kaopectate to help coat the mouth
d. balanced diet to compensate for insufficient nutrition
e. Acyclovir, an antiviral may be administered in extreme cases to inhibit the virus. "Magic
Mouthwash" contains an anesthetic, benadryl, kaopectate and may congaing the antibiotic or
antiviral.
Which of the following lesions has the highest propensity for malignancy?
A. Junctional nevus
B. Leiomyoma
C. Lymphangioma
D. White sponge nevus
E. Granulocytoma A. Junctional nevus
1) Concept: Most junctional nevi are non-cancerous in nature but are capable of transforming
into malignant melanoma if changes are seen in their appearance
b. Junctional nevi or moles are a benign skin growth whose appears flat, round, and mostly dark
brown in color, and originate from multiple skin layers.
c. Junctional nevi arise from cells at the junction of the epidermis and dermis meet.
3) The most dangerous form of melanoma, nodular melanoma can be diagnosed with "EFG"
E: Elevated above the skin surface
F: Firm to the touch
G: Growing
Severe dysplasia or carcinoma in situ is MOST OFTEN associated histologically with which of
the following clinical lesions?
A. Hairy leukoplakia
B. Leukoplakia
C. Lichen planus
D. White sponge nevus
E. Erythroplakia E. Erythroplakia
1) Concept: Erythroplakia
a. Erythroplakia are red lesions that considered to be one of the most common premalignant
lesions in the oral cavity
b. Histopathological examination of erythroplakias exhibit severe dysplasia, carcinoma in situ
and invasive squamous cell carcinoma
A. Anterior Maxilla
B. Posterior Maxilla
C. Posterior Mandible
D. Soft Palate
E. Anterior Mandible A. Anterior Maxilla
1) Concept: Adenomatoid odontogenic tumors are found most commonly in females under 20
years of age in their anterior maxilla and are associated with an unerupted tooth.
b. Adenomatoid odontogenic tumors are a benign epithelial tumor of bone that may or may not
mineralize.
c. They manifest radiographically as a well-defined radiolucent lesion which sometimes contains
radiopaque areas.
The diagnosis of which of the following conditions is an oral cytology smear MOST indicated?
A. Bell's palsy
B. Burning mouth syndrome
C. Post-herpetic neuralgia
D. Psychoneurosis
E. Auriculo-temporal syndrome C. Post-herpetic neuralgia
1) Concept: The most probable diagnosis for these conditions is post-herpetic neuralgia
b. It is characterized by nerve pain due to the damage caused by Varicella Zoster virus.
c. It is commonly restricted to a dermatome of the skins and follows a Varicella Zoster infection
in the same dermatome.
d. Post-herpetic neuralgia presents with
1) Possible paresthesia and itching
2) Discomfort to severe pain which can be described as burning or stabbing
3) Persistence of pain for 3+ months
4) Cutaneous scarring may be present
Which of the following lesions is the LEAST likely to be visible radiographically?
1) Concept: Nasolabial cysts are NOT always visible on radiographs because of their soft tissue
origin and extra osseous occurrence
2) Nasolabial cysts
a. rare, non-odontogenic, soft-tissue, developmental cysts that occur inferiorly to the nasal alar
region
b. they are also known as nasoalveolar cysts of Klestadt's cysts
A 35 year-old man presents with multiple macular pigmented spots on the skin and multiple soft
nodules. What is the most likely diagnosis?
A. Lipomatosis
B. Metastatic malignant melanoma
C. Nevoid basal cell carcinoma syndrome
D. Polyostotic fibrous dysplasia
E. Neurofibromatosis E. Neurofibromatosis
1) Concept: Neurofibromatosis
a. genetic condition that manifests as cafe au lair spots and multiple soft nodules which may
occur anywhere else in the body.
b. Neurofibromatosis occurs with many varieties with the most commonly occurring variety
being the NF1 or von Recklinghausens disease.
c. No cure currently exists for neurofibromatosis and is only managed by treating the symptoms
as they arise.
A 42-year old asthmatic patient who smokes and is HIV+ presents to your office for a routine
evaluation. Upon examination, you notice an asymptomatic red patch on the midline dorsum of
their tongue and a marked loss of lingual papillae. Which of the following is the most likely
diagnosis?
A. Geographic tongue
B. Median Rhomboid glossitis
C. Schwannoma
D. Ulcerative lichen planus
E. Carcinoma B. Median Rhomboid glossitis
A. Lichen planus
B. Mucous membrane pemphigoid
C. Papilloma
D. Pseudomembraneous candiodosis
E. Squamous cell carcinoma D. Pseudomembraneous candiodosis
A. Electrosurgery
b. Marsupialization
C. Parotid gland excision
D. Sublingual gland excision
E. Cryosurgery D. Sublingual gland excision
1) Concept: ranuls typically exhibit a recurrence rate of up to 25% after a complete excision of
the ranula and up to 2% in cases of complete excision of the ranula and sublingual gland
2) Ranulas
a. are mucoceles found on the floor of the mouth that present as soft tissue swellings of collected
mucin from a ruptured salivary gland duct
b. usually caused by local trauma, and are left alone if they are small and not problematic
3) The salivary level experiences by a patient following an ipsilateral sublingual gland excision
is usually not noticed by the patient, so if the first surgery is considered a failure, excision is
recommended.
Which of the following is the MOST COMMON location that Kaposi's sarcoma lesions occur in
AIDS patients?
1) Concept: The hard palate is most frequently affected, followed by the gums.
A. Lichen planus
B. Mucocele
C. Necrotizing sialometaplasia
D. Sialothiasis
E. Apthous ulcer C. Necrotizing sialometaplasia
A. Appears radio-opaque
B. Is dome shaped
C. Protrudes from the floor of the maxillary sinus
D. Require surgical removal
E. Lined with respiratory epithelium D. Require surgical removal
A. Actinic chelitis
B. Hyperkaratosis
C. Lichen planus
D. White sponge nevus A. Actinic chelitis
3) Lichen Planus
a. autoimmune disease of skin and mucous membranes
A. Gingiva
B. Lower lip
C. Tongue
D. Upper lip
E. Buccal mucosa B. Lower lip
A. Dentigerous cyst
B. Hyperparathyroidism
C. Leukemia
D. Osteosarcoma
E. Ossifying fibroma D. Osteosarcoma
1) Concept: Osteosarcomas are classified as a form of bone cancer that predominantly occurs in
children and teenagers.
2) Osteosarcomas
a. The reason for this occurrence of osteosarcoma is still unknown at present but some studies
suggest a genetic etiology.
b. Usually manifest as a solid, indurated swelling that can be distinguished in radiographs as
appearing moth-eaten, or having a sun-burst appearance. The sun-burst appearance is due to the
calcified tumor spicules that radiate outward of the bone.
Which of the following would a cross-sectional occlusal radiograph be useful in locating?
A. Sialoliths in Wharton's duct
B. The hyoid bone
C. The mandibular foramen
D. Maxillary sinus polyps A. Sialoliths in Wharton's duct
1) Concept: Occlusal radiographs are important when attempting to discern the location of
submandibular sialoliths.
2) Stones in the Wharton's duct are made visible in cross sectional occlusal radiographs.
A. Digastric
B. Lateral pterygoid
C. Masseter
D. Mylohyoid C. Masseter
3) Myositis is also a documented side effect of lipid-lowering drugs like statins and vibrates.
Severe dysplasia or carinoma in situ is MOST OFTEN associated histologically with which of
the following clinical lesions?
A. Erythroplakia
B. Hairy leukoplakia
C. Leukoplakia
D. Lichen planus
E. White sponge nevus A. Erythroplakia
1) Concept: Erythroplakia:
a. red lesions that considered to be one of the most common premalignant lesions in the oral
cavity
b. Erythroplakias are MOST COMMONLY found:
1) Floor of the mouth
2) Tongue
3) Soft palate
A. Brain
B. Cervical nodes
C. Liver
D. Lungs
E. Bone B. Cervical nodes
1) Concept: Squamous cell carcinoma of the tongue most commonly metastasizes to the cervical
lymph nodes because the lingual lymph drainage occurs through the cervical lymph nodes.
2) The spread of carcinoma in the cervical lymph noes typically exults in its poor prognosis.
A. Fibroma
B. Mucocele
C. Schwannoma
D. Pleomorphic adenoma D. Pleomorphic adenoma
2) Pleomorphic adenoma
a. most common variety of salivary gland tumor and also the most common tumor of the parotid
gland
b. Plemorphic adenoma derives its name from the architectural pleomorphism (variable
appearance) observed with light microscopy.
c. The tumor usually presents as a slowly proliferating, painless, indurated single nodular mass.
1) Concept: The floor of the mouth and lateral border of the tongue are the most common
locations for the development of squamous cell carcinoma inside the mouth.
2) An explanation for the high potential for premalignant lesions in this area is due to its rich
blood supply because rapidly dividing malignant cells require more nutrition than normal cells.
3) If an ulcer or lesion develops on the floor of the mouth, healing is difficult because of the high
degree of mobility of the tongue and floor of the mouth.
A 41 year old female from your practice resorts, developing a symptomatic, rapidly expanding
ulcer on her right lateral hard palate that appears crater-like and measures 35mm in diameter.
What is the most likely diagnosis?
A. Actiomycycosis
B. Adenoid cystic carcinoma
C. Necrotizing sialometaplasia
D. Pleomorphic adenoma
E. Squamous cell carcinoma C. Necrotizing sialometaplasia
2) Necrotizing sialometaplasia
a. usually benign and is often painless, and is usually self-limiting an resolves in about six to ten
weeks.
b. trauma to the minor salivary glands located in the hard palate causes this condition
Which of the following changes in lingual papillae results in the manifestation of a black hairy
tongue?
A. Abnormal mitosis
B. Invasion
C. Loss of cellular polarity
D. Pleomorphism B. Invasion
1) Concept: Invasion is NOT a feature shown by carcinoma in situ. The basement membrane is
NOT breached in the case of carcinoma in situ.
2) Carcinoma in situ which is also known as an "in situ neoplasm" is an abnormal mass of cells
3) These abnormal cells grow in their initial location and do NOT invade the surrounding tissues.
4) Features include:
a. Abnormal mitosis
b. Loss of cellular polarity
c. Pleomorphism
Which of the following describes the MOST COMMON cause of intraoral verruca vulgaris?
A. Chronic alcoholism
B. Pipe smoking
C. Trauma
D. Autoinoculation D. Autoinoculation
1) Concept: Autoinoculation is the most common cause of intraoral warts causing verruca
vulgaris
2) The human papilloma virus (HPV) virus self implants inside the mucous epithelium, causing
infection.
1) Concept: Squamous cell carcinomas occurring in the floor of the mouth demonstrate the
LEAST favorable prognosis
2) The squamous cell carcinoma occurs in the floor of the mouth because it contains such a rich
blood supply.
3) Cancer cells require an increased level of nutrition compared to normal cells, so a rich blood
supply aids in tumor growth.
A 24-year old female patient reports to your office with small red and white oral lesions that are
located on alveolar non-keratinized mucosa. The patient reports that the ulcerations are
intermittent and painful when present, but usually resolve in 7-10 days. What is the most likely
explanation for her symptoms?
A. Primary herpes
B. Recurrent aphthous stomatitis
C. Recurrent herpes
D. Squamous cell carcinoma
E. Acute necrotizing ulcerative gingivitis B. Recurrent aphthous stomatitis
1) Concept: Aphthous stomatitis (Canker sores) is a common cause of benign and noncontagious
mouth ulcers reported in roughly 20% of the population.
3) There is no cure, and treatments are aimed at reducing pain and speeding the healing process.
4) The formation of apthae involves a T cell mediated immune response triggered by a variety of
a factors, including nutritional deficiencies, local trauma, stress, hormonal influences, allergies,
and a genetic predisposition.
A. Ameloblastic Fibro-odontoma
B. Calcifying epithelial odontogenic tumor
C. Compound odontoma
D. Adenomatoid odontogenic tumor B. Calcifying epithelial odontogenic tumor
2) It is a benign tumor that is thought to have originated from the epithelial remnants of the
stratum intermedium of the enamel organ.
3) It is a slowly progressing painless swelling that is often associated with impacted teeth and
occurs most frequently in the molar area but may also appear near premolars.
2) Sialolithiasis
a. unilateral enlargement and rarely is associated with parotid glands and is also known as
salivary calculi or salivary stones.
b. All other answer foils mostly describe conditions that are characterized by a bilateral
enlargement of parotid salivary glands
A 50 year-old man presents to your office for a periodic exam smelling of tobacco pipe smoke.
Upon examination, you notice a raised white lesion covering most of his hard palate and many
red papules within the white lesion. Which of the following is the most likely diagnosis?
A. Hairy Leukoplakia
B. Lichen planus
C. Nicotonic stomatitis
D. Papillary hyperplasia
E. Leukoplakia C. Nicotonic stomatitis
2) The palate may appear gray or white and contain many papules that are slightly elevated with
red in their center.
Upon routine examination, you notice a rubbery, firm, asymptomatic 2mm circumscribed
exophytic nodule within the main body of the parotid gland. The patients states that they have
noticed the nodule for about "a year or so". Which of the following is the MOST LIKELY
diagnosis?
2) Encapsulated Sialolith
a. is a calcified mass with laminated layers of inorganic material
b. commonly occurs in the subandibular gland and presents with pain
3) Mucoceles
a. occur on the inside of lower lips, gums, roof of the mouth and under the tongue
b. they can cause more problems with speech, chewing, and swallowing
1) Concept: Malignant melanomas usually occur along the hard palate, maxillary gingiva,
tongue, mandible, and the buccal mucosa.
2) The incidence of melanomas within the oral mucosa is said to be rare with an occurrence of
less than 1%
3) The prognosis of treating malignant melanoma is said to be poor with a 5-year survival rate of
about 10-25% in the average.
5) The most dangerous form of melanoma, nodular melanoma can be diagnosed with "EFG"
E: Elevated above the skin surface
F: Firm to the touch
G: Growing
In the United State populace, which of the following describes the MOST COMMON location
premalignant lesions of squamous epithelium are observed?
1) Concept: The floor of the mouth and lateral border of the tongue are the most common
locations for the development of squamous cell carcinoma inside the mouth.
2) An explanation for the high potential for premalignant lesions in this area is due to its rich
blood supply because rapidly dividing malignant cells require more nutrition than normal cells.
3) If an ulcer or lesion develops on the floor of the mouth, healing is difficult because of the high
degree of mobility of the tongue and floor of the mouth.
Each of the following is characterized by BILATERAL enlargement of the parotid glands
EXCEPT ONE. Which is the EXCEPTION?
A. Sjogren's syndrome
B. Acute epidemic parotitis
C. Benign lymphoepithelial lesion
D. Malnutrition
E. Sialolithiasis C. Sialolithiasis
2) Sialolithiasis
a. unilateral enlargement and rarely is associated with parotid glands and is also known as
salivary calculi or salivary stones.
b. All other answer foils mostly describe conditions that are characterized by a bilateral
enlargement of parotid salivary glands
Which of the following locations is inflammatory papillary hyperplasia most commonly
observed?
A. Hard palate
B. Labial tissue
C. Posterior gingival tissue
D. Soft palate
E. Anterior gingival tissue A. Hard palate
A. Antrolith
B. Odontoma
C. Osteoma
D. Periapical cyst
E. Mucus retention pseudocyst D. Periapical cyst
1) Concept: Periapical cysts are localized radiolucencies associated with the apex of a tooth that
previously suffered chronic pulpal or periodontal infection
2) Odontomas
a. radiopaque lesions that may occur along the anterior and posterior teeth
3) Osteoma
a. radiopaque benign lesions or bone growth within a membranous bone
4) Antroliths
a. calcified lesions or masses which are usually located along the maxillary sinus
1) Concept: Carcinogenesis
a. Repeated low doses of ionizing radiate may induce irreparable DNA damage which leads to
errors in replication and transcription that result in carcinogenesis
b. Persistent low dose radiation can induce a type of genomic instability in cells that may trigger
viral interactions leading to pre-mature aging and carcinogenesis
c. Ionizing radiation results in the enhancing of the frequency of mutation and other genetic
changes in the descendants of the irradiated cell after many generations of replication.
d. Gap junction mediated cell-cell communication and activation of the p53 damaged response
pathway may result in carcinogenesis.
A 32-year old patient presents to your office with a tender swelling in the submandibular
triangle. The most likely etiology is...
2) Lymphadenopathy
a. condition where the lymph nodes become swollen, tender and enlarged.
b. could be an indication of infection, malignancy, or an auto-immune disease.
c. enlarged lymph nodes within the submandibular triangle are palpable during bi-digital jaw
palpation
Hard Tissue Hard Tissue
Ameloblastoma in the mandible are similar to which of the following conditions
radiographically?
A. Ameloblastoma
B. Salivary gland inclusion defect (Stafne defect)
C. Traumatic bone cyst
D. Focal osteoporotic bone marrow defect
E. Odontogenic keratocyst B. Salivary gland inclusion defect (Stafne defect)
1) Stafne defect
a. depression along the lingual surface of the mandible that is near the tongue and submandibular
salivary gland
b. well demarcated radiolucency that is approximately about 10-35mm in diameter
c. made by ectopically formed salivary gland tissue which is near the submandibular gland
d. not pathologic and is considered a pseudocyst since it doesn't have fluid and epithelial lining
Which of the following conditions exhibit globular dentin, early pulpal obliteration, defective
root formation, periodical granuloma/cysts, premature exfoliation, and appear to be normally
clinically?
A. Amelogenesis imperfecta
B. Dentin Dysplasia
C. Dentinogenesis imperfecta
D. Regional Dontodysplasi
E. Shell teeth B. Dentin Dysplasia
1) Dentin Dysplasia
a. disturbance in normal dentin formation causing
b. pulpal chamber obliteration
c. alteration or absence of root formation
d. premature tooth exfoliation
2) Amelogenesis Imperfecta
a. affects ONLY the formation of enamel and NOT dentin
3) Dentinogenesis Imperfecta
a. form of dentin dysplasia which causes discoloration or some sort of translucency to affected
teeth
Which of the following has the LOWEST probability of being a sign or symptom of a metastatic
jaw lesion?
A. A symptomless radiolucency
B. A tooth that has not erupted
C. A tooth with no mobility of unknown origin
D. Unilateral paresthesia of the patient's lower lip B. A tooth that has not erupted
1) Non-Metastasis
a. un-erupted tooth has the lowest probability of being associated with a metastatic jaw lesion
b. to be in conjunction with an odontogenic cyst such as dentigerous cyst
2) Metastasis
a. unilateral paresthesia of the lower lips
b. symptomless radiolucency
c. tooth having mobility of unknown origin
Radiographs of a 22-year old man disclose a sharply outlined radiolucent lesion in the
mandibular 1st molar area. This 35 mm lesion scallops between the roots of vital teeth. What is
the most likely diagnosis?
A. Odontoma
B. Radicular cyst
C. Traumatic bone cyst
D. Dentigerous cyst C. Traumatic bone cyst
A. Calcification
B. Eruption
C. Initiation/Proliferation
D. Maturation
E. Apposition C. Initiation/Proliferation
1) Fusion
a. a dental abnormality that occurs during the initiation stage of tooth development where two
different tooth buds unite to form one tooth
b. involves the mandibular anterior teeth, particularly the lateral incisors and canines
Radiographs reveal a radiolucency where the right 3rd molar usually resides. The mandibular
right 3rd molar is not present. Which of the following should NOT be included in a differential
diagnosis?
A. Ameloblastoma
B. Dentigerous cyst
C. Odontogenic keratocyst
D. Odontogenic myxoma
E. Residual cyst B. Dentigerous cyst
1) Dentigerous cyst
a. also known as follicular cysts and occur along the crown area of a partially erupted or
unerupted tooth
b. lining of the dentigerous cyst originates from the epithelial cells of the reduced enamel
epithelium of the tooth
A. Ameloblastic fibroma
B. Cementoblastoma
C. Odontogenic adenomatoid tumor
D. Ameloblastoma A. Ameloblastic fibroma
1) Ameloblastic fibroma
a. benign odontogenic tumor arising from epithelial and ectomesenchymal tissues and produces
no mineralized product
b. appears radiographically as sharply demarcated radiolucent lesion
2) Ameloblastoma
a. benign tumor derived from strictly odontogenic epithelium and not ectomesenchyme tissue.
Amelogensis imperfecta and dentinogenesis imperfecta are MOST STRONGLY differentiated
by which of the following features?
A. Blue sclera
B. Hair loss
C. Hereditary background
D. Radiographic appearance
E. Color of the hair D. Radiographic appearance
1) Amelogenesis Imperfecta
a. teeth are covered with thin, abnormally formed enamel
b. enamel is avascular and high calcified and does not contain the proteins ameloblastin,
enameling, tuftelin, and amelogenin
c. teeth are often brown, gray, or yellow
d. crowns of these teeth are often subject to rampant caries and excessive attrition
A clinical examination discloses a soft, fluctuant, tender swelling in the midline of the hard
palate. All maxillary teeth test vital. Radiographs shows a radiolucency between the roots of the
maxillary central incisors, which of the following cysts is the most likely diagnosis?
A. Incisive papilla
B. Median palatal
C. Nasopalatine duct
D. Periapical
E. Nasolabial C. Nasopalatine duct
A. Cementoblastomas
B. Fibroma
C. Salivary gland inclusion defect (Stafne defect)
D. Osteoma *B. Fibroma
1) Fibroma
a. tumors that are composed of fibrous tissues that are usually benign
b. grow anywhere in the body, but usually grow in tissues that arise from the mesenchymal
tissues
2) Stafne defects
a. occur in the mandible along the lingual area near the submandibular salivary gland
3) Cementoblastomas
a. occur within the cementum of affected tooth
4) Osteomas
a. usually occur in the paranasal sinus and nose
Which of the following cysts is an ameloblastoma most likely to develop from?
A. Nasopalatine duct
B. Radicular
C. Traumatic bone cyst
D. Dentigerous D. Dentigerous
1) Ameloblastoma
a. rare benign odontogenic tumor derived from epithelium that occurs more commonly in the
mandible than the maxilla
b. often associated with unerupted teeth
c. rarely malignant or metastatic
d. expand the bony cortices at a slow growth rate that allows time for the periosteum to develop a
thin shell of bone that cracks when palpated.
e. appear multiloculated with "soap bubble" appearance
f. resorption of root of involved teeth can be seen
g. Symptoms include:
1) painless swelling
2) facial deformity
3) loose teeth
4) ulceration
5) periodontal disease
A 33-year-old woman of African American descent is asymptomatic, but presents to your office
for a routine check-up. No evidence of decay is noted, but examination of her radiographs reveal
periodical radiolucencies associated with the apices of her mandibular central incisors. Pulp
testing reveals all teeth respond similarly. What treatment is indicated?
1) Radiolucency is from the tissue destruction that occurred within the periodical area and the
radiopacity that denotes the boundary set by the inflammatory cells as they try to confine the
infection.
2) Once the infection is completely confined by the inflammatory cells, a periodical cyst or a
granulation tissue may form and the damaged bone begins to remodel.
3) The continuous remodeling of the bone creates the solid, well-defined and radiopaque border
around the periphery of the periodical cyst or of the granulation tissue.
A patient exhibiting a "cotton wool" appearance of the bone in their x-rays and an elevated level
of alkaline phosphatase and normal calcium, phosphate, and aminotransferase concentrations in
their blood is most probably suffering from which of the following diseases?
A. Fibrous dysplasia
B. Hyperthyroidism
C. Multiple myeloma
D. Paget's disease of bone
E. Ewing's sarcoma D. Paget's disease of bone
A. Actinomycosis
B. Candidiasis
C. Histoplasmosis
D. Sarcoidosis
E Tinea versicolor A. Actinomycosis
1) Actinomycosis
a. Actionmycosis Isreali is the etiologic bacteria behind actinomycosis infection
b. presence of yellow sulfur granules confirms the presence of actinomycosis colonies
c. characteristics
1) non-painful hard lump in the jaw
2) painful skin abscesses which initiates a red bruise
3) muscle spasms in the jaw leading to locked jaw
Which of the following is the MOST probable diagnosis for a patient that presents with painful
lesions on their buccal mucosa and whose biopsy revealed a suprabasilar vesicle and
acantholysis?
1) Pemphigus Vulgaris
a. autoimmune disorder characterized by the production of antibodies against specific proteins in
the skin and mucous membranes resulting in formation of skin blisters
b. MOST commonly associated with painful lesions on the buccal mucosa.
c. Biopsy reveals a suprabasilar vesicle and acantholysis
2) Necrotizing sialometaplasia
a. infection condition of salivary glands
3) Erythema multiform
a. hypersensitivity reaction occuring in response to medicine, infections, or illness
A. Exfoliative cytology
B. Labial salivary gland biopsy
C. Salivary flow rate
D. Serology
E. Sialograms A. Exfoliative cytology
1) Exfoliative cytology
a. uses the scraped off or exfoliated tissues to evaluate and examine lesions through
cytopathology analysis and CANNOT be used to diagnose Sjugren's syndrome
3) Sialograms
a. used to determine any blockage or clogged structure at the salivary ducts and glands.
b. helpful tool to diagnose or rule out Sjogrens syndrome
Sjogren's Syndrome is associated with each of the following conditions EXCEPT ONE. Which
condition is the EXCEPTION?
A. Arthritis
B. Cervical caries
C. Warthin's tumor
D. Xeropthalmia
E. Xerostomia C. Warthin's tumor
1) Warthin's tumor
a. also known as papillary cyst adenoma lymphomatous is a benign tumor with unknown
etiology that is strongly associated with cigarette smoking and is NOT directly associated with
Sjogren's syndrome
2) Sjogren's Syndrome
a. systemic autoimmune condition in which the autoimmune system attacks the exocrine glands
like the salivary gland and lacrimal gland
b. signs and symptoms
1) arthritis
2) Xeropthalmia
3) Xerostomia
A. Leukocytosis
B. Leukopenia
C. Lymphocytosis
D. Neutropenia
E. Leukemia A. Leukocytosis
1) Leukocytosis
a. patient's white blood cell count is above the normal range
b. indicates an inflammatory response where infection may be present
c. common in patient's suffering from
1) acute illness such as fungal, viral, or parasitic infection, cancer, hemorrhage, and exposure to
substances that include steroids
2) Types of leukocytosis:
a. Neutrophilia (most common)
b. Monocytosis
c. Eosinophilia
d. Lymphocytosis
e. Basophilia
TMJ TMJ Answers
The MOST COMMON cause of intracapsular restraint of mandibular movement is described by
which of the following?
A. Arthrography
B. Arthroscopy
C. Magnetic resonance Imaging
D. Pantomograph
E. Cone-beam computed tomographyA. Arthrography
1) Arthography
a. considered the least effective tool in the assessment and diagnosis of a temporomandibular
joint (TMJ) dysfunctions
b. involves multiple radiographic images with contrast medium in order to assess different
aspects and angles of the TMJ and are difficult to place and interpret
2) Pantomographs
a. Radiographic images used in orthography are 2-dimensional representations of a 3-
dimensional object, so accurate diagnoses are difficult to make at best
b.
3) Arthroscopy
a. less invasive surgical procedure wherein an arthroscope is inserted into a small incision
approximating the TMJ to directly examine or treat inferior portion of the joint
2) In order to lessen the movements within the painful side of the jaw during jaw opening, the
side of the jaw that experiences pain limits its movements.
3) The condyle on the non-painful side maintains its function and therefore appears to move
toward the painful side of the jaw.
Which of the following MOST ACCURATELY describes trigeminal neuralgia (tic douloreux)?
1) Tic douloureux
a. Characteristics
1) having brief episodes of sharp/excruciating pain
2) experience paroxysmal attacks of pain lasting from a fraction of second to 2 minutes
3) Affecting one of more divisions of the trigeminal nerve
4) Pain may or may not be persistent between paroxysms
5) Pain is usually a sudden and sharp/stabbing feeling after stimulating a trigger zone
2) Trigger zones
a. Trigger zones are affected areas within the branches of the trigeminal nerve
b. Trigger zones in one branch, and may spread to other branches over time. The most commonly
affected branches are V2 and V3, but pain can be in just about any location on the head, and
even the index finger.
Which of the following is the most likely diagnosis for a patient presenting to you with a
unilateral, slowly progressing elongation of their face causing malocclusion and deviation of
their chin away from the affect side?
A. Condylar Hyperplasia
B. Myofascial pain disorder
C. Osteoarthritis
D. Rheumatoid arthritis
E. Tooth ankylosis A. Condylar Hyperplasia
1) Condylar Hyperplasia
a. idiopathic, slowly progressive unilateral enlargement of the head and neck of the condyle
b. typically results in crossbite malocclusion, facial asymmetry, and shifting of the midpoint of
chin to the unaffected side
c. treatment is condylectomy if it occurs during the active growth period
d. orthodontics or surgical mandibular repositioning is performed following growth cessation
What is the classic clinical sign or symptom of an anteriorly displaced disc with reduction (ADD
with Reduction)?
(http://bodymechanics.com.au/jaw-tmj-clicking-popping-part1.html)
Anterior Disc Displacement without Reduction Anterior disc displacement (without
reduction)
(http://bodymechanics.com.au/jaw-tmj-clicking-popping-part1.html)
True/False:
Polymorphonuclear neutrophils (PMN) cause tissue damage while protecting host tissues.
Overall, the role of PMNs is described as mostly destructive. The first statement is true and
the second is false
A. Depression psychosis
B. Passive-aggresive behavior
C. Schizotypical behavior
D. Sociopathy
E. Borderline personality disorder A. Depression psychosis
1) Depression psychosis
a. condition which may worsen with the presence of TMJ dysfunction
b. presence of depression is a common condition among people experiencing chronic pain,
especially TMD
c. most pone to TMJ possess a malocclusion
d. factors that cause TMJ disease
1) grinding teeth during sleep (bruxism)
2) overbite
3) rheumatoid arthritis
Most patients suffering from TMJ pain/dysfunction typically exhibit...
A. Evidence of destruction of cortical bone of the condylar head on the affected side
B. Normal dentitions
C. Physical findings of rheumatoid arthritis in other joints
D. No obvious TMJ pathology on pantomographs D. No obvious TMJ pathology on
pantomographs
1) Pantomographs are not useful when diagnosing TMJ pain/dysfunction disorders because only
hard tissues are visible.
2) Relation of the condylar head to the mandibular fossa and articular tubercle are also often
distorted
3) MRI is the preferred method for visualizing the TMJ followed by Cone-beam Computed
Tomography.
Which direction is the articular disc of the TMJ moved if the lateral pterygoid muscle is
contracted?
A. Anterio-laterally
B. Anterio-medially
C. Posterio-medialy
D. Posterio-laterally B. Anterio-medially
1) Exfoliative cytology
a. uses the scraped off or exfoliated tissues to evaluate and examine lesions through
cytopathologic analysis and CANNOT be used to diagnose Sjogren's syndrome.
4) Sialograms
a. used to determine any blockage or clogged structure at the salivary ducts or glands. It is a
helpful tool to diagnose or rule out Sjogren's syndrome.
A patient reports moderate intermittent pain and popping/clicking associated with their right pre
auricular area. The patient has a 45mm maximum incisal opening. What is the most likely reason
for the patient's discomfort?
A. Ankylosis
B. Disc interference disorders
C. Infection
D. Myofacial pain disorders B. Disc interference disorders
A. Arthrosis
B. Chronic dislocation
C. Muscle spasm
D. Unilateral condylar hyperplasia
E. Capsular Fibrosis C. Muscle spasm
1) Occlusal Separators
a. help the TMJ recover from heavy bite forces following muscle spasms
b. separate upper and lower teeth from each other and allow the TMJ to rest and recover
c. they also serve to help the muscles of mastication relax
Which of the following diagnoses is the MOST PROBABLE for a patient with spontaneous
necrotizing ulcers of the oral cavity and a CBC with differential that reveals 68% lymphocytes,
28% monocytes, 2% polymorphonuclear neutrophils, 1% eosinophils, and 1% basophils and
WBC count of 1,986?
A. Infectious mononucleosis
B. Leukemia
C. Primary Herpes
D. Recurrent apthae
E. Systemic Lupus Erythematosis
F. Agranulocytosis F. Agranulocytosis
1) Agranulocytosis
a. health condition manifested with spontaneous mucous membrane ulcerations in the mouth,
vagina or rectum
b. occurs when the body fails to create mature and normal white blood cells making the body
more susceptible to bacterial infection
c. other manifestations
1) sore throat
2) rigor
3) chills
4) fever
Cast gold vs. amalgam 1) Cast gold material provides superior marginal sealing and
physical properties which makes it an ideal material for recreating anatomic contours.
2) Cast gold material can be re-adapted and burnished at the finish lines of the cavity preparation
to ensure a tiger fit and lesser marginal leakage.
Which of the following factors is MOST important when choosing the optimal restorative
martial for a Class V restoration on the buccal surface of a mandibular 2nd premolar?
B. Esthetics
C. Reaction of gingival tissues C. Reaction of gingival tissues
1) Esthetics is not a factor because the Class V restoration is placed at the cervical area of a
mandibular premolar and is not within the esthetic zone.
2) Restorative materials that do not induce gingival tissue reaction should be considered when
selecting the proper restorative material for Class V restorations.
The dentist should mentally plan the outline from before beginning tooth preparation to:
1) Over cutting and over extension compromises the remaining tooth structure and the success of
the restorative procedure. Excess removal of tooth structure may extend close to the pulp,
causing accidental pulp exposure or irritation.
2) Outline Form: shape of the boundaries of the completed cavity; cavity is removed
3) Resistance Form: design feature in the cavity preparation which allows tooth and restoration
to resist the masticatory stresses without fracture
4) Retention Form: design features in the cavity preparation which allows it to retain restoration
securely during function
5) Convenience Form: features in the prepared cavity which improve visibility and accessibility
during preparation and restoration
According to G.V. Black classification, the outline from of a cavity preparation is in the shape of
the cavity preparation
1) Outline Form: describes the outline of the tooth surface to be included in the preparation.
24 hours after the placement of a routine Class V composite, the patient reports discomfort with
the tooth. Which of the following is most likely etiology of the complaint?
A. No liner or base placed under the restoration
B. Root dentin was exposed during the finishing of the restoration B. Root dentin was exposed
during the finishing of the restoration
1) The tooth maybe sensitive after the restoration of #31 caused by inadequate or inaccurate
filling of the cavity preparation resulting to root dentin exposure.
2) The exposed root dentin is more sensitive since the cavity is open and prone to acid attacks.
Anterior maxillary incisors in a middle-aged patients can be given a younger appearance by
performing an enameloplasty that:
1) Rounding the incisal point angles of maxillary incisors removes the sharp angles that make the
teeth appear worn down and abraded.
2) Rounded incisal edges and pointed cusp tips = younger looking smile
1) The centric contact in enamel should be preserved since it established the original and proper
occlusal contact between maxillary and mandibular teeth.
2) Decreasing of removing the centric contact in enamel may cause occlusal disharmony and
unsta
Dental Caries Dental Caries Answers
Which of the following describes a case where compound caries may be found?
A. Calcification
B. Histodifferentiation
C. Proliferation
D. Apposition A. Calcification
Patients who chose not to treat tooth decay may experience...
1) Untreated caries --> affect the pulp --> irreversible pulp damage --> tooth loss
D. Benzodiazepines
E. Opioids E. Opioids
Which of the following patient situations is associated with the highest caries risk?
A. 0.5-1.0 mg/kg
B. 100-200 mg/kg
C. 20-50 mg/kg
D. 300-500 mg/kg
E. 500-800 mg/kg C. 20-50 mg/kg
1) 20-50 mg/kg body weight is the lethal dose of fluoride. Above this range, fluoride starts
showing its toxic effects in the body.
Which of the following is NOT a reason why fluoride prevents tooth decay?
1) Fluoride replaces the hydroxyl groups of the hydroxyapatite crystals of enamel. It then forms
fluoroapatite crystals that are significantly more resistant than acid.
Which of the following portion of primary teeth is staining MOST evident?
A. Cervical
B. Distal
C. Facial/Buccal
D. Incisal/Occlusal
E. Lingual
F. Mesial A. Cervical
1) Class III: proximal surfaces of anterior teeth not including incisal edges
2) Class IV: proximal surfaces of anterior teeth including the incisal edges
3) Class V: smooth facial and lingual surfaces in the gingival 1/3
4) Class VI: occur on the incisal edges or cusp tips
Incipient interproximal caries are typically found...
1) Some patient do NOT like amalgam fillings in molars as these fillings sometimes show during
speech.
2) With para functional habits such as frequent clenching or grinding of teeth indicate that
amalgams or metal crowns are placed.
Which carbohydrate found in human dies is most responsible for caries?
B. Glucose
E. Sucrose E. Sucrose
1) Sucrose (glucose + fructose) is used as a sweetener and is fermented by bacteria into acid,
which helps form caries.
2) Glucose is cariogenic, but is less cariogenic than fructose since it is a monosaccharide not a
disaccharide
Which of the following are considered to be organic components of oral bacterial plaque?
A. Porphromonas gingivalis
B. Streptococcus mutans
C. Streptococcus salivarius
E. Actionmyces viscosus E. Actionmyces viscosus
1) Actinomyces viscosus = commonly associated with acid production and root caries
2) Porphyromonas gingivalis = pathogen of periodontitis
3) Streptococcus gordinii = early colonizers involved in plaque formation
4) Streptococcus mutans = coronal caries
5) Streptococcus salivarius = common oral bacterium and resides on the tongue
Each of the following is suggested to cause the deposition of sclerotic dentin EXCEPT one.
Which one is the EXCEPTION?
A. Abrasion
B. Age
C. Caries
D. Nutrition
E. Occlusal stress D. Nutrition
1) Sclerotic dentin
a. results from aging or mild irritation such as
b. abrasion
c. attrition
d. occlusal stress
e. is harder, denser, less sensitive and more protective of the dental pulp
f. characterized by hyper mineralization or blockage of tubules by the deposition of whitlockite
crystals and be denatured collagen
B. Lacrobacillus casei
C. Porphyromonas gingivalis
D. Streptococcus salivarious
E. Streptococcus sanguinis E. Streptococcus sanguinis
1) After dental plaque is formed, it adheres to the surface of tooth through dextrans.
2) Dextrans are insoluble and sticky and serve to increase the tenacity of the attachment of dental
plaque to the surface of the tooth
3)
The letter "D" in DMFS stands for...
A. Decayed
D. Demineralized A. Decayed
1) DMFS
D: decayed or carious tooth surfaces of all teeth present within the oral cavity
M: missing tooth surfaces of all teeth present within the oral cavity
F: filled surfaces of all teeth present within the oral cavity
S: surfaces
T: teeth
Which of the following is the primary factor in determining the optimal fluoride concentration
for community water?
A. air temperature
B. DMFT score of the community
C. Weight of the average community member
D. Adult to child ration of the community A. air temperature
1) high temperatures --> lower fluoride levels since most people will drink copious amounts of
water
2) low temperatures --> higher fluoride levels since most people will drink less water in this type
of weather
Which of the following factors is MOST related to caries initiation in elderly patients?
A. Bruxism
B. Erosion
C. Gingival recession
D. Attrition C. Gingival recession
1) Acute Caries
a. really soft to touch and caseous (cheesy) in consistency
b. rapid process involving a large number of teeth
c. dental pulp is at risk of irreversible damage
d. lesions are lighter in door mostly light brown and gray
Each of the following accounts for the increased risk of caries risk of elderly people EXCEPT
one. Which is the exception?
1) Oral microflora is relatively constant after initial colonization in childhood. Oral microflora
may be modified with changes in diet, salivary flow, oral hygiene, and etc.
2) Age (increased)
a. increased number of medications used to treat various disease
b. as person ages, acidic are replaced by fibrous and fatty tissue leading to decreased salivary
flow
A. 4.5
B. 5.5
C. 6.5
D. 6.9
E. 1.5 B. 5.5
1) When the pH at the surface of a tooth drops below 5.5, demineralization proceeds faster than
remineralization (there is a net loss of tooth structure on the tooth's surface)
2) Caries process occurs when bacterial acid demineralization excess the remineralization by
salivary components.
The earliest manifestation of a carious lesion is...
A. Cavitation of enamel
B. Change in enamel opacity
C. Radiolucency
D. Rough surface texture
E. Sensitivity B. Change in enamel opacity
1) change in the opacity of enamel becomes more evident along the areas of active caries
progression
2) Caries process demonstrates area of demineralization that are suggested by a chalky white
appearance in the enamel.
3) Change in enamel opacity will eventually leda to further tooth surface destruction and
formation of tooth decay/cavitation is not addressed immediately.
Which of the following treatments is best when superficial decalcification and staining are
evident in the buccal groove of a mandibular molar?
B. Full removal of the affected area with good retention and resistance form and restoration
D. Enameloplasty limited to the superficial depth of the decalcified enamel D.
Enameloplasty limited to the superficial depth of the decalcified enamel
1) Localized and decalcified superficial stains within the limits of the enamel layer can be
addressed by enameloplasty procedures.
Which of the following is the MOST LIKELY diagnosis for a tooth with a cavity floor that is
hard and leathery with a very dark appearance?
A. acute caries
B. aggressive caries
C. chronic caries
D. localized caries
E. severe chronic periodontitis C. chronic caries
1) Chronic caries
a. lesions that are hard, leathery cavity floors
b. dark appearance
c. affect fewer number of teeth and are smaller in size
Which describes the correct order for the progression of carious lesions?
1) Essential to know the fluoride content of the tap water to recognize if supplementary fluoride
sources should be used.
Which of the following anatomical features of a tooth is mistaken MOST OFTEN for a carious
lesion in radiographs?
A. Cingulum
B. Cusp
C. Marginal ridge
D. Pulp Horn
E. Cemento-enamel junction E. Cemento-enamel junction
1) Apparent radiolucency is often found just below the cemento-enamel junction on the root
surface called "cervical burn out" and is often misdiagnosed as root caries in many cases.
A. Accidental trauma
B. Periodontal disease
C. Untreated caries
D. Treated caries C. Untreated caries
1) Untreated caries is the leading reason for the extraction of primary teeth
2) Primary teeth have thinner enamel which makes it easier and faster for bacteria to generate
cavities
Which of the following factors of caries susceptibility is modified most by fluoride therapy and
occlusal sealants?
A. Microflora
B. Substrate
C. Time
D. Host D. Host
1) If the saliva becomes more viscous, its ability to flow is altered resulting in diminished
function in the oral cavity.
2) Saliva fucntions
a. dilute the bacterial acid metabolites that hart teeth
b. buffer acid from cardiogenic bacteria
c. remove food debris on tooth surface
d. remineralized damaged tooth structure
Which of the following should a dentist consider primarily when restoring the incisal edge or
enameloplasty for a patient with slight chipping of the incisal edge of teeth #8 and #9?
1) Very important to consider morphology and translucency when restoring incisal edges of
maxillary incisors
2) Thickness of enamel in the incisal surface area is greater than that of the facial and incisal
surfaces
3) Difference in the thickness of enamel in this area make it appear more radiolucent.
What would happen to the caries risk of a mouse that was fed by a gut tube so that no
carbohydrates would be allowed in the oral cavity?
1) Caries risk
a. amount
b. frequency
c. duration of carbohydrate ingestion
d. presence of fermentable food substrate like carbohydrates in the mouth is necessary for caries
generation
A. Gingival recession
B. Microleakage
C. Premature occlusion
D. Recurrent caries C. Premature occlusion
1) Masticatory sensitivity
a. apical portion of the periodontal ligament experiences excessive pressure or apical periodontal
tissue destruction
b. vital tooth that recently experienced an excessively high occlusal restoration will exhibit
masticatory sensitivity due to being the first tooth to receive the heavy occlusal force during
mastication
c. premature contact is an area of stress concentration that is transmitted to the periodontal
ligament which can cause dental trauma and masticatory sensitivity.
Which composite resin constituent provides the most radiopacity?
A. Barium
B. Fumed Silica
C. Silicate
D. Quartz A. Barium
1) Composite Fillers
a. like quartz, silica, barium, strontium, aluminjm, and zirconium are incorporated in the
composite resin for strength, translucency, and radiopacity
2) Barium
a. metal particle that is a well-known replacement filler for quartz because of its ability to
improve the radiopacity of composites
A very deep MO cavity was restored with an amalgam restoration one month ago with deep
retentive grooves placed into the dentinal line angles of the gingival box. The patient reports pain
in the general area of the tooth, what is the most probable reason for this discomfort?
A. Filled
B. Fluoride release
C. Light cured
D. Opaque/tinted
E. Self-cured E. Self-cured
2) Favorable properties
a. light cured polymerization
b. fluoride release
c. opaque/tinted composites resins in order to differentiate from tooth structure
d. filled composite resin
Which of the following describe the advantages of resin based composite (RBC) as a posterior
restorative material?
1) Silane
a. structural component in resin composite to act as a coupling agent to coat filler particles to
promote adhesion
b. helps to make a bond between the resin composite on one end and the tooth substrate on the
other acting as a bi-functional coupling agent. This process is termed as hybridization and the
structure formed is called hybrid layer.
Which of the following does the bonding of composite material to dentin depend on?
A. Dehydration of dentin
B. Difunctional coupling agents
C. Etching with dilute phosphoric acid
D. Covalent bonding C. Etching with dilute phosphoric acid
1) Bonding
a. dentin bonding mechanisms rely on difunctional coupling agents like silane, which penetrate
into the inherently moist dentin surfaces and are able to copolymerize with composite resins
b. bond strength is obtained from the penetration and adaptation of the bonding agent to the
demineralized inter tubular dentin and exposed collagen fibers
c. interdiffusion zone formed by the bonding agent and the dentin is called hybrid layer
A 35 year old patient presents to your office with unrestored teeth #1-#32 with staining of the
occlusal pits and grooves without a detectable catch with the explorer. What is the best treatment
option...
A. Bis-GMA sealant
B. Conservative class I amalgam fillings
C. No treatment
D. Preventive resin restoration
E. Topical fluoride placement
F. Cyanoacrylate sealant C. No treatment
1) Presence of stains within the occlusal pits and grooves of a sound tooth
2) Arrested Caries
a. dark stains observed in pits and fissures of teeth without any detectable catch is arrested caries,
which occur when a formerly caries affected area of tooth remineralized, stopping the caries
process.
3) Incipient Caries
a. is distinguished by a chalky white appearance on the smooth surfaces of teeth
4) Active Caries
a. distinguished during an oral examination as an explorer catch with soft, easy to flake off tooth
structure
Which of the following describes the primary advantage of placing a microfilmed resin
composite?
A. Abfraction A. Abfraction
1) Abfraction
a. loss of tooth structure caused by flexural forces applied by cyclic loading of the enamel that
usually occurs at the cementoenamel junction (CEJ).
2) Attrition
a. loss of tooth structure by contact with another tooth
3) Abrasion
a. describes the loss of tooth structure by an external force like dentifrice
4) Erosion
a. describes the loss of tooth structure through chemical dissolution by acids NOT of bacterial
origin
A patient of record calls your office complaining of discomfort after a routine class V restoration
was placed yesterday on tooth #31. Which of the following is the likely etiology of the patient'
discomfort?
1) Tooth may be sensitive after the restoration of #31 is probably caused by inadequate or
inaccurate filling of the cavity preparation resulting to root dentin exposure.
2) Exposed root dentin is more sensitive since the cavity is open and prone to acid attacks
Rubber dam clamps must contact the anchor tooth apical to the height of contour and which of
the following to be stable?
1) All 4 tips of the rubber dam clamp should be in contact with the surface of the tooth to provide
maximum stability.
A. Degree of translucency
B. Hue
C. Metamerism
D. Value
E. Penetrance A. Degree of translucency
1) Translucency
a. distance travelled by light into tooth structure before it is reflected back outward is known as
its degree of translucency
2) Metamerism
a. when the angle of lighting of type of light source make colors appear as the same or different
3) Value
a. refers to the lightness or darkness of a certain area or color
4) Hue
a. is the color itself and its distinctive shades
5) Penetrance
a. degree of the ability of light to pass through
During operative procedures, which of the following is the best method for prevention pulpal
damage?
1) Pulpal damage
a. when too much heat is transmitted to dentin causing dentin dehydration
b. dry cutting of the tooth structure causes heat build-up along the tooth surface, eliciting pain
and causes damaged due to trauma to the pulp
c. use of water spray during tooth preparation decreases heat build-up and minimizes dehydration
of dentin
When restoring MO or DO decay, an only is indicated...
1) Onlays
a. reinforce fractured, weakened, or unsupported tooth structure
b. weakened cusps are reinforced by reducing unsupported structure and replacing it with a
durable material capable of bearing heavy occlusal forces
c. restore a cusp of cusps
2) Inlays
a. do not restore cusps
Which of the following is caused by gastric regurgitation?
A. Attrition
B. Erosion
E. Abrasion B. Erosion
1) Erosion
a. caused by gastric regurgitation or reflux, which is characterized by the back flow of gastric
juices in the oral cavity
b. contain HCl, which damages the tooth structure because it has a pH<5.5
c. loss of tooth structure through chemical dissolution by acids NOT created by bacteria
d. by ingestion of acidic beverages in males
e. by bulimia in adolescents or females
f. occurs when oral pH drops below 5.5
The preferable treatment option for a fractured incisal of a mandibular central incisor that is not
pulpally involved in a 10 year old is...
2) Glass Ionomer
a. have short longevity because cannot withstand high occlusal stress load
Which of the following tooth conditions presents the most favorable outcome for tooth
whitening?
A. Aged-yellow teeth
B. Blue-gray teeth
C. Patients with amelogenesis imperfect
D. Patients with old composite-resin restorations A. Aged-yellow teeth
1) Teeth Whitening
a. yellowing of teeth due to age, coffee, and tea staining will demonstrate the most favorable
tooth whitening results due to the stains being extrinsic in nature.
b.
Which dental procedure is a rubber dam most indicated...
A. Composite resin
B. Silicate cement
C. Unfilled resin
D. Amalgam C. Unfilled resin
1) Unfilled resin
a. exhibit higher coefficient of thermal expansion than tooth structure, leading to increased
marginal leakage
b. high CTE means that the resin expands and contracts faster than the tooth, resulting in gaps
that
c. make teeth sensitive to changes in temperature
d. increase marginal leakage
A mature pulp does all of the following EXCEPT one. What is the EXCEPTION?...
A. Forms dentin
B. Forms enamel
C. Provides the nerve blood supply to the tooth
D. Forms cementum B. Forms enamel
1) Mature pulp
a. lay down tertiary dentin throughout life for protection from physical or chemical insult
b. contain capillaries that approximate the dentin just below the layers of odontoblasts, and
nourish the entire tooth
c. innervated by autonomic nerve fibers that control smooth muscles of arterioles and the afferent
sensory fibers coming from the trigeminal nerve
For an Ideal Class V restoration on a mandibular premolar, which of the following is the MOST
IMPORTANT factor when choosing a restorative material?
1) Restorative materials
a. do not induce gingival tissue should be considered when selecting the proper restorative
material for Class V restorations
b. esthetics are not a factor since the Class V restoration is placed at the cervical area of a
mandibular premolar and not in the esthetic zone
c.
A 43 year old male fractures at the distoincisal point angle of #9. The facial of the tooth has
previously been restored with composite resin, from the site of the fracture, you can see that the
layer of composite is very thin and you assume that the remaining strength is questionable. The
patient presents a restoration that would provide the best longevity.
2) Pin-retained amalgam
a. not a good option since it is anesthetically pleasing and pin placement may harm the pulp
1) Cast gold material provides superior marginal sealing and physical properties which makes it
an ideal material for recreating anatomic contours.
2) Cast gold material can be re-adapted and burnished at the finish lines of the cavity preparation
to ensure a tiger fit and lesser marginal leakage.
Each of the following is an advantage of a resin composite for posterior restorations EXCEPT
one. Which is the EXCEPTION?
2) Occlusal evaluation
a. amalgam or gold restorations are recommended in such conditions
3) Advantages
a. low thermal conductivity
b. radiopacity of composite resins
Which of the following materials demonstrates the highest rate of fluoride release, but also the
least resistant to wear?
A. Compomer
B. Glass Ionomer
C. Resin Composite
D. Resin-Modified Glass Ionomer
E. Silica Cement B. Glass Ionomer
1) Glass Ionomer
a. glass ionomer cements have the highest rate of fluoride release and recharge yet possess poor
wear resistance
b. low wear resistance
c. NOT recommended as restorative materials in high stress bearing areas
d. mostly indicated as liners under more strong restorative materials such as composites and
composers
e. can be used in Class III and Class IV cavities where low stresses are encountered
1) Silicate cements
a. not good for restoring teeth with proximal contacts
b. glass particles in silicate cements are easily dislodged from the restorative filling
c. is brittle and prone to surface crazing and chipping on the margins
d. unsuitable for restoring:
1) proximal contacts
2) stress bearing areas
Which of the following would most likely be the result of inadvertently sealing a small occlusal
carious lesion on a maxillary 1st premolar?
2) Arrested caries
a. may appear darker due to staining from recent dimeralization, and does not necessary require
restoration
b. teeth arrested occlusal caries should be sealed to protect the tooth from further damage.
Which of the following is the correct order for listing the occlusal forces applied to the tooth
from greatest to least?
1. Molars
2. Premolars
3. Canines
4. Incisors
A. 1,2,3,4
B. 1,3,2,4
C. 3,2,4,1
D. 4,3,1,2 B. 1,3,2,4
b. Molars can tolerate maximum amount of masticatory loads while incisors can bear minimal
forces of chewing and mastication
c. excessive forces can cause wear or fracture of teeth and their cusps. The normal physiologic
contact wear of teeth is 20 micrometers/year.
d. molars and premolars are important in maintaining the vertical dimensions of face
Each of the following is consider a disadvantage of Microfilled Resin Based Composite
compared to Hybrid-filled Composite EXCEPT one. Which is the EXCEPTION?
e. allow the restoration to bend with tooth flexure, better protecting the bonding interface
f. has greater flexibility and low modulus of elasticity may perform better in certain Class V
restorations than a more rigid hybrid composite
Each of the following is a recognized disadvantage of amalgam restorations EXCEPT one.
Which is the EXCEPTION?
A. Brittleness
B. Does notnd to tooth structure on its own
C. Esthetics
D. Short lifespan D. Short lifespan
1) Amalgam restorations
a. short lifespan is NOT recognized as a disadvantage of amalgam restoration
b. have documented long life in all areas of the oral cavity
c. does NOT bond to tooth structures on its own and require certain retention features like
converging walls and adequate cavity depth
d. disadvantages
1) poor esthetic
2) brittleness
Which of the following describes the BEST clinical reason to place a restoration>
2) Restorations
a. intended to be preventive in regards to future carious activity and has a primary emphasis on
restoring a smooth surface which will NOT allow plaque accumulation
b. restore structure, function, and esthetics are also of prime importance
Which of the following site is the LEAST likely for Class I carious lesions to occur?
A. Calcium Hydroxide
B. Fluoride Varnish
C. Zinc Oxide Eugenol
D. Sodium Hypochorite C. Zinc Oxide Eugenol
1) Zinc Oxide Eugenol
a. type of intermediate restorative material made by mixing zinc oxide powder and eugenol (oil
of cloves)
b. its anesthetic and antibacterial properties make it an ideal material for sedating pulp and
temporarily restoring teeth
c. good interim restoration between endodontic treatments and is also use as sealing material in
obturation of root canals
Which of the following materials are contraindicated as a sealant?
A. Amalgam
B. Glass Ionomer
C. Nanohybrid resin
D. Unfilled resin
E. Microhybrid resin A. Amalgam
1) Sealant
a. biocompatible with the oral tissues
b. resistant to dissolution by oral fluids
c. lasts for a long time in the oral cavity
d. application is not technique sensitive
2) Amalgam
a. contraindicated for small restoration since it is brittle
b. needs a minimum of 1.5mm thickness to obtain flexural resistance
3) Glass Ionomer
a. being used as a sealant because of its ability to release fluoride
Which of the following variables accounts for the primary retention of fissure sealants
1) Micro-mechanical retention
a. primary means of retention for pit and fissure sealants
b. shape and depth of pits and fissure provide mechanical retention for sealants
c. deep pits and fissures are more retentive than shallow pits and fissures
Which of the following materials demonstrates the greatest coefficient of thermal expansion?
A. Compomers
B. Glass ionomers
C. Resin composites
D. Resin-modified glass ionomers C. Resin composites
1) Resin composites
a. greatest value of coefficient of thermal expansion (CTE) among the materials listed
b. rate of dimensional change of a material per unit change in temperature
c. CTE is approximately 3 times that of the tooth structure
d. etching reduces the potential negative effects as well the difference between the CTE of tooth
structure and that of the material
As an amalgam preparation becomes wider buccolingually?
1) Amalgam Restoration
a. becomes wider faciolingually, the following drawbacks can result:
1) tooth is more subject to fracture
2) integrity of the restoration is less likely to be maintained
2) Ideal Dimensions
a. facilingual width of NO more than 1-1.5mm and a depth of 1.5-2mm are considered ideal
taking into consideration the extent of caries progression
The filler particles within resin composites are coated with which of the following substances to
promote adhesion to the matrix?
A. Bis-EMA
B. Big-GMA
C. Comphorquinone
D. Polymethylmethacrylate
E. Silane E. Silane
1) Silane
a. filler particles of the resin composites are coated with silane coupling agents to promote
adhesion to the matrix
b. coupling agent that enhances the bonding between the filler particles and resin matrix
c. synthetic hybrid inorganic-organic compounds which are also used to promote adhesion
between dissimilar materials. Good in promoting adhesion in silica based materials such as
porcelain.
d.
What is the primary reason for administration of prednisolone during an operative procedure?
1) Prednisolone
a. decrease pain stimuli by reducing the production of prostaglandins responsible for the
mediation of pain and inflammation
b. anti-inflammatory steroid drug that functions as an effective inhibitor of phospholipase A2
that is responsible for promoting inflammation
c. down-regulate some pro-inflammatory cytokines and reduce the pulpal inflammation during
operative procedures
Each of the following about spherical alloys compared to admixed alloys is true EXCEPT one.
Which is the EXCEPTION?
1) Admixed alloys
a. yield better inter proximal contacts for Class II restorations
b. tends to resist condensation better than sperical alloys
2) Spherical
a. very plastic and cannot rely on pressure of condensation to establish proximal contour
b. require lower mercury:alloy ratio due to decreased surface area per unit volume
c. have shorter working time, faster setting reaction and poorer adaptation to the cavity walls
Which of the following describes the loss of tooth structure through dissolution by acid NOT
created by bacteria?
A. Abfraction
B. Attrition
C. Erosion
D. No answers apply
E. Abrasion C. Erosion
1) Erosion
a. loss of tooth structure through chemical dissolution by acids NOT created by bacteria
b. most commonly caused by ingestion of acidic beverages in males
c. most commonly caused by bulimia in adolescent females
d. when oral pH drops below 5.5
e.
The most significant factor in IATROGENIC pulpal damage is...
A. Bacterial invasion
B. Heat
C. Proximity of preparation to the pulp
D. DesiccationC. Proximity of preparation to the pulp
1) Pulpal damage
a. avoided by maintaining dentin thickness is 2mm or more
b. number and diameter of dentinal tubules increases with closer proximity toward the pulp, so
the dentin becomes more permeable and easily damaged.
c. dentin has average thickness of 3mm
d. a minimum remaining dentin thickness of 2mm can help prevent pulpal damage
e. dentin thickness of 0.75mm, pulpal reaction to increased bacterial load is observed
f. dentin thickness of 0.25mm, loss of the odontoblasts is observed
A. Low viscosity
B. Lowest fluoride release
C. Sealants on partially erupted molars
D. Used as liner, base, or restorative materials B. Lowest fluoride release
1) Glass Ionomer
a. highest degree of fluoride release
b. used as liners, bases, and restorative materials
c. used as sealant on partially erupted teeth and as caries control restorations in deep cavities
Leakage of the margins of an amalgam restoration...
1) Amalgam restorations
a. release corrosion products that fill in and seal the micro-gap in between the tooth and
restorative material with age
b. improves the seal within the margins, decreasing marginal leakage and percolation of fluids in
the micro-gap
c. considered to be the only dental restorative material that improves its marginal sealing with
age
A patient reports to your clinic in pain for the last two weeks after a well condensed Class V
restoration was placed in tooth #20 4 months previous. The patient reports no discomfort up until
these last two weeks. What is the most likely cause of the discomfort experience by the patient?
1) Cervical region of the tooth has thinner enamel, so caries located there progresses faster if not
immediately restored.
2) Restorative treatment procedures performed on the tooth could have caused trauma to the pul
pouring caries removal which manifested laster due to the inflammation process.
3) Cervical abrasion would take longer than 4 months to manifest
4) Class V fracture would NOT allow the tooth to flex more causing pain.
The tooth most commonly involved in the dental anomaly "dens in dente" or is the permanent:
1) Dens in dente
a. infolding of the outer surface of the tooth and must be diagnosed radiographically
b. "tooth within a tooth" and is also known as Dens invaginatus
c. most often in maxillary lateral incisors and bilateral occurrence is not uncommon
Which of the following esthetic properties dose dentin provide?
1) Dentin provides
a. Chroma: intensity of any particular hue or color.
b. Fluorescence: emission of light by a substance that has absorbed light or other electromagnetic
radiation
c. Opaqueness: absorption and scattering of radiation in a medium. It is neither transparent allow
all light to pass through nor translucent allowing some light to pass through.
Which of the following is the MOST significant disadvantage of glass ionomer cements?
A. Difficult preparation
B. Low bond strength to dentin
C. Moisture sensitivity during initial curing
D. Pulpal irritation C. Moisture sensitivity during initial curing
1) Glass-ionomer cements
a. set through acid-base reaction
b. water loss and moisture contamination must be prevented in order to obtain satisfactory
physical properties
c. desiccation prevents formation of the polycarboxylate matrix, resulting in a rough chalky
surface and decreased surface hardness
d. during the latter part of the reaction, water is essential in hydrating the cross link of the
polymer matrix to strengthen the cement
The American Dental Association (ADA) Statement on posterior resin based composite
restorations suggest their use for which of the following?
1) Smear layer
a. layer of debris produced from grinding on the surface of a cavity preparation
b. tooth surface is altered by rotary and manual instrumentation during cavity preparation,
cutting debris is smeared over the enamel and dentin surfaces, forming the smear layer
c. contains
1) Calcified debris
2) Shattered and crushed hydroxyapatite
3) Fragmented and denatured collagen
4) Bacteria
5) Saliva
6) Dentinal chips
Each of the following statements regarding mercury is true EXCEPT one. Which is the
EXCEPTION?
1) Mercury (Hg)
a. only metal that remains in the liquid sate at room temperature
b. combines with silver-copper-tin alloy to form dental amalgam.
c. can't combine with nickel, chromium, molybdenum, cobalt, and iron under ordinary conditions
to form dental amalgam
d. surface tension of Hg is higher than water
e. in low copper amalgam, Hg is liberated as a result of corrosion to react with an unreacted
gamma phase to produce gamma-1 and gamma phases.
In relation to resin composites, which mechanical property measure the material's ability to resist
the propagation of a crack?
A. Elasticity
B. Flexural strength
C. Fracture toughness
D. Hardness C. Fracture toughness
1) Fracture toughness
a. measures the material's ability to resist the propagation of a crack
b. quantitative way of expressing a material's resistance to brittle fracture when a crack is present
c. brittle fracture = characteristic of materials with low fracture toughness
2) Elasticity
a. tendency of a solid material to return to their original shaped after being deformed.
Which of the following is dentin primarily composed of?
i. Apatite crystal flakes
ii. Elastic fibers
iii. Collagen
iv. Fibroblasts
A. i and ii
B. i and iii
C. i, ii, and iii
D. i, ii, and iv B. i and iii
1) Dentin
a. composed of apatite crystal flakes and collagen fibers
b. 45-50% inorganic component in the form of hydroxyapatite
c. 30% organic mainly collagen
d. 25% water
2) Odontoblasts
a. generate an extracellular collagen matrix as they being to move away from the adjacent
ameloblasts
3) Dentin formation
a. begins immediately before the enamel formation
Which of the following most accurately describes the difference in the thickness of coronal
dentin in primary teeth compared with their corresponding permanent tooth?
A. 33%
B. 50%
C. 66%
D. 75%
E. 25%B. 50%
1) Coronal dentin of primary teeth is typically 50% of the quantity of the coronal dentin found in
permanent teeth because:
2) Primary teeth have pronounced pulp horns which causing less dentin coverage.
3) Permanent teeth are large in size and have smaller pulp spaces in relation to their crown size.
4) Dentin formation occurs throughout life thus increasing the bulk of dentin in permanent teeth
The primary concern in planning a patient's treatment is...
1) Beneficence
a. dentist has a duty to promote your patient's comfort and welfare
b. primary objective of the clinician is to respect the patient's right to be treated in a way that puts
their rights to autonomy, beneficence, justice, nonmaleficence, and veracity above all else
Ramifications due to a lack of inter proximal contacts between amalgam restorations usually
include which of the following?
2) Materials with HIGHER filler contents exhibit LOWER water absorption than materials with
lower filler content
3) Polymerization shrinkage occurs toward the walls of cavity preparations to which it is bonded
most strongly.
1) Smear Layer
a. defined as debris, calcific in nature which is produced by reduction or instrumentation of
enamel, dentin, and cementum
b. interfere with any adhesive bond formed between the tooth strutter and the restorative material
c. 2 strategies used to overcome the low attachment strengths of smear layer
1) removal of the smear layer prior to bonding by acid etching
2) use of bonding agents that can penetrate the smear layer and incorporate it into the bonding
layer
A. Hyperemic pulp
B. Irreversible pulpitis
C. Necrotic pulp
D. Reversible pulpitis
E. Chronic pulpal inflammation D. Reversible pulpitis
1) Acute Reversible Pulpitis
a. transient condition of the pulp where in it experiences unusual sensitivity due to the following
causes:
b. Thermal Shock
1) pulp is damaged by heat generally created by friction during the preparation process or
polishing the restoration
c. Trauma
1) induced by a blow to the tooth or improper occlusal relationship
d. Desiccation
1) tooth is prepared without the utilization of a high-speed hand piece without a water jet
f. Chemical stimulus
1) sweets are easily fermented and bacteria easily forms acid by products that triggers the
sensitivity
2) sour foods on their own are acidic by nature and could demineralize the tooth surface and
cause sensitivity
g. Caries extension
1) continuous bacterial attack on the tooth surface causes pain and sensitivity to tooth
2) pain is lost after stimulus is removed
Resin Modified Glass Ionomers are _____ compared to Resin Composite materials.
2) Compared to RMGIC
a. stronger
b. more color stable
c. more wear resistant
What is the most accepted treatment for mottled enamel (Colorado brown
stains/Hyperfluorosis/Chalky enamel white enamel with brown spots)
1) Mottled enamel
a. combination of small white, brown and yellow spots are seen all over the suffices of the teeth
2) Microabrasion
a. fast, pain-free treatment that is effective in lightening or completely removing the yellow,
white and brown stains seen on mottled enamel
b. removes a thin layer of stained enamel with the use of pumice and hydrochloric acid.
c. Hydrochloric acid whitens the stains in the tooth surface and has an effect that lasts for a few
days after its application.
Which of the following describes the 1st step in cavity preparation according to G.V. Black?
A. Convenience form
B. Outline form
C. Resistance form
D. Retention form B. Outline form
1) Outline form
a. initial extension or the outline form of the tooth preparation should be visualized
preoperatively by estimating the extent of the defect, the preparation form requirements of the
amalgam, and the need for the adequate access to place amalgam into the tooth
A. The calcium hydroxide has induced reparative dentin formation to completely heal the
exposure
B. The lack of symptoms may be temporary, and the tooth may become symptomatic later
C. The pulp cap was a success
D. Tertiary dentin has been laid down to heal the exposure site permanently B. The lack of
symptoms may be temporary, and the tooth may become symptomatic later
1) Histological analysis and not with clinical signs and symptoms that the tooth elicit, so it is
impossible to truly know the pulp status with out extracting the tooth or waiting for symptoms to
arise
2) Asymptomatic condition of the pulp at present could never determine the status of the pulp
Which of the following is the mechanism by which mercury enters the body that is considered to
induce the highest toxicity?
A. Absorbed through the skin
B. All mechanisms of absorption are equally toxic
C. Ingestion
D. Inhalation D. Inhalation
1) Most toxic form of mercury to enter the body is through inhalation of mercury vapors
2) 80% of elemental and inorganic mercury is absorbed in the lungs.
In patients with cusps undermined, by decay and heavy occlusal forces, the restorative material
of choice is...
A. Amalgam
B. Cast gold
C. Glass Ionomer
D. Composite resin B. Cast gold
1) Cast Gold
a. Patient with undermined cusps and heavy occlusal forces, cast gold is the restorative material
of choice
b. Gold is the most durable restorative material
c. can be easily finished, polished, burnished and adapted to tooth structure to decrease recurrent
caries risk
d. highest corrosion resistance of any restorative material
Which of the following describes the loss of tooth structure through contact with another tooth?
B. Attrition B. Attrition
1) Attrition
a. loss of tooth structure by contact with another tooth
b. occurs most frequently in patients who suffer from bruxism or who habitually intake
stimulants both prescribed and illegal
2) Abrasion
a. describes the loss of tooth structure by an external force like dentifrice
3) Erosion
a. loss of tooth structure through chemical dissolution by acids NOT of bacterial origin
The properties of zinc-oxide eugenol can be describe by the each of the following EXCEPT one.
Which is the EXCEPTION?
1) Zinc-oxide eugenol
a. pulpal sedaton
b. cavity base
c.interim dental restoration
d. can be easily adapted into the walls of cavity preparation and will stay intact when properly
condensed into the cavity
e. zinc-oxide eugenol cement as temporary restorations is specifically indicated when tooth has a
very deep cavities eliciting pulp sensitivity and requires further observation prior to placement of
final restoration
The term for when different types of light sources makes color appear different is...
A. Metamerism
B. Opalescence
C. Translucency
D. Fluoroscence A. Metamerism
1) Metamerism
a. where colors which appeared similar in a particular light source appear different when
observed with another light sources
2) Fluorescence
a. light absorbed by a substance is emitted back in a longer wavelength
3) Opalescence
a. appears yellowish-red when light is transmitted through it
b. material appears blue in the scattered light that is perpendicular to the transmitted light
4) Translucency
a. when light is permitted to pass through a material but is diffused within the material, making
the image on the opposite side not clearly visible
General Operative Procedures General Operative Procedures Answers
Which of the following compounds is responsible for the photoinitiaion step of light-cured
sealants?
A. Benzoyl peroxide
B. Bisphenol A
C. Camphoroquionone
D. Fluoride
E. Fumed Silica C. Camphoroquionone
1) Camphoroquionone
a. used as a photo initiator and visible light or argon laser is used as the activator in light cure
sealants
2) Benzoyl Peroxide
a. incorporated as a component in auto-curing/self-curing sealants
3) Sealants
a. most important requirements of a pits and fissure sealant is that it should prevent leakage at its
periphery and gives an adequate working time
b. adherence of pits and fissure sealants and working time is significantly better in light cured
sealants as compared to chemical cure sealants
Which of the following statements it CORRECT?
2) Retentive pins
a. in Class IV restorations are CONTRAINDICATED because they can show through the tin
enamel and give an unaethetic appearance to the solution
3) Rebonding
a. completed at the end of restorative procedures is does NOT decrease marginal integrity and
color stability
4) Metamerism
a. complication in color perception as various light sources produce different perceptions of
color. It will create problems in shade selection.
Name the technique where deep caries are excavated from a tooth, and a small amount of
affected dentin is left provided that caries-free DEJ is present, and a base is placed along with a
permanent restoration?
e. Steps
1) Infected dentin is completely removed
2) Affected dentin close the pulp is left due to the possibility of pulp exposure
3) Calcium hydroxide, then glass ionomer is placed over the affected dentin
4) Final restoration is placed
f. Calcium hydroxide
1) placed on the affected dentin to induce its remineralization and promote the reparative dentin
formation
Each of the following is an indication for the placement of placing a base EXCEPT one. Which
is the EXCEPTION?
1) Bases
a. replace missing tooth structure and support the final restoration
b. insulate the pulp from drastic temperature changes experiences by the restoration
c. provide structure to condense against when placing amalgam
d. protect the pulp from agents which may irritate it
Which of the following describes Metamerism?
A. A complication observed when the perceived color of objects is different in differing light
sources
B. A disease associated with high soda consumption
C. A problem caused by over etching
D. The closing of dentin tubules
E. When color changes due to wetness A. A complication observed when the perceived
color of objects is different in differing light sources
1) Metamerism
a. complication observed when the perceived color of object is different in differing light sources
b. various light sources produce different perceptions of color
c. color of the surrounding environment influences what is in the patient's mouth
d. complicates the selection of the appropriate shade of the restorative material
Each of the following statements is TRUE concerning resin based composite restorations
EXCEPT one. Which is the EXCEPTION?
2) Occlusion
a. It is necessary to carry out occlusal evaluation before restoring if possible
3) Pre wedging
a. helps in obtaining an adequate contact in the final restorations
1) C-factor
a. ratio of bonded to unbounded or free surfaces in a tooth preparation
b. the greater the C-factor, the greater the potential for bond disruption from polymerization
shrinkage.
c. Class IV restoration has the lowest c-factor
d. Class I restoration has the highest c-factor
3) Composites
a. polymerization shrinkage is one of the biggest concerns regarding the composite resins
Each of the following is a reason adjacent Class I I or Class III cavities should be prepared and
restored using a composite resin during a single appointment EXCEPT one. Which is the
EXCEPTION?
e. the fact that the caries to be restored are adjacent does not improve the contact of the
restoration
Which of the following materials possess the strongest ability to recharge its fluoride?
A. Compomer
B. Glass Ionomer
C. Resin based glass ionomer
D. Resin composite B. Glass Ionomer
A. Surfaces smoother than usual will give the impression of a larger size
B. Teeth appear smaller when the value is increased
C. The illusion of increased length can be achieved with horizontal highlights
D. The illusion of increased width can be achieved with vertical highlights A. Surfaces smoother
than usual will give the impression of a larger size
1) Smooth Surfaces
a. give the impression of larger size and vice versa
2) Increased value
a. teeth appear larger than their actual size when the value is increased
3) Illusion
a. art of changing the perception of an object to appear different from what it is
b. illusion of size, shape, length, and color are created to solve or hide an esthetically difficult
situation
c. increased length: achieved with vertical highlights
d. increased width: achieved with horizontal highlights
When utilizing four-handed dentistry, the assistant should be positioned...
1) Four-handed dentistry
a. assistant should sit close to the back of the patient's chair higher than the dentist to facilitate
visibility
b. position is suitable for better view of the site, instruments and materials from the mobile cart
or instrument tray
c. allows you access to these materials without leaning or overextending your arms
d. assistant stools should be placed in a position so that their eye level is 4 to 6 inches higher than
the dentist's
For a class V restoration where should in the rubber dam be punched?
1) Angle formers
a. hand instruments with their cutting edge sharpened at an angle to the axis of the handle
b. used to create bevels, refine pulpo-axial line angles, and smooth margins
c. also called "marginal trimmers"
Each of the following is a criteria when determining the effectiveness of a visible light-curing
unit EXCEPT one. Which is the EXCEPTION?
1) Composite resins
a. do not typically release and therefore is NOT a factor in determining the effectiveness of a
visible light-curing unit
2) Criteria
a. wavelength of the curing light is an important consideration
b. normal range of composite curing light units is approximately 470 nm.
c. shade of the composite resins also affects the penetration of light required for curing.
d. exposure time should neither be overextended nor kept short
Which of the following describes the blade length on a cutting instrument with a four number
formula of : 10 95 7 14
A. 1 mm
B. 10 mm
C. 14 mm
D. 7 mm
E. 9.5 mm D. 7 mm
A. Blade, Condenser
B. Blade, Hatchet
C. Blade, Periodontal Probe
D. Shaft, Forceps
E. Shank, Explorer A. Blade, Condenser
1) The blade of the gingival marginal trimmer corresponds to the nib of the condenser.
2) Gingival margin trimmers are cutting instruments while condensers are non cutting
instruments.
4) Nibs
a. working ends or nibs of the condenser may be of any shape but they are usually round with flat
ends. Triangular, rectangular or diamond shaped nibs are also used.
Which of the following statements is TRUE?
1) Bond Strength
a. relies upon the formation of resin tags in enamel
2) Acid Etching
a. thought to remove the smear layer and creates a micro porous enamel layer on which resin tags
are formed by adhesive resins
b. 2 step etch and rinse adhesives consume longer time periods as compared to the self-etch
adhesives
c. can be done on both enamel as well as dentin
After recurrent Class V caries were found on a molar that extends subgingivally, crown
lengthening surgery was performed to expose 3+mm of root structure. The best design features
would include:
1) Margins Concept
a. margins of cavity preparation should always be placed in sound tooth structure
2) Prepared teeth should always have supported tooth structure surrounding the restorative
material to decrease the chances of tooth fracture from occlusal stresses
A. Cornea
B. Iris
C. Lens
D. Retina
E. Cilliary muscle D. Retina
1) Continuous exposure to visible light used for curing the composite can cause serious damage
to the RETINA.
2) Care should be taken to look directly at the visible light cure sources.
3) Use a light curing machine with a protective barrier covering the light source.
1) The most likely cause of the interdental papillae bulging out from underneath of a rubber dam
is when the rubber dam holes are punched too close together.
2) Holes punching too close together cause the material to stretch too much and prevent the
rubber dam from adapting properly.
3) Lack of adaptation creates space of fluid seepage and contamination and rubber dam tearing
may occur more easily
Which of the following locations is ideal for the placement of a microfilm composite?
A. Class I
B. Class III
C. Class IV
D. Class V D. Class V
1) Microfill composites are considered an appropriate choice for restoring Class V cervical
lesions or defects in which cervical flexures can be significant.
2) This is true for cases of bruxism, clenching and stressful occlusion. Their low modulus of
elasticity allows them to flex during tooth flexure, better protecting the bonding interface.
3) Microfilled composites also provide a smooth and polished surface in the finished restoration
that is less receptive to plaque.
If a rubber dam is abnormally wrinkled between teeth, the probable reason is...
1) Large areas between holes in the rubber dam sheet cause wrinkling due to excess material
between teeth.
2) Excess material between the holes became evident with the folding of the rubber dam septum
in-between the holes.
3) Excess material increase the difficulty of passing the rubber dam through the contact area.
A. A final veneer layer of microfilled resin will help create a smooth, glossy surface.
B. It is recommended to use retentive pins for support on Class IV restorations.
C. No answers apply
D. Tooth fragments should never be reattached to the remaining tooth structure A. A final
veneer layer of microfilled resin will help create a smooth, glossy surface.
1) A final veneer layer of micro filled resin will help create a smooth and glossy surface due to
its small sized particles.
2) Polished surfaces are less receptive to plaque accumulation and extrinsic staining
3) Retentive pins are never recommended for support and retention in Class IV restorations.
Which of the following is the instrument grasp MOST commonly used in operative dentistry?
A. 2-handed grasp
B. Palm grasp
C. Palm-thumb grasp
D. Pen grasp D. Pen grasp
1) Pen grasp is the MOST frequently used instrument grasp in operative dentistry procedures.
3) Palm grasp
a. used for bulky instruments
b. commonly used for surgical forceps, rubber damp clamp forceps, straight chisels, and the
air/water syringe.
4) Palm-thum grasp
a. used by the assistant for holding the oral evacuator.
b. operator may use this with instruments that require a more vertical movement
Dental burs are MOST COMMONLY made from which material?
A. Galvanized iron
B. Iron
C. Steel carbide
D. Tungsten carbide D. Tungsten carbide
c. Different Types
1) Cutting burs
2) Excavation burs
3) Finishing and polishing burs
d. Finishing and polishing tungsten carbide burs have more flutes compared to cutting burs. The
number of flutes range commonly ranges from 12-30.
To extend the life of a tungsten carbide bur, the bur should...
1) The lifespan of a tungsten carbide bur can be extended by bringing the bur up to speed before
contacting tooth structure, because it decreases the friction between the bur and the tooth
structure thereby decreasing damage to the bur and the pulp.
2) Sufficient rotating speed makes the cutting edge of the bur more efficient even with using
light pressure.
3) Heat sterilization corrodes the carbon steel and anneals the cutting edge of the bur.
The maxillary incisors of a middle-aged patient can be made to appear younger through
enameloplasty that includes
1) Rounding the incisal point angles of maxillary incisors removes the sharp angles that make the
teeth appear worn down and abraded.
2) Rounded incisal angles and pointed cusp tips create the illusion of a younger looking smile.
Rounded incisal angles also make a person appear more feminine, while square looking incisal
angles suggest masculinity.
3) Shortening and flattening of incisal edges makes a person appear older since it insinuates
abrasion of teeth due to old age.
Each of the following can be achieved with a properly trimmed wooden wedge EXCEPT ONE.
Which is the EXCEPTION?
1) A well-fitted and properly tightened matrix band placed between the filling surface and
adjacent proximal tooth surface to prevent over contouring of the contact point.
2) A proper contact point is important for the life of the restoration and gingival health.
3) Food impaction and gingival disease may occur if a contact point is NOT properly established.
4) A properly trimmed wooden wedge placed in the interdental space below the matrix band can
help to,
a. protect the gingiva
b. provide space for the matrix band placement
c. reduce leakage of moisture ion the cavity preparation
d. prevent material from leaking out during condensation
When placing a light cure resin composite in a deep cavity preparation, the composite should be
placed in increments of no greater than...
A. 0.5mm
B. 1 mm
C. 1.5 mm
D. 2 mm
E. 2.5 mm D. 2 mm
1) When placing a light cured resin composite in a deep cavity preparation, the composite should
be placed in increments of no greater than 2mm.
2) Composite should be placed incrementally to facilitate proper light activation, combat
polymerization shrinkage stresses, and the development of correct anatomy. The deepest portions
of the tooth preparation are restored first incrementally.
3) An anatomic layering technique is preferred. The operator places and light-activates one
increment per cusp at a time and continues to place subsequent increments until the preparation
is filled with development of anatomic contours.
Which of the following is the reason trituration is completed?
1) The primary objective of the process of trituration of amalgam is to remove the oxide coating
and wet each particle of alloy with mercury.
2) Properly triturated amalgam is a homogenous mass with slightly reflective surface. It flattens
slightly if dropped on a tabletop.
3) A correctly mixed amalgam should have sufficient wetness to aid in achieving a well-adapted
restoration and NOT be dry or crumbly.
Which of the following does not damage soft tissue?
1) Fluoride
a. in small controlled doses helps to strengthen teeth nd does not cause harm to the gums
3) Gingival retractors
a. placement of gingival retractors into the sulcus also causes certain damage to the marginal
gingiva as the retraction cord displaces them from their original location.
1) Zinc
a. is added to amalgam to prevent the oxidation of other metals in the alloy during the
manufacturing process, which keeps the alloy from turning dark.
b. accomplishes this by combining readily with oxygen to form zinc oxide
2) Zinc Benefits
a. enhances the mechanical properties of amalgam
b. reduces marginal fracture rate
c. prolongs the service of the restoration
Name the technique where a deep caries are excavated from a tooth, and a small amount of
affected dentin is left provided that a caries-free DEJ is present, and a temporary restoration is
placed then replaced with a permanent restoration following analysis 6 months later?
1) When sharpening an instrument, the bevel of the blade is placed at an angle of 45o to the
sharpening stone. This ensure maximum efficiency of the blade to sharpen the instrument.
2) Instrument sharpening is an important aspect of operative dentistry. Dull instruments are not
recommended for carrying out procedures in the oral cavity.
3) Dull instruments
a. produce more heat
b. less efficient and can damage tooth structure
c. recommended to discard those instruments which cannot be sharpened.
Light-cured composite resin is most affected by which of the following variables?
A. Opacity of enamel
B. Shade of material
C. Thickness of increment
D. Length of exposure C. Thickness of increment
1) Polymerization of light cure composites is dependent upon the penetration of light through the
composite resin
2) As the material thickness increases, the penetration of light decreases, which may lead some
composite unpolymerized, resulting in the failure of restoration.
3) Place composite resin in small increments is advised because it allows for complete
penetration of curing light and complete polymerization.
1) Sealants
a. should NOT be used on all patient's teeth
b. indicated for either preventive or therapeutic uses, depending upon patient's caries risk, tooth
morphology or presence of incipient enamel caries
c. only caries-free pits and fissures or incipient lesions in enamel no extending to the DEJ are
recommended for treatment with pits and fissure sealants
d. Advantages
a. Perform as a physical barrier
b. Prevent bio film from collecting within a pit or fissure
c. Sealant placement is considered as non-invasive procedures
Each of the following describes an ideal ergonomic position for dental work EXCEPT one.
Which is the EXCEPTION?
1) Ergonomic position
a. at least 10 inches or more space between his/her nose and patient's oral cavity in order to
achieve better visualization, controlled instrumentation and convenient working environment.
b. elbows at 90o or greater
c. operator's weight should be supported using the entire seat/stool surface to maintain balance
Each of the following are TRUE regarding self-curing sealants EXCEPT ONE. Which is the
EXCEPTION?
1) The setting reaction of self cure or chemical cure or auto-curing sealants is exothermic in
nature.
2) Significant amount of heat energy is liberated. It is advised to use light curing sealants for
safety, good manipulation and ease of handling.
3) Auto curing sealants are composed of benzoyl peroxide or tertiary amines.
4) Late manipulation can disrupt polymerization.
A carious lesion is detected clinically and is confirmed radiographically extending from the
distal pit to the central fossa along the central groove of #19. The planned amalgam preparation
and restoration should
A. Extend from the distal pit to the central fossa along the central groove. It should also include
any enamel undermined by the removal of carious tooth structure
B. Extend from the distal pit to the medial pit, along the central groove
C. Extend from the distal pit to the medial pit, along the central groove. Buccal and lingual
extension should be prepared as well, from the central fossa along the buccal and lingual grooves
D. Span the entire occlusal surface, along the central groove, including both the medial and distal
marginal ridges A. Extend from the distal pit to the central fossa along the central groove.
It should also include any enamel undermined by the removal of carious tooth structure
1) The depth of the preparation should be at least 1.5-2mm in order to provide strength to the
restoration.
2) The pulpal floor depending upon the enamel thickness is almost always in dentin.
Which of the following tooth structures is (are) affected by tooth bleaching?
1) Bleaching agents like hydrogen peroxide and carbide peroxide act on the tooth enamel only
unless root dentin is exposed during bleaching.
2) Oxidation of enamel surface stains and impurities is carried out by these bleaching agents.
4) Discoloration of tooth enamel caused by extrinsic stains can be corrected with the help of
tooth bleaching or tooth whitening procedures.
The remaining cusps should be evaluated if the faciolingual width of a Class I preparation
exceeds a distance of _____ the facial and lingual cusp tips?
A. 1/2
B. 1/3
C. 1/4
D. 3/4 B. 1/3
1) If the faciolingual width of a Class I preparation exceeds 1/3 of the distance between facial
and lingual cusp tips, the remaining cusps should be evaluated.
2) If extension from a primary groove toward the cusp tip is no more than half the distance, no
cusp capping needs to be done.
3) If this extension is 1/2-2/3 of the distance, consider cusp cupping. If the extension is more
than 2/3 of the distance, cusp capping is usually recommended.
A patient presents with a carious lesion that my result in a pulp exposure upon preparation for an
MOD amalgam restoration on a vital and asymptomatic tooth. Which of the following should the
clinician do?
A. Leave the infected dentin in the deeper areas, temporize the tooth and observe it for 2 weeks
then restore or initiate root canal treatment.
B. Remove the carious dentin completely then initiate root canal treatment
C. Remove the infected dentin laterally first before removing it completely from the deeper parts
of the carious lesion
D. Leave the affected dentin in the deeper areas, apply a base material, then restore. D.
Leave the affected dentin in the deeper areas, apply a base material, then restore.
A. 12
B. 18
C. 24
D. 6
E. Finishing carbide burs do not have flutes A. 12
1) The minimum number of flutes needed on a carbide bur to be considered as a finishing bur is
12.
2) Carbide burs
a. used most commonly for excavating and preparing cavities, finishing cavity walls, finishing
restoration surfaces, drilling old fillings, finishing crown preparations, contouring bone,
removing impacted teeth, and separating crowns and bridges.
b. made of tungsten carbide, a metal that is extremely hard and can withstand high temperatures
c. carbide has high hardness and can maintain a sharp cutting edge and be used many time
without becoming dull
d. carbide burs are brittle and have a tendency to fracture under pressure. Because of their
brittleness, they are best operated at high speeds with light pressure.
A. 1, 2, and 5
B. 1, 3, 4, and 5
C. 1, 3, and 4
D. 2 and 4
E. 3 and 5 B. 1, 3, 4, and 5
1) Longer light exposures usually are required for the polymerization of dark and opaque shades.
2) An increase from the typical amount of curing light (e.g. 30-40 seconds), when using a
tungsten halogen light is necessary in microfilmed resins, dentin shade resin, cold or refrigerated
resin and with a larger diameter tip
3) In addition to classic tungsten halogen light, plasma arc curing systems and blue light-emitting
diodes (LEDs) are available which are more efficient, more portable, and more durable.
Which of the following creates the phenomena of dentinal plugs?
A. Adhesive
B. Debris from the smear layer
C. Oxalic acid
D. Primer (from micro/macrotags)
E. Sclerotic dentin B. Debris from the smear layer
1) Dentinal or smear plugs are composed of debris from the smear layer
2) Smear layer is documented to be about 0.5-2.0mm thick layer of debris with a mainly granular
substructure that entirely covers the dentin. The surface of the smear layer appears quite
irregular.
3) The orifices of dentinal tubules are obstructed by debris tags known as smear plugs or dentinal
plugs. These dentinal plugs extend into the tubules to a depth of 1-10 micrometers.
4) Smear layer is reported to reduce dentinal permeability by about 86% due to dentinal
plugging.
5) Dentinal plugs are removed by acid etching the tooth surface with phosphoric acid.
Each of the following is an advantage of using the acid-etch technique for composite resin
restorations with minimally cavity preparations EXCEPT one. Which is the EXCEPTION?
A. Improved esthetic outcomes
B. Improve retention of the restoration
C. Maximum conservation of tooth structure
D. Improved access for finishing of the restoration D. Improved access for finishing of the
restoration
1) Acid etching
a. creates microporosities that adhesive can infiltrate to create retention for composite resin
bonding
b. roughens the enamel rods and dentin thus creating micro mechanical abrasions that allows the
bonding agent to flow and adhere to the tooth surface
c. removes surface debris, allowing for a clean bonding site for improved esthetics
d. creates higher bond strength between composite restorations and tooth structure and decreases
micro leakage
A. 20,000 mJ/cm2
B. 200,000 mJ/cm2
C. 2000 mJ/cm
D. 500 mJ/cm2 A. 20,000 mJ/cm2
1) The radiant exposure for a curing light producing 1000 mW of power with a spot size of 2
cm2 and an exposure time of 40 seconds is 20,000 mJ/cm2.
2) Dental curing light is a piece of dental equipment that is used for polymerization of light cure
resin based composites
3) It can be used on several different dental materials that are curable by light.
1) Concept: Marginal ridges should be supported by dentin to avoid fracture under heavy
occlusal forces and should NOT be undermined
2) Undermined marginal ridges are easily fracture because the enamel in these areas is
unsupported
3) Dentin supported marginal ridges provide the best fracture resistance against heavy occlusal
forces.
A cast gold restoration is retained primarily by...
1) Concept: Cast gold restoration is retained primarily by retention and resistance form of the
cavity preparation.
2) Retention
a. form prevents the removal of the restoration along its path of placement by the occlusal forces
b. achieved with parallel walls with minimal taper to facilitate a single pathos placement of the
restoration
3) Resistance
a. resistance form resists the dislodgment and movement of restoration under directed apical,
oblique, or occlucsal forces.
b. achieved with the use of fish tail and dovetail preparations, presence of grooves, slots and
pins.
Which of the following is the MOST IMPORTANT reason a dentist should visualize the outline
form before they begin to prepare a tooth?
1) Concept: Overcutting and over extension compromises the remaining tooth structure and the
success of the restorative procedure
2) Cutting extensively without a thorough knowledge of dental anatomy could result in excessive
removal of tooth structure that may extend too close to the pulp, causing accidental pulp
exposure or irritation.
3) Undermining cusps and overextending the cavity outline weakens the remaining tooth
structure. Large cavities are too difficult to restore and normally result in a greater chance of
post-operative sensitivity.
Which of the following should be the proximal cavosurface angle be on for a MO preparation?
A. 120o
B. 30o
C. 45o
D. 60o
E. 90o E. 90o
2) It helps to conserve the dentinal support and the strength of the restoration and enables the
restoration to withstand the forces of mastication adequately without undergoing fracture.
Which of the following describes how the surface of the enamel should appear after acid etching
of the enamel is complete?
1) Concept: After acid etching of the enamel tooth surface, it appears white and opaque in
appearance commonly described as possessing a frosty appearance.
2) The frosty appearance is due to the action of acids causing selective demineralization of the
area, creating porosities in the superficial enamel surface.
3) Resin tags are formed in the porosities following application of adhesive and resin composite
materials, creating micro mechanical interlocking and a strong resin bond is formed.
Which of the following permanent tooth pulp horns is at the most risk for a potential accidental
exposure during a preparation for a Class II amalgam?
1) When making a Class II cavity preparation, the pulpal floor along the buccal cusp of the
mandibular 1st premolar should be higher than the lingual to avoid encroaching on its prominent
buccal pulp horn.
2) Mandibular premolars have a more prominent buccal cusp and consequently, a prominent
buccal pulp horn.
3) The position of the pulp follows the external anatomy of the tooth which must always be
considered during preparation of cavities
Which of the following is/are considered reason(s) to place bevels into enamel?
A. All answers apply
B. To enhance esthetics if the margin is in a visible location
C. To remove fragile enamel
D. To smooth the cavorestorative margins A. All answers apply
1) Concept: Enamel bevels are generally placed to minimize the line of demarcation at the tooth-
restoration interface. The bevel is commonly placed at a 45-60 degree angle.
1) Concept: A facial bevel of approximately 2mm should be placed in order to achieve the most
esthetically pleasing Class IV resin-based composite restorations. Bevel is placed at an angle of
45-60 degrees.
1) Concept: It is recommended to remove the carious dentin near the pulp in a Class II
preparation with a large very slowly rotating bur. This precaution is necessary to prevent
accidental pulp exposures during caries excavation.
4) Sharp explorer tips are contraindicated to use near the pulp because they might pierce the
dentin and create a small pulp exposure.
Which of the following terms describe the line, or angle formed by the junction of a cavity all
with unprepared surface of the tooth?
A. Cavosurface angles
B. Dimensional angles
C. Line angles
D. Point angles
E. wall A. Cavosurface angles
1) Concept: The line or angle formed by the junction of a cavity wall with the unprepared surface
of the tooth, that is a continuous entity enclosing the entire external outline of the prepared
cavity, is termed as the cavo-surface angle.
2) Point angle
a. angle formed between 2 cavity walls and a floor or between 3 walls
3) Line angle
a. is formed between 2 walls or a wall and floor of a cavity
Which of the following describes a major difference between a Class V preparation form
amalgam versus a composite restoration
A. Convenience form
B. Depth of the preparation
C. Outline form
D. Angulation of the enamel cavosurface margins D. Angulation of the enamel cavosurface
margins
2) Enamel cavosurface margins for an amalgam restoration should have no bevel to avoid
amalgam fracture due to lack of minimum thickness of material for strength
3) The cavosurface margin preparation for Class V composite restorations require a 45 degree
bevel to provide additional surface for adhesion as well as to create an esthetically blended
junction between the tooth and the composite material.
What design features of a DO alloy preparation would proven the restoration from falling out
into an edentulous space? Select all that apply.
1) Concept: Placing occlusal dovetails provide resistance to dislodging forces for the restoration
2) Convergent axial walls keep the restoration in placed by providing retention and resistance to
dislodgment to perpendicular and shear stress
3) An amalgapin in the proximal box provides added resistance and prevents displacement into
adjacent edentulous space.
How do preparations for proximal amalgam and cast gold inlay differ?
1) Concept: Cast gold inlay preparations require a bevel to remove unsupported enamel rods and
render a smooth flowing form of cavity preparation
2) The bevel on the margin allows for better marginal adaptation through burnishing.
3) Amalgam has a weak edge strength, requires a 90o cavosurface margin and an adequate
thickness for strength and durability.
Class II amalgam cavity preparations in primary molars DO NOT require a gingival bevel
because the enamel rods in that area are tilted which direction?
A. Gingivally
B. Horizontally
C. Lingualy
D. Occlusally
E. Facially D. Occlusally
1) Concept: The enamel rods of primary teeth are occlusally directed which makes the gingival
bevel unnecessary.
3) The enamel rods of permanent molars become apically directed as they approach the cervical
aspect of tooth.
Tooth #19 is being prepared for an occlusal amalgam restoration. Caries remains in the facial,
pulpal, and lingual walls after the ideal outline form and depth were established. Which of the
following is the next step in the treatment of this tooth?
1) Concept: The outline form should be extended to completely remove all the infected dentin
and enamel.
2) Amalgam restorations require solid parallel walls with no unsupported enamel to avoid failure
of the restoration or tooth fracture under function.
3) Proper extension of the outline form when removing carious tooth structure should be done to
prevent leakage and recurrence of caries.
Each of the following is a rationale for placing a bevel on preparations for composite resin
restorations EXCEPT one. Which of the following is the EXCEPTION?
1) Concept: Exposing organic layers of enamel is insignificant for bonding composite and tooth
structure and is NOT a reason to place a bevel into the cavosurface margin.
2) Beveling is performed to
a. Expose ends of the enamel rods
b. Improve the marginal seal of composite restoration with tooth structure
c. Increase the surface area of enamel for etching
d. Eliminate the ling between filling and tooth
Which of the following describes Low viscosity resins?
A. Condensable
B. Flowable
C. No answers apply
D. Packable B. Flowable
A. Acute angles
B. Obtuse angles
C. Rounded
D. Right angles D. Right angles
1) Concept: The angles in the preparation for an amalgam restoration should be right angles.
1) Concept: Burnishing of the side of the matrix band against the adjacent tooth during the
placement of Class II restorations helps to obtain an accurate inter proximal contact.
2) Establishment of proximal contact is very important for the longevity of the restoration and
gingival health around the tooth being restored.
3) Failing to achieve an optimum proximal contact can lead to pocket formation and overhanging
restorations which result in the failure of restorations.
2) An enamel bevel helps in diminishing the line of demarcation at the interface between the
restorative material and tooth surface.
3) Bevels increase the resin bond strength and decreases the chance of fracture and dislodgment
of the restoration.
Retention grooves MUST be deep enough to resist explorer tip displacement an thus should be
how many mm deep?
A. 0.5mm
B. 1.5mm
C. 1mm
D. 2mm
D. 3mm A. 0.5mm
1) Concept: Retention grooves are the secondary retention features of a preparation and must be
deep enough to resist explorer tip displacement. Ideally grooves are 0.5mm deep.
2) The use of retention grooves is recommended in tooth preparations with extensive proximal
boxes in order to enhance retention form and counter proximal displacement.
4) Depth refers to the extent of translation i.e. direction of the movement of axis of the bur. It is
about 0.5mm at the gingival floor level.
5) The retention grooves are positioned 0.2mm inside the DEJ maintaining the enamel support.
Radiographs reveal that a 16 year old patient with excellent oral hygiene and no missing teeth
presents with distal decay on #12. A distal slot preparation can be performed if...
1) Concept: Cavosurface margins should be free of unsupported enamel rods because they
normally fracture under occlusal stress
2) A 45o cavo-surface bevel exposes more surface area of enamel rods that can be etched and
bonded to retain and seal composite restorations,
a. NO bevels should be placed on occlusal surfaces
The most retentive pin design is...?
A. Friction-lock system
B. No answers are correct
C. Threaded
D. Cemented C. Threaded
2) Friction locked pins and threaded pins are both retained by the elasticity of the dentin walls
3) Cemented pins
a. least retentive among pin designs used in restorative dentistry but also creates the least stress
on dentin
Retention features for Class V restorations are typically placed on...
1) Concept: Retentive undercuts are prepared within the Incisal/Occlusal and Gingival walls of
cervical cavities (Class V preparations).
2) Placement of undercuts should be confined within the dentin layer to prevent the undermining
of enamel.
3) Added restorative features like points and grooves within the dentin walls allow more
retention for the restoration.
4) Retention for Class V restorations can be improved by lengthening the walls and making
parallel opposing walls
According to Black's steps in cavity preparation, which step occurs first?
A. Clean preparation area in attempts to remove any superficial debris and to ensure a clear
working field
B. Establish outline form based on location and extent of carious lesion
C. Establish outline form by removing deepest portion of carious lesions first
D. Obtain convenience form by removing carious lesion and tooth structure adjacent to it to
allow adequate observation, accessibility and ease of operation B. Establish outline form
based on location and extent of carious lesion
1) Concept: The outline for an amalgam preparation for a primary mandibular 2nd molar will be
almost identical to the permanent mandibular 1st molar tooth except slightly smaller.
2) The primary 2nd molar and permanent 1st molar are nearly identical in tooth morphology.
3) The primary 2nd molar typically demonstrates 5 cusps like the permanent 1st molar.
2) Mandibular Molars:
Primary 2nd = Permanent 1st
Design principles for Class II amalgams include which of the following? Select all that apply.
A. Extension of the prep to line facial and lingual line angles for better cleansibility
B. Facial/Lingual extension of the gingival box to the point where contact is totally removed
C. Removal of unsupported enamel and loose enamel rods
D. A rounded pulpo-axial line angle B. Facial/Lingual extension of the gingival box to the point
where contact is totally removed
C. Removal of unsupported enamel and loose enamel rods
D. A rounded pulpo-axial line angle
1) Concept: Rounded pulpo-axial line angle provides resistance to fracture for the amalgam
restoration by lessening the occlusal stress concentration.
2) Loose enamel rods and unsupported enamel has to be removed because they are weak areas of
tooth that may fracture against occlusal load.
3) The extension of the facial and lingual preparation within the gingival box should be out of
contact to its adjacent tooth to provide room for access, instrumentation and proper restoration of
contacts.
According to G.V. Black, the outline form of cavity preparation is the shape of the cavity
preparation...
A. Cavosurface angle
B. Line angle
C. Point angle
D. Wall junction B. Line angle
2) Point angle
a. junction formed between 3 walls or 2 walls and 1 floor or 2 floors and 1 wall of a cavity
preparation is known as a point angle.
3) Wall Junction
a. point where 2 walls or the floor and walls meet.
DO amalgam restorations are less likely to fracture between the occlusal and distal portion if...
1) Concept: The smear layer is the layer of debris produced from grinding on the surface of a
cavity preparation.
2) When the tooth surface is altered by rotary and manual instrumentation during cavity
preparation, the cutting debris is smeared over the enamel and dentin surfaces, forming the smear
layer.
A. A conventional bevel
B. A retentive bevel
C. An esthetic bevel
D. No answers apply C. An esthetic bevel
2) Retentive Bevel
a. typically found around the margins of a Class V restoration
When prepping a tooth for a cast gold restoration, the tooth structure that is weakened by the
preparation and subjected to masticatory forces must be
A. Etched
B. Reduced and protected by the restoration
C. Reinforced by a core buildup and cement
D Safeguarded by a full coverage restorationB. Reduced and protected by the restoration
1) Concept: Weak tooth structure must be removed or reduced to provide a strong foundation for
the restoration
2) Undermined cusps and unsupported tooth structure are prone to fracture, so capping of cusps
may be necessary to protect the tooth and provide strength.
3) The tooth preparation must conserve sound tooth structure and have adequate retention and
resistance form.
Which of the following is the reason why satisfactory gingival seats are NOT POSSIBLE for the
proximal box of a deep Class II cavity preparation in PRIMARY teeth?
A. The buccal and lingual surfaces converge occlusally for primary molars
B. The enamel rods of the gingival 1/3 of primary molars extend occlusally
C. The proximal contact of primary molars is flat and broad
D. Primary teeth possess a marked cervical constriction D. Primary teeth possess a marked
cervical constriction
1) Concept: Primary teeth possess prominent cervical ridges and are more slender mesiodistally
at their cervical portions and narrower at their necks.
2) These features make it extremely difficult to achieve satisfactory gingival seats for proximal
boxes of deep class II cavity preparations
3) The enamel rods in the gingival 1/3 of the crown also extend in an occlusal direction
compared to permanent dentition that run cervically.
Restoration of Prepared Cavities Restoration of Prepared Cavities Answers
Over-mixing an admix (dispersalloy) amalgam capsule can result in each of the following
outcomes EXCEPT one. Which is the EXCEPTION?
1) Concept: Over mixing admix amalgam alloy capsule does NOT result in a decrease in overall
strength
4) Dispersalloy is designed for use in stress bearing restorations e.g. Class 1 and 2 preparations,
when other restorative materials or restoration techniques are NOT indicated.
Which of the following phases of amalgam is considered the weakest?
A. Beta
B. Gamma
C. Gamma-1
D. Gamma-2
E. Alpha D. Gamma-2
1) Concept: Gamma-2 phase is the weakest and has the least resistance to corrosion
A. Non-working
B. Protrusive
C. Retrusive
D. Working B. Protrusive
1) Concept: An overbuilt mesial marginal ridge of a maxillary 2nd molar tooth will interfere with
protrusive movement.
2) High spot will hinder the forward movement as it will come in contact with the opposing tooth
earlier.
3) It is ESSENTIAL to remove all the high spots after restoring the tooth so that occlusal trauma
is not incurred by the tooth and its antagonist.
4) Articulating paper can be used to identify the high spots in order to carry out their removal.
5) High spots in a restoration will affect the normal functioning as well as cause pain in the long
run.
Which of the following should be performed in regards to calcium hydroxide (Ca(OH)2)
placement during indirect or direct pulp capping procedures to ensure optimal thermal and
protective insulation of the pulp?
1) Concept: A stronger base will ensure that the calcium hydroxide and pulp are well protected
and sealed against irritants that may cause further harm to the pulp.
2) Calcium hydroxide dissolves easily and exhibits weak mechanical properties as a base.
3) Calcium hydroxide bases should stay undisturbed when approximating the pulp in order to
induce dentin bridge formation within the dentin pulp complex.
Which of the following is the primary photo initiator used to initiate curing in resin composites?
A. Benzoyl Peroxide
B. Bezoyl methyl ether
C. Bis-phenol A
D. Camphoroquinone D. Camphoroquinone
1) Most composite resins currently used employ camphoroquinone as the primary photo initiator.
2) Camphoroquinone
a. absorbs photons of light energy (predominantly at about 470 nm).
3) Curing lights
a. The manufacturer of light curing lights attempt to maximize the light in the absorption range
of the photo initiator within the composite being cured.
4) Benzoyl peroxide
a. is used as an initiator along with tertiary amine activator in chemical or self cure composites
Cast gold restorations are indicated to replacing aging amalgams to...
1) Concept: Cast gold restorations can achieve more ideal anatomic contours because they are
made outside the mouth and under controlled conditions.
2) During the process of carving cast gold restorations, the master cast can be articulated
properly and the contours can be corrected immediately prior to its placement in the mouth.
3) Carving and shaping of anatomical contours is done more accurately and efficiently outside
the mouth.
4) Since cast restoration are fabricated on the master cast, the margins and the cavity prep will be
clearly seen and proper extension of the restoration to the finish lines can be achieved.
Which of the following is the most probable explanation for a freshly condensed amalgam
restoration that begins to chip away when it is carved?
A. The alloy was improperly mixed and was not fully wetted with mercury
B. The amalgam was condensed after its working time had elapsed
C. The amalgam was contaminated by moisture
D. A low-copper alloy was used B. The amalgam was condensed after its working time had
elapsed
1) Concept: Over condensation of amalgam alloy will result in chipping away of the filling
material during carving.
1) Concept: Superseal and dentinal sealers are typically used in amalgam preps only.
2) The preparation should have rounded line angles to conserve tooth structure in posterior Class
II resin composite restorations. Sharp angles will eventually lead to breakage or fracture of
restoration in these areas.
4) The preparation tends to have a narrower outline form than for an amalgam restoration.
5) Preparation outline should follow the extent of carious lesion only. There is no extension for
prevention.
Which of the following describes why it is recommended that a matrix for a proximal restoration
(Class II or III) be taller than the adjacent marginal ridge being restored?
1) Concept: The matrix band should be placed slightly higher than the adjacent marginal ridge
during the placement of proximal restorations which allows the clinician to achieve overfilling of
the cavity preparation.
2) Overfilling the amalgam in proximal restoration is necessary because it allows for the:
a. proper carving of the amalgam restoration
b. burnishing and achieving the contact point
c. ease in the restoration of tooth morphology
Which of the following describes the function of silanes in resin composites?
1) Concept: The function of silanes from resin composites is to bind the inorganic and organic
materials with hydrogen and covalent bonds.
2) The bi-functional silane coupling agents are incorporated in composites resins to make a
strong bond between the resin composite material and the tooth surface.
3) These attach to the dentinal substrate on one side and the composite resins on the other side
forming a hybrid layer.
Which of the following properties are improved by adding filler particles added to the matrix of
resin composites?
1) Concept: Filler particles provide strength to the composite resins and help to improve the
following physical properties:
a. Reduces the coefficient of thermal expansion
b. Reduces polymerization shrinkage of the composite
c. Make the material harder, denser, and more resistant to wear
d. Cause reinforcement of the resin matrix
e. Decrease polymerization shrinkage
f. Improves workability
g. Decrease water sorption
h. Increases radiopacity
Admixed amalgam alloy consists of which of the following?
1) Concept: Admixed amalgam alloy consists of a mixture of lathe-cut particles and spherical
particles
2) Admixed alloys
a. have the "body" of lathe-cut alloys when condensing; are easily condensed with goo
adaptation but are more easily worked with like the spherical alloys
b. can withstand forces of condensation better than the spherical alloys which is why these alloys
are preferred for proximal amalgam restorations.
c. demonstrate higher levels of creep and corrosion compared to spherical alloys.
Which of the following methods should be employed if the tip of the curing light is narrower
than the composite restoration being cured?
A. Move the curing tip over the surface for the recommended time
B. Place the tip stepwise over each area and expose each area for the recommended time
C. Position the tip far away enough from the tooth to illuminate the entire restoration
D. Center the tip on the surface and cure the entire composite from that spot. B. Place the
tip stepwise over each area and expose each area for the recommended time
1) Concept: Proper exposure time for every portion of a composite resin will ensure that the
entire restoration is completely polymerized.
2) Placing the small tip from one area to another while following the recommended curing time
will ensure that no unpolymerized composite will be left behind.
3) Adequate curing of composite restoration is important to ensure the restoration has no weak
areas, is properly sealed and can perform at its best during mastication.
Each of the following is a component of the chemical reaction for light initiated composite resin
polymerization EXCEPT one. Which is the EXCEPTION?
A. Benzoyl peroxide
B. Camphoroquinone
C. Tertiary amine
D. ~468 nm blue light A. Benzoyl peroxide
1) Concept: Benzoyl peroxide is used as an initiator in self cure or auto-curing composite resins
2) Camphorquinone is an initiator and tertiary amines are activators for light activated composite
resins.
3) VLC composites need a light of wavelength approximately 468 nm to initiate (start) the
polymerization reaction.
Which of the following describes the primary method for retention to enamel by adhesives?
A. Dentin tubules
B. Macrotags
C. Microtags
D. Primer application
E. Smear layerC. Microtags
1) Concept: Microtags are believed to be the major contributors to retention to enamel with
regards to adhesives.
2) The acid treated enamel surface has a high surface energy allowing the flow, intimate
adherence and polymerization of the resin monomer within the pores, creating retentive resin
micro tags up to 20 micrometers deep.
3) At the same time, the individual cores of all the exposed individual crystals are solubilized to
form a multitude of micro porosities.
4) These countless numbers of mini tags or micro tags formed within the individual crystal cores
are major contributors to enamel bond strength.
After etching a Class III preparation for a composite restoration, the preparation is contaminated
with saliva. Which of the following actions are indicated are indicated next?
A. Rinse away the saliva with water, dry the preparation, then repeat the etching procedure and
restore
B. Rinse away the saliva with water, then dry the preparation, then proceed
C. Wipe away all saliva with cotton pellet, rinse away the saliva with water, dry, and proceed
D. Blow dry the saliva with the air/water syringe then proceed A. Rinse away the saliva with
water, dry the preparation, then repeat the etching procedure and restore
1) Concept: Saliva contains minerals that can immediately remineralize the etched tooth and
weaken the bonding of the composite to tooth surface.
2) By drying and re-etching the surface to be restored, the primer and bonding agent can
establish better adhesive interface between composite and the tooth structure.
3) Re-etching the tooth will ensure roughening of the tooth surface is achieved and will ensure
better adhesion of the bonding agent to the etched tooth structure through increased mechanical
retention through increased microtention.
A. Bis-GMA
B. Camphorquinone
C. Filler particles
D. Free radicals
E. Polymethymethacrylate D. Free radicals
1) Concept: The formation of free radicals induces the polymerization of pits and fissure
sealants.
2) Sealants
a. are the most effective clinical technique to proven tpit and fissure caries
b. the cost effectiveness of sealants is based upon sealant retention
c. classified as self-cure or auto-cure sealants and visible light cure sealants
d. Camphorquinone is the most common photo initiator found in resins and is used because its
decomposition creates free radicals
Which of the following factors demonstrate an effect on photo polymerization?
1) Concepts: Photo-polymerization in visible light cure composite resins can be affected by the
following factors:
a. Time of application of curing light is an important factor. It depends upon the type of resin
used, amount of tints or opacifiers incorporated, wavelength of light and its intensity
b. Distance of light curing tip from the surface of restorative resin can affect the amount of
polymerization
c. Irradiance and wavelength of the photo-polmerizing sources should be considered
Which of the following describes the maximum amount of resin composite that can be properly
cured per layer of restoration?
A. 0.5mm
B. 1mm
C. 2mm
D. 4mm
E. Depth does not matter C. 2mm
1) Concept: The maximum depth of resin that can be properly cured per layer is approximately
2mm.
2) Light cured composites are currently among the most popular restorative materials due to their
ease of handling.
3) The success of composite resin restorations depends upon the access of high intensity curing
light to the material.
4) If the composite thickness exceeds 2mm, inadequate curing occurs. This phenomenon is
specially seen with darker shade composites. Filler particles and coloring agents tend to scatter
or absorb the curing light within 1-2mm of the material.
How does etching tooth structure with acid improve retention of composite restorations? Select
all that apply.
A. It displaces the water in dentinal tubules and allows composite to flow deeper into dentin
B. It increases the chemical bonding strength
C. It increases the mechanic retention
D. It removes the surface debris from the cavity preparation. C. It increases the mechanic
retention
D. It removes the surface debris from the cavity preparation.
1) Concept: Acid etching removes debris and other impurities from the cavity that may affect the
overall result of the restorative procedure.
2) Acid etching
a. provides surface roughness to provide mechanical retention without too much loss of healthy
tooth structure during cavity preparation
b. microporosities created by acid etching allows even small cavity preparations to have
rendition despite insufficient retention form
c. Acid etching improves MECHANICAL retention NOT CHEMICAL bonding.
Which of the following statements regarding the creep of amalgam is CORRECT?
1) Concept: Alloys with higher copper content demonstrate lower creep values because they
exhibit little of no gamma 2 phase.
2) Creep
a. defined as the time dependent plastic permanent deformation of amalgam under static or
dynamic loading.
b. causes protrusion of amalgam out of the cavity. The protruded edges are unsupported and
weak and are further weakened by corrosion leading to fracture, ditching, and micro leakage of
the restoration.
c. the gamma 2 phase is primarily responsible of higher creep values
True/False:
Spherical alloys contain more mercury than admixed alloys. The higher mercury content is why
it is easier to achieve a contact with spherical alloy. Both statements are false
1) Concept: Spherical amalgam alloys do NOT contain more mercury than the admixed alloys.
2) Spherical alloys
a. are easier to condense into areas of difficult access such as around pins because they provide
less resistance to condensation pressures. They harden rapidly, are smoother for carving,
burnishing and polishing.
b. are difficult to achieve tight interproximal contacts with because of their pliable nature and
admixed alloys are recommended for areas requiring development of proximal contacts.
Each of the following is an indication for using resin composite materials EXCEPT one. Which
is the EXCEPTION?
1) Concept: Composite resin restorations are contraindicated when gingival margins are NOT
intact typically due to concerns regarding fluid contamination
2) It is very difficult to maintain isolation and make a satisfactory bond with etched dentin.
3) It is advised to placed an (Resin Modified Glass Ionomer Cement) RMGIC liner before
placement of resin material if it necessary to fill it with composite (like in anterior esthetic
cases).
A. 0.5mm
B. 1.0mm
C. 2.0mm
D. 2.5mm
E. <0.5mm B. 1.0mm
1) The first increment in a Class II restoration must be 1mm thick if snowplow technique is not
used. The first increment is placed on the gingival floor of the restoration.
A. Clinician forgot to burnish the matrix band against the adjacent tooth
B. Loading too much amalgam into the prep before properly condensing it into the proximal box
C. Over-tightening of the matrix band
D. Clinician forgot to place a wedge B. Loading too much amalgam into the prep before
properly condensing it into the proximal box
1) Concept: Inadequate condensation of amalgam into a proximal box before it sets will result in
an open gingival margin.
2) Placement of excessive amalgam into the cavity prep often allows the amalgam to set before it
is adapted and properly condensed into the floor and walls of the cavity resulting in voids in the
restoration and an open gingival margin
a. Small condensers should be used initially for proximal boxes
b. Larger condensers should be used after the adaptation to the margins and cavity floor are
deemed adequate.
3) Incremental filling ensures that amalgam is condensed and adapted to the cavity completely
and also reduces incidence of voids and open margins in the restoration
1) Concept: Precarve burnishing should take place soon after condensation of the amalgam is
completed in order to produce denser amalgam at the margin of restorations.
2) When the amalgam is placed or inserted to slight excess with condensers, it should be pre
carved burnished with a burnisher.
3) It is done to achieve:
a. Finalization of condensation
b. Removal of excess mercury rich amalgam
c. Initiation of carving process
Which of the following are recognized methods to cure resin sealants? Select all that apply.
A. Autocuring
B. Chemical polymerization
C. Photopolymerization A. Autocuring
B. Chemical polymerization
C. Photopolymerization
1) Concept: Pits and sealants are most efficient in sealing the caries susceptible in a tooth
2) Pits and fissure sealants are placed after minimal and no preparation of the tooth surfaces and
then cure to make a hermetic seal.
3) The curing of sealants can occur through chemical or auto-curing as is the case in self cure
pits and fissure sealants.
4) VLC sealants are cured through the mechanism of photo-polymerization with the help of
visible light curing units.
Each of the following is an advantage indirect composite restorations over direct placement
composite restorations EXCEPT one. Which is the EXCEPTION?
1) Concept: The primary advantage of indirect resin restorations over direct resin restorations
are:
a. Improved proximal contacts
b. Decreased marginal leakage
c. Increased strength
d. Decreased postoperative sensitivity
A. Curing shrinkage
B. Microleakage
C. Pulpal irritation
D. Coefficient of thermal expansion B. Microleakage
1) Concept: Microleakage can be reduced by acid etching the tooth when placing composite
restorations.
2) Conventional acid etching techniques demonstrate less micro leakage than the newer self-
etched primers.
4) Acid etching results in the formation of microscopic retentive areas about 25 microns in depth.
Which of the following instruments is MOST useful when polishing an amalgam restoration?
2) it is advised to carry out finishing and polishing of am algae restorations at least 24 hours
AFTER the placement of the amalgam so that complete setting of the amalgam can occur.
Which of the following acts as the BEST conditioner to clean the tooth's surface when applying
glass ionomer adhesives?
A. Acetone
B. Ethanol
C. Isopropyl alcohol
D. No answers apply
E. Phosphoric Acid
F. Polyalkenoic Acid F. Polyalkenoic Acid
1) Concept: Polyalkenoic Acid is used for glass ionomers because it is a weaker acid that does
NOT penetrate into the dentin as much as phosphoric acid.
2) This is because the glass ionomers have a much higher molecular weight polymer that cannot
penetrate into the smaller tubules created further gingival by the phosphoric acid.
3) Ethanol is a solvent primer used to remove excess water after rinsing acid.
Each of the following statements about resin based composites (RBCs) as a posterior restorative
material are correct EXCEPT one. Which is the EXCEPTION?
1) Concept: Amalgam has been demonstrated to be a better restoration for rests of removable
partial dentures than that of resin based composites.
2) Amalgam core buildups have also demonstrates better longevity than that of composites.
3) It is preferable to use amalgam in areas experiencing high masticatory and functional loads,
areas where isolation cannot be maintained and patients with parafunctional habits like bruxism
and clenching.
A. Bonding adhesive
B. Glass Ionomer
C. Hybrid fill
D. Micro fill
E. Nanofill B. Glass Ionomer
1) Concept: The bonded base or open sandwich technique liner is made up of glass ionomer
cement or resin modified glass ionomer cement.
2) In an open sandwich technique, a restorative glass ionomer cement or resin modified glass
ionomer cement is used in the portion of the restoration near the gingival margin.
4) Composite resins are placed over the glass ionomer cement without impending the contact of
glass ionomer cement with oral cavity.
Which of the following is the MOST important variable for the clinical success of posterior resin
based composite (RBC)?
1) Concept: The most important variable in clinical success of posterior RBC is the placement
technique used to carry out restoration.
3) An important step to restore Class II preparations with direct composite restorations is the
selection and proper placement of matrix band.
4) Class II composites are totally dependent upon the contour and position of matrix and wedge
for establishing appropriate proximal contacts.
Each of the following statements about polishing amalgam are all correct EXCEPT one. Which
is the EXCEPTION?
1) Concept: Polishing amalgam restorations has NOT shown any significant increase in the life
of restorations.
3) Finishing can create a more comfortable surface for patient's tongue, however, it can produce
an unaesthetic and shiny surface in some cases.
Which of the following materials will provide the MOST ESTHETIC restoration for a Class V
preparation on an anterior tooth?
A. Glass ionomer
B. Hybrid resin composite
C. Microfilled resin composite
D. Resin based glass ionomer C. Microfilled resin composite
1) A Class V preparation should be restored with micro filled resin composite material whenever
esthetics is the main concern.
2) Due to their small particle size, microfilmed resin composites have a smooth, highly
polishable surface which requires minimal finishing.
3) The low elastic modulus of these materials allows them to flex during tooth flexure, better
protecting the bonding interface in Class V restorations.
4) Microfilled resins are NOT typically used for restorations that are going to be in contact with
other teeth because they have a low resistance to wear.
Which of the following statements is TRUE concerning the carving of amalgam?
1) Concept: While the matrix is in place, the marginal ridge should be carved very nearly to the
height of the adjacent marginal ridge.
2) Initial carving of the occlusal surface should be rapid, concentrating primarily on the marginal
ridge height and occlusal embrasure areas.
3) The explorer tip is pulled along the inside of the matrix band mimicking the adjacent tooth,
creating the occlusal embrasure form.
The indicated method for trimming the margins of an amalgam restoration is by...
A. Carving a circumferential trough around the margins of the restoration so that amalgam can
be burnished into it for a tight seal
B. Carving circumferentially with a sharp instrument resting mostly on the restoration
C. Carving circumferentially with a sharp instrument that rests mostly on the tooth surface
D. Burnishing from the tooth to the restoration C. Carving circumferentially with a sharp
instrument that rests mostly on the tooth surface
1) Concept: A sharp carver should be placed on the tooth surface at the tooth and restoration
surface.
2) Carver instrument is moved circumferentially for trimming the margins of the restoration
3) Instrument should be moved in order to restore the normal morphology of the tooth.
Glass ionomers use an acid/base reaction to chemically bond to the tooth surface. What are the
acid and bases used to create this reaction?
1) Concept: The setting reaction of glass ionomer cement is an acid-based reaction between the
polyalkenoic acid and fluoroaluminosilicate glass powder resulting in a chemical bonding to the
tooth surface.
2) When the powder and liquid are mixed, the fluoroaluminosilicate glass powder is attacked by
hydrogen ions from the polyalkenoic acid liberating Al+3, Ca+2, Na+1, and Fl-1 ions.
3) After saturation the free calcium and aluminum ions diffuse into the liquid and cross link with
2 or 3 ionized carboxyl groups of the polyacid to form a gel.
Zinc is added to lower-copper amalgam for each of the following reasons EXCEPT one. Which
is the EXCEPTION?
3) Delayed expansion and corrosion products result in sealing the restoration which reduces
marginal voids and chances of fractures.
Each of the following statements regarding flowable resin composite as the first increment in a
Class II prep are true EXCEPT one. Which statement is the EXCEPTION?
2) Lower viscosity composite resins exhibit high flow rates and penetrate deeper portions of the
preparation to fill the voids and irregularities.
4) The flowable composites are commonly used as the first small increment in snowplow
technique in proximal preparations.
5) A small uncured increment of flowable composite is placed on the gingival portion, and then a
conventional composite is placed over it. The conventional composite is condensed ti displace
most of the flowable composite out of the cavity preparation and rest of it flows into deeper
portions where conventional composite cannot reach.
Why is calcium hydroxide the suggested material for vital pulp capping procedures?
1) Concept: Calcium hydroxide is the most biocompatible material that has been proved to help
induce dentin bridge formation.
2) Calcium hydroxide has been used for a long time and is the gold standard for direct and
indirect pulp capping.
3) Calcium hydroxide induces the formation of reparative dentin to wall off and protect the pulp
against bacterial attacks.
Larger sized condensers and lateral force application are techniques used to properly condense
which type of amalgam?
A. Admix
B. Low copper
C. Spherical
D. Lathe-cut C. Spherical
1) Concept: Spherical amalgam alloy has high compressive strength requiring strong
condensation forces to ensure proper adaptation to the cavity preparation.
2) Use of strong lateral forces and large condensers should deb used to properly condense
spherical amalgam alloy.
3) Spherical alloys have large particle composition necessitating good condensation to minimize
the gap between the cavity prep and the amalgam.
Which of the following is/are true of convention Glass Ionomers? Select all that apply.
1) Concept: Conventional glass ionomer contain water soluble polyacids and basic ion leachable
glass in their composition.
1) Concept: The shiny and coherent mass of amalgam produced after the process of trituration
(mixing) indicates that the material is mixed homogeneously.
2) The purpose of trituration is to remove oxide layers from the alloy particles, to coat each alloy
particle with mercury, and to provide a homogenous mass for condensation.
1) Concept: Organic mercury is considered to be the most toxic form of mercury. Mercury can
form organic compounds such as methyl mercury.
2) Organic mercury compounds can be readily absorbed by many organisms and concentrated as
they pass up the food chain. Organically bound mercury in food is the primary source of mercury
exposure in most people.
3) Excretion of mercury is less effective from the human body compared to its absorption.
Organic mercury has a tendency to concentrate in liver, kidney, and brain after being absorbed.
4) Higher concentration of mercury in the human body is harmful. Mercury toxicity can result in
bronchitis, pneumonia, kidney disease, allergic reactions. When inhaled in toxic quantities, it can
cause damaged to the central nervous system.
5) Dentists are at an increased risk of mercury toxicity due to the excessive use of amalgam
fillings in the operator. The maximum safe dose ingested in a 40 hour work week is 50
microgram per cubic meter.
6) The dental operator should be well-ventilated with seamless floor tiles in order to prevent
mercury retention in higher concentrations and decreased mercury inhalation. Use of personal
protective equipment is mandatory.
Which of the following should be performed to test the occlusion of an amalgam restoration?
A. Instruct the patient to bite down and report how it feels
B. Instruct the patient to bite on articulating paper
C. Perform the tap test with articulating paper by manually moving the patient's jaw
D. The restoration will be correct if it was carved to typical occlusal anatomy C. Perform the
tap test with articulating paper by manually moving the patient's jaw
1) Concept: The tap test is usually performed to test the occlusion of an amalgam restoration. It
is performed with the articulating paper by moving the patient's jaw side to side and up and
down.
2) It is advised that the occlusion of the restoration should be evaluated. A piece of articulating
paper is placed over the restoration and the patient is instructed to close gently into occlusion and
manual movement of jaws is carried out.
3) Any high area of contact can be evaluated by the depth of color imparted by the pear and
especially if it has a silvery centre. These deep colored or shiny centered areas are reduced and
adjusted.
4) Instructing the patient to bite hard on the paper can cause fracture of the restoration.
Cavity liner placement should be limited to which of the following? Select all that apply.
1) Concept: The use of cavity liners should be limited to those areas of the preparation where
there is a possibility of a minute pulpal exposure.
2) The placement of cavity liners protects the endangered pulp from thermal, chemical,
electrical, and mechanical trauma.
3) The choice of cavity liner material depends upon the remaining dentin thickness. If the
remaining dentin thickness is greater than 1.5mm, glass ionomer cement can be used as cavity
liner but for a remaining thickness of 0.5mm or less, calcium hydroxide should be used, then
glass ionomer should be placed.
4) Application of cavity liners along the entire wall will reduce the retention or bonding of
restorative material.
The first step in the delivery of a cast gold inlay is...
A. Adjust contacts
B. Adjust occlusion
C. Burnish, adapt margins
D. Cement the restoration
E. Seat the restoration with a mallet A. Adjust contacts
1) Proximal contacts must first be assessed and adjusted to properly placed gold inlays.
2) Contacts if an inlay must always be checked because dimensional change might have occurred
during casting.
3) After evaluating the contacts, seat the restoration to check the marginal fit and its occlusal
relationship.
4) Gold can be burnished against the margins of the preparation to make it more adapted and
tightly fit for a good marginal seal.
Composite is bonded to adhesive by which of the following means.
1) Concept: Composite resin restorative materials is chemically bonded to adhesive resin through
polymerization through MMA bonds.
2) Mechanical bonding occurs between the adhesive and tooth substrate such as dentin/enamel.
3) The zone in which low viscosity resin of the bonding resin or adhesive system micro
mechanically interlocks with dentinal collagen is termed as hybrid layer or hybrid zone.
Composite resin restorations...
1) Concept: Composite restorations are restorative materials popularly used because of its:
a. High esthetic value
b. Ease of manipulation
c. Durability
2) Mechanical features like convergence of cavity walls, adequate preparation depth, grooves
and slots are incorporated in cavity preparations to retain amalgam fillings.
A. Decreased value
B. Increased translucency
C. Increased value
D. Decreased hue A. Decreased value
1) Concept: Decrease in value occurs when complimentary colors are used to adjust the shade of
a restoration.
2) This becomes a compromising situation when relative brightness is sacrificed for the sake of
shade matching.
4) Variations in value are used to create a focal point for the design of a restoration.
5) Gradations of value are also used to create the illusion of depth in a restoration.
1) Concept: Indirect pulp caps are indicated for teeth with deep caries with minimal pulpal
inflammation
3) Calcium hydroxide base is placed on the affected dentin to induce its remineralization and
promote the reparative dentin formation.
Which of the following techniques should be implemented for a patient presenting with rampant
caries in an area where esthetics are NOT considered important to the patient?
1) Concept: Glass ionomer without placement of a bevel should be used in a case of rampant
caries in an area where esthetics is NOT a concern.
3) Beveling of enamel margins is NOT beneficial in this case because there is no need to blend
the color of the restoration to the tooth and does not provide a better seal.
Acid etching teeth for resin composites will accomplish which of the following. Select all that
apply.
1) Concept: Acid etching teeth creates microporosities that adhesives can infiltrate to create
retention for composite resin bonding.
2) Acid etching roughens the exposed enamel rods and dentin, thus creating micro mechanical
abrasions that allows the bonding agent to flow and adhere to the tooth surface.
3) Etching also removes surface debris, allowing for a clean bonding site.
4) Acid etching creates higher bond strength between composite restoration and tooth structure
while also decreasing micro leakage.
In the bonding process, which of the following describes what primer BEST?
A. 1
B. 1 and 5
C. 2 and 4
D. 2 and 5
E. 3 and 4 D. 2 and 5
A. 400-499nm
B. 500-599nm
C. 600-699nm
D. 700-799nm
E. 300-399nm A. 400-499nm
4) LED curing lights have made composite curing easier and faster because they emit a beam of
light up to 1000mW/cm2.
Although the ADA standards for shrinkage is 20 microns/cm, NO detrimental effects are
associated with shrinkage less than which of the following amounts?
A. 20 microns/cm
B. 30 microns/cm
C. 40 microns/cm
D. 50 microns/cm D. 50 microns/cm
1) Concept: The ADA standard for the polymerization shrinkage of composite resins is 20
microns/cm. However, values of polymerization shrinkage less than 50 microns/cm are
acceptable haven NO detrimental effects.
2) The presence of inorganic filler particles throughout the composite structure reduces shrinkage
of the restorative. Higher the volume of the inorganic fillers, the lower the shrinkage of
composites.
1) Concept: Large cavity preparations are NOT an indication for composite in posterior teeth.
2) Small to moderate sized cavities in posterior teeth should be restored with RBC.
I. Compomer
II. Resin-Modified Glass-Ionomer
III. Glass-Ionomer
IV. Resin Composite
A. I, II, III, and IV
B. III, I, II, IV
C. III, II, IV, I
D. IV, III, II, I
E. No Answers apply E. No Answers apply
1) Concept: The fluoride releasing ability of various dental restorative material decreases in the
order of:
glass ionomer cements > resin modified glass ionomers > compomers > composites
2) This order is the same for fluoride recharging ability of materials from outside sources.
3) The greatest release occurs on the 1st day and subsequently decreases as the time passes.
4) Fluoride releasing materials can be recharged with external fluoride sources in order to
increase their fluoride release and re-mineralizing potential.
How is a cast gold onlay superior to a cuspal coverage amalgam? Select all that apply.
1) Concept: Cast gold inlays are fabricated more precisely because they are outside of the mouth
a. It is easier to manipulate material when there is better access.
b. There is no interaction with oral fluids to contaminate the materials.
2) Cast gold inlays have better compressive strength and are less likely to fracture.
Adjacent proximal cavities can be restored with composite resin at the same appointment
because...Select all that apply.
1) Concept: Adjacent proximal cavities are best restored in one appointment because
2) The cavity preparations can be made more conservatively, preserving more healthy tooth
structure.
3) There will be adequate access and visibility, enabling the dentist to work more efficiently and
effectively.
4) The restorations can be placed easier due to adequate space to finish the proximal margins of
the restorations properly.
5) Placing the restorations at the same time will decrease the wasted materials like adhesives etc.
that must be dispensed.
6) Placing the restorations at the same time DOES NOT increase the chance of having proximal
contacts.
When using matrix bands for posterior proximal amalgam restorations, the band should be
trimmed to which dimension?
1) Concept: The coronal portion of the matrix band should be located approximately 1mm higher
than the adjacent marginal ridge to facilitate proper contouring and adaptation of the restorative
material along the proximal wall and marginal ridge of the restoration.
3) Matrix bands should also be placed tightly hugging the tooth to ensure proper marginal
adaptation and anatomical form.
When finishing the occlusal surface on a posterior composite, the dentist should...
1) Concept: The centric contact in enamel should be preserved since it establishes the original
and proper occlusal contact between maxillary and mandibular teeth.
2) Increasing the intensity of centric contacts during restorative treatments may cause premature
contact, occlusal disharmony and eventually dental trauma.
3) Decreasing of removing the centric contact in enamel may cause occlusal disharmony and
unstable centric occlusion.
Incremental placement for a Class II prep leads to all of the following EXCEPT one. Which is
the EXCEPTION?
1) Concept: Increased post-operative sensitivity is NOT among the recognized effects following
incremental placement for a Class II preparation because incremental placement of composite
resins decrease the polymerization shrinkage of composites and increases the percentage of
curing resulting in decreased postoperative sensitivity.
1) Periapical radiolucencies can only be visualized after the cortical bone surrounding the root
apex is destroyed and the infection extends into the cancellous bone of periosteum.
2) Lamina dura is considered cortical bone, and as long as the cortical bone is intact, periodical
radiolucency will not be evident radiographically.
Odontoblasts vs. Odontoclasts Calcific metamorphosis is carried out by odontoBLASTS
not odontoCLASTS.
Calcific metamorphosis occurs when trauma induces odontoblasts to rapidly form extensive
amount of repartee dentin, causing the pulp to appear smaller and at some point obliterated
almost entirely.
Loss of the apical seat that is incurred through over-instrumentation is best clinically managed
by:
A. Filling with a gutta-percha cone that is larger than the apical perforation
B. Increasing the file size and decreasing the length of the file
C. Prescribing analgesics and antibiotics
D. Using a chelating agent and placing Ca(OH)2
E. Filling with a warm gutta percha technique B. Increasing the file size and decreasing the
length of the file
1) splinting should last for about 2 weeks. Freedom for slight movement lessens the pressure on
bone and allows better healing along the periodical aspect of bone.
Which of the following characteristics provide the least reliable finding from a clinical
examination of teeth subjected to traumatic injury?
1) Tooth that experienced trauma may or may not elicit a response to tooth vitality test, since the
nerves of the tooth could be damaged.
2) Traumatic tooth takes about 8 week minimum before it can display a normal pulp response.
Which of the following choices describes the access cavity preparation on a mandibular molar
with 3 canals best?
A. Pentagonal
B. Trapezoidal
C. Triangular
D. Oval B. Trapezoidal
1) Access preparation for the mandibular 1st molar is trapezoidal in shape since it follows the
position of the cusp tips.
Clinical Diagnosis, Case Selection, Treatment Planning, and Patient Management Clinical
Diagnosis, Case Selection, Treatment Planning, and Patient Management Answers
Which of the following treatment is indicated for a patient with irreversible pulpits on tooth #8
with an open apex?
1) Apexification
a. procedure where calcium hydroxide or MTA is placed in the apical end of a tooth to close the
apex of teeth with a necrotic pulp so that the tooth can be filled with a biocompatible material
such as gutta percha so the tooth will be restored permanently
4) Pulpotomy
a. procedure commonly performed on carious primary tooth where the pulpal inflammation
extends only in the crown
Referred periauricular pain is most common with...
A. Mandibular molars
B. Mandibular premolars
C. Maxillary premolars
D. Maxillary molars A. Mandibular molars
1) The pain that originates from mandibular molars is sometimes referred toward the ear because
both are innervated from one source - the mandibular nerve (V3).
2) The nerves from the mandibular molars transmit pain stimuli to the mandibular nerve which
also provide sensory innervation to some parts of the external ear.
3) The same origin of innervation and the proximity of the external ear to mandibular molars, the
pain perceived within the molar area easily travels and radiates into the external ear.
True/False:
The dental community believes that rubber dams must be used to complete all root canal
treatments.
In certain cases, a clinician can choose not to use a rubber dam with proper informed consent to
complete endodontic procedures. Statement I is true and Statement II is false.
1) Rubber Dams
a. using rubber dams during root canal procedures is a standard operating procedure and is
accepted and practiced worldwide
b. root canal treatment requires an operating field free of contamination to prevent saliva and
bacteria from entering the canal orifice
1) Periapical radiolucencies
a. can only be visualized after the cortical bone surrounding the root apex is destroyed ad the
infection extends into the cancellous bone of periosteum
b. lamina dura surrounding the periodical aspect of tooth is considered cortical bone, and as long
as the cortical bone is intact, periodical radiolucency will not be evident radiographically
c. evidence of bone destruction that extends into the cortical bone and cancellous bone
supporting the tooth.
Pulpotomy procedures on primary molars depend on primarily on which of the following factors
for success?
1) Pulpotomy
a. Success of a pulpotomy procedure lies on the ability of the remaining healthy pulp to remain
vital and not irreversibly inflamed after the procedure
b. procedure that removes only the portion of he coronal pulp that is infected and inflamed,
which keeps the radicular portion vital
c. cover the pulptomized tooth with an SSC crown may increase the chance for success of
treatment
Which of the following terms can be used to describe replacement resorption?
A. Ankylosis
B. Apical pathosis
C. Painful
D. Rapidly progressing
E. Acute apical abscesA. Ankylosis
1) Replacement Resorption
a. process wherein the tooth firmly attached to the bone, leading to ankylosis
b. possible outcome observed in a replanted avulsed tooth
c. inflammatory response initiated by the damaged PDL results in its replacement with alveolar
bone
2) Ankylosis
a. describes a tooth wherein an area of root is devoid of an attachment apparatus
Which of the following treatments is indicated for a patient with a 1mm pulp exposure created
when their cusp fracture off 30 minutes ago above the gumline?
A. Debride the canals and place calcium hydroxide in the canals and place a permanent
restoration.
B. Instrument and obturate the canals to mid root level in order to avoid vascular trauma
C. Perform a non-surgical root canal treatment
D. Perform a non-surgical root canal treatment with systemic vitamin K administration
E. Extract #14 C. Perform a non-surgical root canal treatment
A. Athletic
B. Lack fo supervision by parents
C. Physical abuse
D. Underdeveloped motor coordination skills
E. Alcohol related falls D. Underdeveloped motor coordination skills
Calcific metamorphosis occurs because trauma can induce odontoblasts to activate. Both
the statement and the reason are correct and related
1) Calcific Metamorphosis
a. common condition observed in teeth that have experienced trauma and is characterized by an
abnormal hard tissue formation and deposition in the pulp space that either partially or
completely fills it
b. trauma induces odontoblasts to rapidly form extensive amount of reparative dentin, causing
the pulp to appear smaller and at some point obliterated entirely
c. may occur when the fragments of fracture roots are in tight contact with one another if the
apical portion of the tooth is still vital. The calcification will close the fracture line and stabilize
the connection of the two fragments of the root.
Which of the following is the most likely complication of bleaching a tooth that was not
adequately obturated?
C. Maxillary canines
E. Maxillary incisors C. Maxillary canines
1) Maxillary canine
a. longest root in the oral cavity
b. root is relatively straight with only some slight palatal or labial tipping along its apex.
c. presents with only one root canal most of the time
d. diameter is relatively large and oval in shape when viewed in cross-section
An increase in which of the following is evidence of an aging pulp?
A. fibrous elements
B. number of odontoblasts
C. pulp stones
D. size of the pulp chamber
E. vascularity
F. cellular elements A. fibrous elements
1) Pulp Chamber
a. fibroblasts in the pulp chamber continue to produce fibrous connective tissue and ground
substance, increase its amount compared to the other substances within the pulp
b. size of the pulp decreases as we age due to the continuous formation of secondary dentin and
the formation of reactionary dentin related to cares and other dental trauma
c. decrease in pulp size also decreases the vascular supply, nerve fibers and the overall cellularity
of the pulp.
Which of the following best describe replacement root resorption?
A. Ankylosis
B. Apical pathosis
C. Chronic pain
D. Rapid progression
E. Acute inflammation A. Ankylosis
1) Root Replacement
a. occurs in response to dental trauma or severe damage to the periodontium
b. bone grows and attaches to the root causing ankylosis
c. happens more commonly among patients who suffered severe cases of avulsion and luxation
A 6 year-old boy presents with a carious lesion on tooth T and no mobility, a small draining
sinus tract is found adjacent to tooth T. Radiographs indicate no furcal bone loss. Which of the
following is the suggested treatment?
A. Extraction
C. PulpectomyC. Pulpectomy
1) Pulpectomy
a. indicated for cases where there is no tooth mobility but the infection might already have
reached the pulp
2) Pulpotomy
a. indicated for primary teeth having accidental pulp exposure or a bacterial attack that only
affects the coronal portion of the pulp
The apical foramen is most commonly...
1) The apical foramen is usually situated approximately 0.5-1.0mm short of the root apex.
2) Apical constrition
a. narrowest portion of the canal located a few mm from the anatomical apex.
b. junction between the first layer of dentin and the first cementum layer that covers the exiting
portion of the tooth apex.
A 22-year old patient presents your office complaining of mild-to-moderate pain associated with
tooth #30 that had an amalgam restoration recently placed. The pain occurs for roughly 2
seconds and is provoked by cold, heat, and sweet foods. Which of the following is the most
probable diagnosis?
A. Internal resorption
B. Irreversible pulpitis
C. Pulp necrosis
D. Reversible pulpitis
E. Externa resorption D. Reversible pulpitis
1) Reversible Pulpitis
a. pain that is provoked by various stimuli including cold, heat, sweet foods, touch, and etc.
b. pain that only lasts for just a few seconds after the stimulus is removed
2) Irreversible Pulpitis
a. condition of the pulp where it cannot return to a healthy state
4) Necrotic Pulp
a. usually asymptomatic
b. characterized by non-vital pulp
c. pain associated with a necrotic pulp can be attributed to a periodical infection associated with
the necrotic pulp
Following trauma to primary maxillary incisors, which of the following would MOST LIKELY
cause yellowish discoloration>
A. Calcific metamorphosis
B. Internal resorption
C. Pulp hyperemia
D. Pulp necrosis
E. Blood pigments A. Calcific metamorphosis
1) Calcific metamorphosis
a. is a common reason that teeth appear yellow after trauma occurs and is recognized clinically
as early as 3 months following injury.
b. characterized by hard tissue within the root canal space of a tooth causing yellow discoloration
of the clinical crown
Internal resorption that has not totally perforated the root surface is BEST managed by which of
the following?
A. Necrosis
B. No specific condition
C. Normal pulp
D. Reversible pulpitis
E. Mild irritation A. Necrosis
1) Necrosis
a. prolonged unstimulated pain is associated with cases involving pulpal necrosis or irreversible
pulpits
b. describes the death of pulpal cells
c. pain associated with pulpal necrosis is often periodically derived
2) Reversible Pulpitis
a. pain subsided after the removal of the stimulation in cases of reversible pulpits
Periapical cemental dysplasia in its early stages is best differentiated clinically from apical
abscess by which of the following methods>
A. Palpation
B. Patient symptoms
C. Percussion
D. Periodontal examination
E. Radiographic appearance
F. Pulp Testing F. Pulp Testing
1) Pulp Testing
a. tooth should be tested for vitality to rule-out apical abscess
b. a vital pulp designation suggest that the radiolucency is probably due to other causes
b. presence of an intact lamina dura along the apical portion of the involved tooth also shows that
the radiolucency did not come from an infected tooth.
A patient presents to your office with a tooth #19 that tests indicate pulp necrosis, pain on
percussion; and no periodical lesion present. Which of the following should the emergency
treatment consist of?
A. Open the tooth to achieve drainage and leave the tooth open to drain
B. Open the tooth, perform apical trephination, temporize, and check occlusion
C. Perform a pulpotomy, temporize, and check the occlusion
D. Prescribe antibiotics and analgesics and reschedule the patient for later
E. Debride the canals, temporize, and check the occlusion E. Debride the canals, temporize, and
check the occlusion
A. Apical surgery with removal of the apical segment root canal treatment of the coronal
segment
B. Apical surgery with reverse filling
C. Calcium hydroxide treatment of the coronal segment only
D. Extraction with removal of the apical segment and replantation of the coronal segment
E. Extraction of both tooth segments D. Extraction with removal of the apical segment and
replantation of the coronal segment
2) Intentional replantation
a. indicated when the apical half of the root of the tooth cannot be engaged, cleaned, and shaped
b. extract the apical segment and replant the coronal segment that recently received a root end
filling
Which of the following actions is indicated if an accessory canal in the middle 1/3 of a tooth with
a necrotic pulp and an adjacent radiolucent lesion is noted? A radiograph made after obturation
suggest that no material entered the accessory canal?
A. Observe the patient with a 6 month recall and radiograph schedule for the next year
B. Perform an apicoectomy
C. Re-obturate the canal using the continuous wave warm lateral to force material into the
accessory canal
D. Expose the root surgically then curette the lesoin A. Observe the patient with a 6 month recall
and radiograph schedule for the next year
1) Treatment
a. best to observe and evaluate the root canal treated tooth prior to re-obturating the canal even if
the accessory canal was not included during obturation
b. observation is best because the complete sealing of the main root canal might be sufficient to
prevent bacterial re-infection.
c. only way to know if the treatment was successful is by having recall and radiographic
evaluation to assess bone healing and absence of active infection
A patient presents with continuous and spontaneous pain associated with the maxillae left central
incisor. Tooth #9 has a large Class V composite restoration placed many years ago. Cold testing
elicits a lingering pain. There is no sensitivity to percussion or palpation. What is the most
probable diagnosis?
Diagnosis
1) Irreversible pulpits
a. condition known to elicit spontaneous lingering, and throbbing pain sometimes without a
stimulus
2) Continuous pain
a. experienced by the patient is an indication that the pulp is already inflamed and irritated even
without external stimulus
b. large and old Class V restoration could have lost its seal and served as an opening for bacterial
invasion.
Which of the following pulpal changes is MOST PROBABLE to occur if a permanent tooth with
a mature apex is intruded due to trauma?
A. Internal resorptin
B. Necrosis
C. Transient inflammation
D. Calcific metamorphosis B. Necrosis
1) Necrosis
a. When a permanent tooth is intruded, the most probable result is pulpal necrosis because the
blood vessels supplying the pulp are impeded
b. intrusion of primary teeth does not typically result in necrotic pulp because the bloodflow is
better because of the open apex
c. 90% of intruded primary teeth will re-erupt after 2-6 months
Pulpotomies are CONTRAINDICATED in primary molars with which of the following?
1) Internal resorption
Root canal therapy is indicated to treat cases involving internal resorption.
2) Treatment Options
a. When a carious lesion approximates or extends into the pulp chamber of a deciduous tooth,
removal of coronal pulp is performed to prevent the spread of the infection into the radicular
pulp
3) Pulpotomies
a. performed on deciduous teeth to prevent premature tooth loss and potential loss of space
b. Contraindications
1) internal root resorption (root canal therapy indicated)
2) perforation of pulp chamber floor
3) over 1/2 root resorption
4) cellulitis
5) localized abscess
6) draining sinus
7) inability to isolate the tooth
8) inability to properly restore tooth after the procedure
During an automobile accident, a patient experiences a blow to the face and mouth. Radiographs
suggest a horizontal mid-root fracture of maxillary central incisor. The tooth presents with NO
mobility and NO symptoms. The tooth does not response to pulp testing. No radiographic lesion
is present. The best course of action is...
1) Solubility
a. increasing the power to liquid ratio makes the mixture more viscous, stronger, and less soluble
b. presence of moisture on a mixing slab also affects the quality of the polyacrylic acid liquid and
increases the solubility of the zinc phosphate cement mix
c. proper mixing techniques also affects the quality of the mixture
d. the zinc phosphate must be uniformly mixed through flat sweeping motion of the spatula while
powder is added in increments
Which of the following does a negative response of a tooth to electronic pulp testing (EPT) an
hour after a severe lunation indicate?
2) Negative response
a. may not always indicate pulpal necrosis because many teeth take about 2 months to respond to
electric pulp testing again
Sudden relief of severe pain associated with a dentoalveolar abscess can be explained by which
of the following?
1) Dentoalveolar abscesses
a. accumulation of pus within the teeth, gums, and supporting alveolar bone
b. accumulation of pus within the dentoalveolar abscess creates hydrostatic pressure, resulting in
the sensation of severe pain
c. treated through root canal treatment and possibly incision and drainage depending upon case
severity
d. drainage of the lesion releases the pressure caused by the suppuration and results in sudden
relief of pain that is experiences by the patient.
e. severe, intense, and throbbing pain which worsens with the passage of time
f. can be partially diagnosed by noting the presence of periodical radiolucency
Which of the following describes the most common sequences of treatment for replanting
permanent teeth with closed apices?
A. Canal debridement, calcium hydroxide therapy, repositioning, splinting, and gutta-percha fill
B. Root canal therapy, Respositioning, and splinting
C. Repositioning, splinting, and root canal therapy
D. Repositioning, splinting, canal debridement, calcium hydroxide therapy, and gutta-percha fill
D. Repositioning, splinting, canal debridement, calcium hydroxide therapy, and gutta-
percha fill
3) Irreversible Pulpitis
a. lingering sensitivity after the cold stimulus is removed.
b. may or may not elicit spontaneous pain
4) Reversible Pulpitis
a. characterized by a patient that may be sensitive to cold or sweet but the pain quickly
diminished once the cold stimulus is removed
Each of the following would be visible on a periodical radiograph EXCEPT one. Which is the
EXCEPTION?
A. Calcification of a canal
B. Canals of a maxillary 1st premolar
C. Lingual curvature of the palatal root
D. Open apex of a tooth
E. Perforation of the furcation C. Lingual curvature of the palatal root
1) Root Radiographs
a. illustrate a 2-dimensional mesiodistal view of the tooth and surrounding structures, therefore
the buccolingual aspects are not able to be portrayed
b. canal that suddenly disappears midroot, or appears off center is often the result of the tooth
possessing 2 canals
c. open apices and furcation perforations can also be seen radiographically
Which of the following histologic features are least likely to be found in normal dental pulp?
A. cold/thermal testing
B. palpation
C. percussion
D. Test cavity
E. Electric pulp test A. cold/thermal testing
1) Irreversible Pulpitis
a. pain perceived by a tooth with irreversible pulpits during a cold test or a heat test is more
intense and lingers even after the stimulus is removed
1) Treatment
a. root canal therapy is the treatment of choice for teeth with non-vital pulps resulting from
trauma
b. necrotic tissues (pulp and infected dentin) are removed, canals are cleansed with an irrigating
solution like sodium hypochlorite, then filled with an inert material and a coronal restoration is
placed to seal the canals from the oral environment and restore masticatory function.
2) Vitality tests
a. performed in order to assess the status of the pulpal tissue, especially after a tooth has
undergone trauma
b. teeth which do not respond to vitality tests are considered non-vital and possess a necrotic
pulp
Which of the following is the MOST LIKELY adverse effect of internally bleaching an
endodontically treated tooth with superoxide?
1) Concept: The most common side effect of internally bleaching a tooth with superoxide is
external cervical root resorption.
2) The presence of a glass ionomer barrier over the root filling material may help to reduce the
instances of external cervical root resorption if it is at least 4mm in thickness.
3) The walking bleach technique using sodium perborate is NOT associated with external
cervical root resorption.
A. Cell-free zone
B. Odontoblastic layer
C. Plasma cells
D. Undifferentiated mesenchymal cells C. Plasma cells
1) Concept: A healthy pulp does NOT contain plasma cells because they are stimulated to
migrate to the pulp with inflammation and infection.
1) Concept: Symptomatic apical periodontitis (SAP) presents with pain upon masticatory forces
or percussion.
A. Alternative to treatment
B. Benefits of treatment
C. Cost of treatment
D. Risks of treatment C. Cost of treatment
1) Informed consent requires that the patient has the capacity to act autonomously with
understanding, and without outside controlling influences.
2) Informed consent requires that the patient have the knowledge and understanding of the risks
and benefits of the proposed treatments.
Basic Endodontic Treatment Procedures Basic Endodontic Treatment Procedures Answers
Which of the following pairs of intracanal instruments and its action is INCORRECT?
A. Intracanal instruments are more susceptible to breaking if they are rotated after becoming
locked into dentin
B. K-files can be used to file and ream, while a reamer can only be used to ream
C. Reaming action will enlarge a root canal and make it more round in shape
D. Rotating instruments in a clockwise direction forces debris apically, while counterclockwise
rotation forces debris coronally D. Rotating instruments in a clockwise direction forces
debris apically, while counterclockwise rotation forces debris coronally
1) Directions
a. debris is forced in a coronal direction when rotating instruments are used in a clockwise
direction and vice versa
2) K files
a. have both reaming and filing actions when used during root canal preparation
3) Reamers
a. cause enlargement of root canals producing a round shape
b. cannot be used in a filing motion
4) Separated instruments
a. to prevent broken or separated instruments, never fro to rotate an instrument that is locked into
dentin.
Which of the following describes which cell layer the nerve plexus of raschkow resides in?
A. Cell-free layer
B. Cell-rich layer
C. Central core of the pulp
D. Odontoblastic layer
E. Only in the apical 1/3 of the tooth A. Cell-free layer
1) Cells found in the dental pulp
a. fibroblasts (principal cell)
b. odontoblasts
c. defense cells like
1) histiocytes
2) macrophages
3) granulocytes
4) mast cells
5) plasma cells
3) A-fibers
a. myelinated nerve that conduct rapid and sharp pain sensations
b. close association with the odontoblasts and extend fibers to many but not all dentinal tubules
4) C-fibers
a. thinner, non-myelinated nerved involved in dull aching pain
b. terminate in the pulp tissue proper, either as free nerve endings or as branches around blood
vessels
Proper irrigation helps decrease the likelihood of incomplete removal of bacteria, pulp tissue,
and dentinal shavings. Which of the following is the best method to ensure complete cleaning of
the root canal?
A. Oval
B. Pentagonal
C. Triangular
D. TrapezoidalD. Trapezoidal
1) Access Preparation
a. design for the mandibular 1st molar is trapezoidal in shape, since it follows the position of the
cusp tips
1) Taper
a. 0.02mm taper indicates an increase of 0.02mm in diameter per 1mm of file length.
b. describes the amount of file diameter increases with each millimeter from tip of the file toward
the handle.
The pulpal anatomy of which of the following teeth means that the endodontic access should be
triangular in shape?
A. Adjusting occlusion
B. Debriding the canal system of necrotic tissues
C. Introducing antimicrobial medicaments into the pulp space
D. Prescribing analgesics B. Debriding the canal system of necrotic tissues
1) Recapitulation
a. serves to maintain canal latency
b. it also prevents deposition of dentin chips and fillings that may cause blockage of the canal
during step back canal preparation
c. performing recapitulation on after each file is used prevents canal preparation errors like apical
transportation, incomplete instrumentation, and under-filling during obturation
When instrumenting the medial root of a mandibular 1st molar, which of the following canal
surfaces is the most likely to become stripping-perforated?
A. Buccal
B. Distal
C. Lingual
D. Mesial B. Distal
A. Polyvinyl resin
B. Zinc oxide
C. Zinc Oxyphosphate
D. Zinc stearate
E. Polycarboxylate B. Zinc oxide
1) Zinc oxide
a. antibiotic properties
b. serves to prevent reinfection of the root canal
2) Eugenol
a. sometime used in conjunction and serves to sedate and sooth periradicular nerve tissues to
decrease post obturation sensitivity
The root canal anatomy of a maxillary 1st molar with 4 canals requires which shape of access
preparation?
A. Ovoid
B. Quadrilateral
C. Square
D. Triangular
E. Round B. Quadrilateral
A. Filing 0.5-1.0mm beyond the radiographic index and obturating to the radiographic index
B. Filing 0.5-1.0mm short of the radiographic index and obturating to 0.5-1.0mm short of the
radiographic apex
C. Filing to the radiographic index and obturating 0.5-1.0mm short of the radiographic index
D. Filing to the radiographic apex and obturating to the radiographic apex B. Filing 0.5-1.0mm
short of the radiographic index and obturating to 0.5-1.0mm short of the radiographic apex
1) Filing procedures
a. recommended to keep the preparation length 0.5-1.0mm short of the radiographic apex during
root canal treatment.
b. leaves a pulp stump (apical constriction), which prevents extrusion of irritating filling
materials into the periradicular tissues.
c. Filing should be carried out followed by gutta percha filling placement 0.5-1.0mm short of the
radiographic apex to provide a hermetic apical seal.
Procedural Complications Procedural Complications Answers
Which of the following is the suggested protocol if the pulpal floor is perforated during access
preparation?
A. Perform no treatment at this time and schedule the patient for an extraction
B. Repair the perforation and continue the root canal treatment at a subsequent appointment
C. Repair the perforation at a subsequent appointment only if symptoms occur
D. Repair the perforation immediately with mineral trioxide aggregate (MTA/Portland Cement),
inform the patient, and reassess the tooth at the recall appointment
E. Continue the root canal treatment as normally planned because tertiary dentin will fill in
D. Repair the perforation immediately with mineral trioxide aggregate (MTA/Portland
1) Root Perforations
a. should be addressed immediately through the use of MTA to help stimulate healing of
periradicular tissues and to promote cementum deposition
b. MTA is ideal material since it create a seal when moisture is present
c. MTA is biocompatible and is capable of inducing periradicular tissue repair and cementum
deposition
If a permanent maxillary central incisor was avulsed and rigidly splinted, what is the most likely
outcome?
A. Internal resorption
B. Normal healing process
C. Replacement resorption
D. Root fracture
E. Calcific metamorphosis C. Replacement resorption
1) Avulsed tooth should be splinted with a flexible splint to avoid extensive healing
complications like replacement resorption
2) Avulsed teeth should have some degree of freedom to lessen pressure on the bone and allows
better healing along the periodical aspect of bone surrounding the traumatized tooth.
Two weeks following the obturation of a maxillary central incisor due to trauma, a radio-opaque
horizontal line was noted in the midroot area, extending both medially and distally and into the
periodontal ligament (PDL) space. This finding is most likely indicative of...
A. Accessory canals
E. A midroot fracture E. A midroot fracture
1) Midroot fracture
a. become more visible after root canal treatment as the sealer flows out of the space in between
the fractures
b. prognosis of a midroot fracture is relatively poor
c.
Which of the following is the most UNDESIRABLE property of sodium hypochlorite?
1) Sodium Hypochlorite
a. undiluted or excessive amounts is toxic to vital tissues and can cause periodical tissue damage
and pain
b. good disinfectant that is used in dentistry as an endodontic canal irritant at a diluted
concentration
c. disinfect gutta percha points prior to placement and obturatoin of the canal
Which method is the best to manage loss of apical seat due to over-instrumentation?
1) Apical seat
a. use a shorter length of file to establish a correct working length
b. correction of working length will eventually hep re-establish apical seat, then adequate flaring
of the apical portion of the canal can be done with the use of larger sized hand files
You break a size of 35 K-file 1mm short of the apex in the MB1 canal of tooth #15 that was
diagnosed with irreversible pulpits. The remaining file can neither be retrieved nor by-passed. It
is indicated that the dentist finishes the root canal treatment and does which of the following?
1) Broken file
a. broken file inside poses some risks of reinfection due to the incomplete sealing of the canal
b. process of instrumentation, cleaning and shaping is compromised because of the broken file,
which may result in a failure of the root canal treatment later.
c. unretrieved broken file may stay inside the mouth if the tooth is asymptomatic and if a
radiographic lesion shows evidence of healing
Which of the following locations would a perforation demonstrate the BEST prognosis?
A. Apical 1/3 of root
B. Coronal 1/3 of root
C. Floor of pulp chamber
D. Middle 1/3 of root A. Apical 1/3 of root
1) Apical Perforations
a. occur through the apical foramen or the body of the root to form a new canal
b. the more apical the perforation the more favorable the prognosis for the tooth (except for
coronal perforations)
Which of the following locations would a perforation present the HIGHEST failure risk?
A. Apex
B. Apical 1/3 of the root
C. Crown
D. Furcation
E. Middle 1/3 of the root D. Furcation
Perforations
a. HIGHEST risk for endodontic failure is the perforation through the furcation because it is
more difficult to seal
b. Perforations near the root apex can be sealed during obturation.
c. Teeth with endodontic perforations may still be successful.
d. NOT a guarantee of endodontic failure
Traumatic Injuries Traumatic Injuries Answers
A 42 year old patient reports to your office after a car accident where their maxillary central
incisor is traumatized, and is slightly tender to percussion, is in good alignment, and responds
normally to pulp vitality tests. Radiographic examination reveals a horizontal fracture of the
apical 1/3 of the root. Which of the following is the treatment of choice?
1) Pulp vitality tests on traumatized teeth are usually inaccurate, necessitating a few weeks later.
2) A tooth that has fracture roots in close proximity with one another have a greater chance of
developing calcific metamorphosis, therefore splinting for the immobilization of the traumatized
tooth is necessary.
An 8 year old boy presents to your office with a traumatized #8 that no longer responds to
electric and thermal vitality tests. Which of the following is the suggested treatment?
A. Apexification
B. Calcium Hydroxide pulpotomy
C. Pulpectomy
D. Re-evaluate after 2 weeks
E. Svek pulpotomy D. Re-evaluate after 2 weeks
1) Traumatized immature teeth may give a false reading with thermal and electric vitality tests
because their blood supply may still be intact, but their nerve may not respond.
2) As the circulation is restored to the tooth, the responsiveness to pulp testing may return after 2
weeks.
3) Apexification or pulpectomy is NOT indicated at this time because the pulp may still be vital.
Which of the following treatments is indicated for a 5-year-old patient with a sinus tract and a
dark brown discoloration associated with their maxillary central incisor that appeared following
trauma.
1) Extraction
a. of the primary maxillary central incisor is induced for a 5 year old child when the tooth is
associated with a sinus tract and discoloration
b. NOT advisable to retain this tooth considering the proximity of the permanent successor and
age of the patient. Retention of this diseased tooth can lead to abnormal function of permanent
tooth.
2) Turner's Tooth
a. describes when the permanent tooth bud is affected via infection or trauma of a primary tooth
3) Infection
a. most commonly affects the canine
b. trauma most commonly affects the maxillary central incisor
An 11-year-old girl presents to your office 4 hours after a fall that fractured her maxillary central
incisor to the point that the remaining tooth structure is supra gingival. The exposed pulp is
diagnosed as vital. Which of the following is considered the treatment of choice?
1) Proper restoration of the fracture maxillary central incisor can only be done if the tooth
undergoes root canal treatment
2) Tooth can be restored after root canal treatment and exposure of adequate tooth length.
Which of the following is the correct sequence for the INITIAL TREATMENT in which mature
avulsed teeth are replanted?
A. Performing root canal debridement, calcium hydroxide therapy, repositioning, splinting, and
filling with gutta-percha
B. Repositioning and splinting only
C. Respositioning, splinting, and performing root canal therapy
D. Performing root-canal therapy, repositioning, and splinting B. Repositioning and
splinting only
1) During an initial treatment, the avulsed tooth is gently repositioned into its socket and then
splinted to the adjacent teeth to ensure that the arch form is preserved
2) Maintaining the tooth's proper position within the socket is important for the success of the
replantation procedure. Tooth should be splinted until it is stable enough until the necessary
treatments can be done.
In a clinical exam following a traumatic injury, which of the following is the LEAST reliable
finding?
A. Displacement of teeth
B. Loss of tooth structure
C. Tooth vitality
D. Tooth mobility C. Tooth vitality
1) Tooth that recently experience trauma may or may not elicit a response to tooth vitality test
because the nerves of the tooth could be damaged
2) Inability of the traumatized tooth to elicit pulpal response during a vitality test can be
attributed to the injury within the nerve fibers of the tooth.
3) Tooth with trauma may takes approximately 8 weeks at a minimum before it can display
normal pulp response.
Adjunctive Endodontic Therapy Adjunctive Endodontic Therapy Answers
When restoring an endodontically treated tooth with amalgam, what depth into each root canal
should be achieved to obtain satisfactory retention?
A. 2mm
B. 3mm
C. 4mm
D. 5mm
E. 1mm B. 3mm
1) Amalgam
a. A depth of at least 3mm into the root canals is essential for the retention of an amalgam
restoration in an endodontically treated tooth
b. depends upon mechanical retention because it does not demonstrate chemical bonding with the
tooth structure
c. after completing root canal treatment, roughly 3mm of gutta percha should be removed from
the root canals using a heated instrument
d. space created int he root canal should be filled and condensed with amalgam before carrying
out coronal filling (nayyar core technique)
Each of the following are true regarding the treatment tooth with a sinus tract EXCEPT one.
Which is the EXCEPTION?
a. Chronic Apical Abscesses present with sinus tracts that eventually drain into the oral cavity
although they may drain into the gingival sulcus (which may imitate a periodontal abscess)
b. Teeth with sinus tract do NOT require antibiotics because the infection drains
c. Apical periodontitis (acute or chronic) should be treated with root canal therapy.
d. If the tract does not heal within a month or so, root-end surgery should be performed
e. Teeth with chronic apical periodontitis may develop an epithelial lining and form a true
periodontal pocket if they are left untreated.
Which of the following material is typically used for the walking bleach technique?
3) Carbamide peroxide
a. used for vital tooth bleaching (external bleaching)
The prognosis for internal bleaching is best if the etiology of the stain is...
A. Necrotic pulp tissue
B. Precipitation of metallic salts
C. Silver-containing root canal sealers
D. Amalgam restorations A. Necrotic pulp tissue
2) Staining from silver containing root canal sealers and from mercury of amalgam restorations
a. appear dark
b. seldom treated by bleaching
c. restorative treatments provide the most esthetic result because they remove or cover up these
stains
Each of the following statements about post preparations is CORRECT EXCEPT one. Which is
the EXCEPTION?
A. It is recommended that at least 5mm of gutta percha should remain in the root canal after the
post space is prepared
B. Posts are indicated when there is inadequate coronal tooth structure for fixed restorations
C. Posts reinforce the tooth structure and prevent vertical root fractures
D. Posts retain the core for teeth with extensive coronal tooth structure loss C. Posts
reinforce the tooth structure and prevent vertical root fractures
1) Posts
a. function of posts are to retain the core, they DO NOT reinforce the tooth
b. typically weaken the tooth because the removal of dentin causes stress and further thins the
walls of the root, predisposing the root to fracture
c. Rule of thumb for post preparation is that you prepared the canals so that 1/2 of the root has
gutta percha remaining (or about 5mm+)
Which of the following is the usual sequence for the amputation (resection) or a root for
periodontal reasons?
1) Amputation (resection)
a. root canal system is exposed during root amputation and therefore must immediately undergo
root canal therapy to ensure that no bacteria will enter the canal system
b. resection of a root with a hopeless or questionable prognosis in its periodontal condition will
save the whole tooth from being extracted
c. periodontal therapy should follow immediately after root canal treatment is accomplished in
order to stop or prevent further periodontal damage
d. root amputation typically prolongs the life of the tooth by about 5 years on average
Each of the following is a reason for placing a post in the restoration of an endodontically treated
posterior tooth EXCEPT one. Which is the EXCEPTION?
1) Post
a. primary purpose or using a post in an endodontically treated tooth is to retain the core if there
is extensive loss of coronal tooth structure
b. enhance the resistance of the restoration to lateral forces depending on the amount of
remaining tooth structure, the length and rigidity of the post, presence of ferrule and the presence
of anti-rotation features
c. placement of posts inside the root canal does NOT strengthen the root tooth.
Post Treatment Evaluation Post Treatment Evaluation Answers
Most vertical root fractures of endodontically treated teeth result from which of the following?
1) Concept: Endodontically treated test are weaker and more prone to fracture when excessive
condensation forces is used during obturation.
2) The width of the prepared root canal compared to the remaining tooth structure also affects the
ability of the endodontically treated to withstand condensation forces.
3) During the condensation of the gutta percha, the force exerted during the compaction of the
gutta percha is transmitted back to the walls of the tooth.
A marked reduction in the size of a periodical radiolucency can be expected approximately how
long after a root canal procedure is completed?
A. 1 Month
B. 1 Year
C. 2 Weeks
D. 2 Years
E. 3 Months
F. 1 Week B. 1 Year
1) Concept: The continuous bone deposition increases the bone density along the periodical area
resulting in a diminished periodical lesion size after about a year.
2) The periodical bone regeneration usually occurs at a rate of about 1.2mm2 per month,
gradually reducing the size of the periodical lesion.
3) Bone deposition in the periodical area is not very evident radiographically until sufficient
thickness of bone is present.
An endodontically treated tooth was restored using a cast post-and-core with a porcelain fused to
metal crown. The patient complains of pain on biting 3 months after the restoration was
completed. Radiographs and mobility are normal. Which of the following is the most probable
reason the patient is feeling pain?
A. Loose crown
B. Open crown margin
C. Psychosomatic
D. Vertical root fracture
E. Premature contact D. Vertical root fracture
1) Concept: Endodontically treated teeth with cast post and core restorations that occlude under
heavy occlusal stress may end up with a vertical root fracture.
2) Cast post and core restorations are solid restorations that completely adapt into the canal
system.
3) Occlusal and shear forces encountered by the cast post-and-core is immediately transmitted to
the weakened endodontic tooth, resulting in a vertical root fracture.
True/False:
One objective of root-canal obturation is to create a fluid tight seal. Another objective is to create
an environment of healing to occur. Both statements are True
1) Concept: Obturation
a. is the step in root canal treatment that involves filling the root canal with a biocompatible
material to create a hermetic seal to prevent contamination caused by leakage either from the oral
cavity or periradicular tissues into the root canal.
b. seals the remaining irritants in the root canal system after proper cleaning and shaping of the
canal creates a conducive environment for the periodical healing to occur.
The treatment with the most favorable post treatment prognosis is a tooth with...
1) Concept: An area with limited internal root resorption provides a more favorable prognosis
because there is less irritation incurred to the pulp.
2) Vertical fractures are best manage with tooth extraction since the tooth will always have a
fracture line which weakens the tooth and exposes it to the harmful bacteria inside the mouth.
3) External lateral root resorption entails destruction of root surface of the tooth that my weaken
the root itself. Treatment external root resorption is also difficult to perform.
Which of the following describes when a clinician can reasonable expect a reduction in the size
of a periodical lesion to be radiographically evident following endodontic therapy?
A. 1-2 weeks
B. 1-2 months
C. 2-3 weeks
D. 6-12 months
E. > 1 year D. 6-12 months
1) Concepts: A clinician can expect bone to be redeposited in the apical area following the
removal of the infected tissues and obturation/swelling of the root canals.
2) When the lesion is healed, osteoblasts form a collagen matrix which is then calcified.
1) Concept: Formation of reparative dentin only occurs when the odontoblasts in the pulp are
still vital.
2) Reparative dentin is laid down by the odontoblasts in the pulp to protect the pulp and keep it
away from the harmful stimuli
3) Apical seal is the main objective of the root canal treatment in order to prevent bacterial
invasion of pulp canal and periodical tissues.
The duration of activity of diazepam depends chiefly on
1) Duration of action for diazepam is due to the long half life of desmethyldiazepam, which may
last from 3 to 7 days.
2) Diazepam
a. fast acting agent with a long duration of action
b. lipid solutble
c. binds to proteins
c. widely distributed throughout the body
The clinical definition of alcohol abuse is when someone...
1) Alcohol Abuse
a. when your alcohol intake causes harm to yourself, to your social and interpersonal
relationships, and to your capability to perform your duties at work
b. Symptoms
1) Poor judgment
2) tipsiness
3) irritability
4) sleeping difficulties
A. C-1
B. K+
C. Mg+2
D. Na+1
E. Ca+2 B. K+
1) Potassium (K) and hydrocholorothiazide are used in combination in order to reduce the
patient's blood pressure and prevent the occurrence of hypokalemia.
3) Potassium
a. regulate intracellular osmoregulation
b. helps in reducing unneeded water and salt inside the body
Excretion of an acidic drug will be increased if which of the following is administered to the
patient?
A. Ammonium chloride
B. Mannitol
C. Sodium Chloride
D. Sodium bicarbonate
E. Aldosterone D. Sodium bicarbonate
1) Concept: Alkalinization of urine through the use of sodium bicarbonate decreases acid drug
reabsorption and increases renal excretion of the drug.
3) If the drug is a weak base, making the urine more alkaline, it will help the drug be reabsorbed.
A. Fluconazole (Diflucan)
B. Griseofulvin (Grifulvin)
C. Miconazole (Monistat)
D. Nystatin (Mycostatin)
E. Clotrimazole Troche (Mycelex) A. Fluconazole (Diflucan)
1) Fluconazole
a. oral triazole used to treat and prevent superficial and systemic fungal infections by inhibiting
the fungal cytochrome P450 enzyme.
b. inhibition of P450 prevents the conversion of lanosterol to ergosterol, and essential component
of the fungal cytoplasmic membrane
3) Griseofulvin
a. primarily used to treat hair and nail fungal infections
The most ideal class of drugs for oral sedation in the dental setting are:
A. Antihistamines
B. Benzodiazepines
C. Muscle relaxants
D. Opioids
E. Barbiturates B. Benzodiazepines
1) Benzodiazepines
a. popular anti anxiety drugs
b. produce anterograde amnesia so that patients does not remember any unpleasant feeling after
the surgical procedure is completed
The ration of an agents LD50 to ED50 provides information as to the drug's
A. Efficacy
B. Potency
C. Safety
D. Therapeutic application
E. Allergenicity C. Safety
1) Concept: Redistribution of ultra-short acting barbiturates into all body tissues explains the
rapid recovery time.
2) Barbiturates
a. eliminated from the bloodstream as they redistribute into body tissues
b. excess drug may also be stored within body fat
c. if the fat becomes saturated with too much barbiturate, the only way to eliminate this excess is
through drug metabolism
d. with slow metabolisms, barbiturates may stay longer in the body causing prolonged effects,
delayed anesthetic recovery, and a possibility of overdose
A 53-year-old male presents for multiple extractions and has been taking 10mg of prednisone
daily for colitis for the last 10 years. After consulting with the patient's physician, you should:
A. Change the patient to another steroid for the week before the surgery
B. Decrease the patient's dose of prednisone by half to 5 mg on the day of surgery
C. Discontinue the patient's steroid therapy preoperatively
D. Send the patient for serum prednisone levels
E. Ask the patient to continue taking the prednisone and consider temporarily increasing the dose
E. Ask the patient to continue taking the prednisone and consider temporarily increasing
the dose
1) Concept: If a patient taking steroids is going to have a surgery, go ahead and increase the dose
A. Prilocaine
B. Bupivacaine
C. Lidocaine
D. Procaine
E. Articaine C. Lidocaine
1) Lidocaine
a. an effective topical anesthetic drug that can effectively numb the mucosal surfaces of the oral
cavity
b. lidocaine topical anesthetic can penetrate approximately 2-3mm deep into the mucosal layer
when applied properly.
General Principles General Principles Answers
Which of the following is NOT a biologic change that occurs with advancing age that affects the
pharcodyanmics and pharmacokinetic of pharmaceuticals?
1) As people age
a. decreased renal excretion occurs as people age, causing increased longevity inside the body for
agents that are renal excreted
b. some drugs may have increased half lives due to reduced functionality of organs metabolizing
the drug such as the liver as we age
c. a decreasing rate of biotransformation also occurs as we get older because if inadequate
production of enzymes that activate the drug.
Which of the following cannot be used to accurately calculate pediatric drug dosages?
1) Inaccurate pediatric dosage has been found to be the leading cause of medical problems in
children.
A. Absorption
B. Biotransformation
C. Distribution
D. Excretion
E. Temperature A. Absorption
1) Concept: Absorption
a. major factor determining the onset of action of orally administered drugs.
b. intravenous drugs demonstrate rapid onset of action due to high absorption while oral drugs
have delayed onset of action due to their first pass metabolism.
c. Different routs of administration provide different absorption rates.
2) Onset of action
a. The onset of action of a drug varies depending upon the routs of administration in the body.
How many milliliters are in a tablespoon?
A. 10 mL
B. 15 mL
C. 20 mL
D. 25 mL
E. 5 mL B. 15 mL
1) Tablespoon
a. There are 15mL in a tablespoon
b. a tablespoon is the largest type of spoon in USA and some part of Canada
c. MOST COMMON function of a tablespoon is its use as a measure of volume in cooking and
dispensing of cough syrup to children
2) Teaspoon
a. 1 tablespoon is equal to 3 teaspoons
Which of the following rationales most accurately describes why high polarized pharmaceuticals
work more rapidly?
1) Low lipid solubility of highly polar medication makes them less permeable to cell membranes
and increase their absorption in the blood stream.
2) High absorption in the bloodstream increases their bioavailability and efficacy as well.
Which of the following is another term for the maximal or "ceiling" effect of drug?
A. Agonism
B. Duration
C. Efficacy
D. Potency
E. Specificity C. Efficacy
1) Concept: Efficacy
a. Efficacy is another ten used for the maximal or ceiling effect of a drug
b. Efficacy is the capacity of a drug to produce its pharmacology effect in the body
c. In other words, it is the maximum achievable result from a drug
What drug characteristic does the ration of the LD50 vs. ED50 indicate to someone?
A. Efficacy
B. Potency
C. Safety
D. Therapeutic application
E. Allergenicity C. Safety
1) Therapeutic Index
a. Therapeutic index is a ratio of the dose of a drug that causes lethal effect over the minimum
dose of the drug that can elicit a therapeutic effect or LD50/ED50
b. Therapeutic index is important to check the margin of safety of using a certain drug
c. High therapeutic index value states that the drug is effective at a minimum dose and its lethal
effect occurs at higher doses
d. Low therapeutic index suggests that the drug has a narrow margin of safety
The primary reason to use antibiotic disk sensitivity assay use is...
A. It allows for the prescriber to test common antibiotics to see which are effective against the
infection in question.
B. It allows the prescriber to know which meds will cause more GI upset by destroying normal
gut flora
C. The results can be determined within minutes
D. It can distinguish between bacteriostatic and bactericidal effects on the bacteria in question
A. It allows for the prescriber to test common antibiotics to see which are effective
against the infection in question.
2) Penicillin Vk
a. Penicillin Vk is a chemically augmented form of penicillin that combines acid stability with an
immediate solubility and faster rate of absorption
b. highly effective against pneumococci, staphylococci except for strains producing penicilinase
and streptococci (groups A, C, G, H, L, and M)
c. Half-life is approximately 30-60 minutes and takes about 5 hours to clear the body entirely.
The endplate potential of neuromuscular junctions is established through...
A. An increase in the conductance of sodium, chloride, and potassium ions through the
postsynaptic membrane
B. Hydrolysis of acetylcholine
C. Increased movement of potassium ions in the postsynaptic membrane
D. Reduction of the resting potential at the postsynaptic area by acetylcholine D. Reduction
of the resting potential at the postsynaptic area by acetylcholine
1) Concept: Roughly 20% of ethanol absorption occurs in the stomach and 80% takes place in
the jejunum and ileum of the small intestine.
3) Alcohol absorption occurs quicker with an empty stomach because the pyloric sphincter has
no food to hold inside the stomach allows the alcohol to pass through, absorbing in the small
intestines.
When ethanol is consumed while a patient is taking barbiturates, the resulting reaction is
considered...
A. Competitive inhibition
B. Non-competitive inhibition
C. Potentiation
D. Uncompetitive inhibition
E. Negative synergism C. Potentiation
1) Concept: Potentiation occurs when one drug administered simultaneously with another drug
interacts to produce a synergistic effect.
2) Barbiturates are drugs known to cause depression of the central nervous system (CNS). Due to
their ability to make people calm, relaxed, and sleepy, they are also termed as sedative-
hypnotics.
3) Alcohol, like the barbiturates also depress the central nervous system. When alcohol is given
in combination with barbiturates, further depression of CNS can occur which might lead to
unconsciousness or death.
Which property of Erythromycin (macrolide) explains its propensity for interaction with other
drugs?
2) Erythromycin
a. stops the enzymatic reaction for other drugs, making their metabolism in the liver slower,
leading to possible increased toxicity of other drugs.
3) Toxic megacolon
a. is a side effect of inflammatory bowel diseases like Crohn's disease and ulcerative colitis,
which prevents pharmaceutical absorption.
The euphoria experience from ethanol absorption into the bloodstream is caused by...
A. A hypnotic
B. A sedative
C. An anesthetic
D. An opiate A. A hypnotic
1) Concept: Hypnotic
a. Hypnotic drugs are psychoactive medications that are mainly used to induce sleep and are
often used to treat sleep disorders like insomnia as well as surgical anesthesia.
b. prolonged used of hypnotic drugs can cause some form of dependence or habit and therefore
their use met be limited for a very short period of time.
c. Benzodiazepines and non-benzodiazepine drugs are the most common hypnotic drugs present
in the market today.
Which of the following demonstrates an enteral means of administration?
A. Inhalation
B. Intramuscular (IM)
C. Oral
D. Subcutaneous
E. Submucosal C. Oral
1) Concept: Enteral administration of medication is performed through the oral route where the
medicine is expected to be absorbed in the stomach and intestine
2) Intramuscular
a. Intramuscular drug administration is performed by injecting the drug into the big muscles of
the body
3) Inhalation
a. Inhalation route of drug administration is performed through the inspiration of medication in
the form of gas.
4) Subcutaneous
a. Subcutaneous drug administration is achieved through injecting the drug along the fatty
subcutaneous layer under the skin
5) Submucosal
a. Submucosal route of drug administration is achieved by placing the drug under the tongue.
Metabolism of drugs will usually leads to a(an)...
1) Concept: During metabolism, drugs undergo several phases of biotransformation which could
lead them into becoming a less ionized compound.
a. The liver is the primary organ responsible for the biotransformation of drugs.
b. A drug is biotransform in the liver to make it water-soluble, making it easier to be excreted out
of the body.
c. Metabolism can make a drug less ionized, prolonging its effect in the body. A drug can
activate or inactivate drugs.
After a threshold stimulus, the cell membrane permeability becomes altered due to the release of
which of the following transmitter substances?
A. Acetylsalicylic acid
B. Cholinesterase
C. Hydroxycholine
D. Acetylcholine D. Acetylcholine
1) Concept: The cell membrane becomes more permeable with the release of acetylcholine
2) Acetylcholine
a. a chemical neurotransmitter that works both for the central nervous system and peripheral
nervous system of the human body
b. Acetylcholine attaches to the acetylcholine receptors and initiates the opening of the Na
channels within the cell membrane.
A physician may enhance the renal excretion of an acidic drug by administering...
A. Ammonium chloride
B. Mannitol
C. Sodium Chloride
D. Sodium bicarbonate
E. Aldosterone D. Sodium bicarbonate
1) Concept: Alkalinization of urine through the use of sodium bicarbonate decreases acid drug
reabsorption and increases renal excretion of the drug.
3) If the drug is a weak base, making the urine more alkaline will help the drug be reabsorbed.
A. ED1/LD99
B. ED50/LD50
C. LD50/ED50
D. LD99/ED1
E. LD99/LD50 C. LD50/ED50
1) Concept: Therapeutic Indexis a numerical comparison of a drug's therapeutic effect over its
toxic or lethal side effect
2) Therapeutic Index
a. measured by dividing the drug's lethal dose or the dose in which it produces toxic effects over
its minimum effective dose.
b. drugs having a low therapeutic index provides a narrow margin of safety which means, the
drug may pose a great risk as compared to its medical value.
When ingested, isopropyl alcohol is metabolized mostly into...
A. Acetaldehyde
B. Ethanol
C. Formaldehyde
D. Methanol
E. Acetone E. Acetone
1) Concept: Isopropyl alcohol is oxidized in the liver by the alcohol dehydrogenase into acetone
--> acetate --> formate --> C02
A. Inscription
B. Subscription
C. Superscription
D. Transcription
E. Conscription E. Conscription
2) Superscription
a. includes the Rx symbol
3) Inscription
a. contains the name of the drug, quantity, and dosage form
4) Subscription
a. includes the guidelines to be followed by the pharmacist regarding the preparation and
distribution of the medication
5) Transcription
a. is the information regarding the intake of the medication (i.e. how, how much, when, and how
often).
Which blood alcohol content is closest to the LD50 (dosage at which 50% of the population
experiences death) of ethanol?
A. 0.1%
B. 0.2%
C. 0.3%
D. 0.5%
E. 0.08% D. 0.5%
1) Lethal dose fifty (LD50) is the concentration of a substance where half of the experimental
population will die if the substance is consumed.
2) LD50
a. is reached when the alcohol concentration in the bloodstream reach 0.4 to 0.5%
b. LD50 is often used to measure the level of toxicity
c. Variation in LD50 maybe influenced by genetic factors, environmental factors, and mode of
administration
The most medically accepted definition of alcohol abuse is when someone...
A. Endorphins
B. Histamine
C. Prostaglandins
D. Serotonin
E. Bradykinin C. Prostaglandins
1) Concept: Prostaglandins
a. Prostaglandins are lipid molecules that are enzymatically derived from arachadonic acid
2) Endorphins
a. are neurotransmitters that are endogenously formed morphine from the opioid peptides in the
body
3) Bradykinin
a. protein peptide that belongs with the kinin group
5) Histamine
a. produced by mast cells and basophils as an immunologic response to a foreign body that enters
our body
The drug administration method that is characterized by slowed absorption is...
A. Intramuscular (IM)
B. Intravenous (IV)
C. Subcutaneous
D. Sublingual
E. Oral E. Oral
1) Concept: Oral administration has the slowest absorption rate because it follows a long
digestive path prior to being absorbed into the body
2) Intravenous
a. drugs are immediately distributed when they are administered intravenously
b. effect is rapid since the drug is placed directly into the bloodstream
3) Intramuscular
a. administered into the voluntary muscle which provides faster absorption than oral and
subcutaneous routes
4) Subcutaneous
a. performed by inserting the drug under the skin where it will be absorb in a slow manner, thus,
prolonging its action in the body
2) Pupil constriction
a. occurs when the sphincter pupillage muscles elicit a delayed reaction to stimuli due to the
depression of the sympathetic nervous system brought about by excessive consumption of
ethanol
b. Ethanol consumption makes a person less responsive to its surroundings as it alters the senses.
A person under the influence of ethanol experiences CNS depression and diuresis.
Cephalosporins are MOST CONTRAINDICATED for patient that exhibit which of the
following reaction to penicillin antibiotics?
1) Concept: Patients experiencing penicillin allergy also have a tendency to elicit a cross allergic
reactions with cephalosporin drugs.
2) Immediate hypersensitivity (Type I hypersensitivity reaction):
a. is a type of rapidly acting allergic response of the body over a certain kind of allergen
b. may result to severe systemic reactions like anaphylaxis which can cause difficulty of
breathing and death
c. administration of epinephrine and antihistamines may help slow down and present this allergic
reaction
Each of the following statements regarding biotransformation of drugs is true EXCEPT for one.
Which is the EXCEPTION?
1) Concept: Biotransformation
a. Biotransformation involves the conversion of a lipid soluble non-ionized form of a drug into
its more water soluble metabolites
b. Biotransformation increases the absorption of drug into the blood stream, making the
bioavailability of drug is enhanced. Water soluble drugs are also easily excreted in urine.
Which of the following describes the chemical bond type that is LEAST PROBABLE to be
involved in drug-receptor interactions?
A. Covalent
B. Dipole-dipole
C. Electrostatic
D. Hydrogen
E. Van der Waal's forces A. Covalent
2) Drug-receptor interactions
a. are normally considered reversible in nature
Central Nervous System Central Nervous System Answers
Which of the following drugs is most likely to induce convulsions if a physically dependent
patient discontinue their use?
A. Meperidine
B. Pentobarbital
C. Phenytoin
D. Diazepam B. Pentobarbital
1) Concept: The sudden withdrawal of pentobarbital use may cause convulsions in patients who
are physically dependent.
2) Pentobarbital
a. is a short acting barbiturate, or CNS depressant.
b. withdrawal symptoms may be treated by administering another type of drug with a similar
effect as pentobarbital
3) Medical detoxification
a. when the substitute drug to treat the withdrawal symptoms does not have addictive properties
like pentobarbital
Antipsychotic drugs can induce extrapyramidal syndrome because of their effect on the...
A. Basal ganglia
B. Cerebellum
C. Cerebral Cortex
D. Hypothalamus
E. Lateral gyrus A. Basal ganglia
1) Concept: Antipsychotic drugs are known to cause side effects like extrapyramidal syndrome
as they affect the basal ganglia of the brain.
2) The basal ganglia functions during normal voluntary movement. Damage of the basal ganglia
can cause either excessive movement or slowly diminished movement
1) Concept: Levodopa
a. Levodopa is an agent administered to patients to be converted by the body into dopamine to
maintain dopamine levels in the brain.
b. Levodopa has no ability to cure Parkinson's, but functions to delay it's effects and enable the
patient to live and function normally for a period of time
c. Levodopa is the most popular and effective drug for alleviating the symptoms elicited by
patients with Parkinson's disease
d. It improves the patient's control of muscle and balance while also reducing the quantity of
tremors experienced by the patient
Administration of which of the following drugs will result in the LEAST psychomotor
impairment and central nervous system depression?
A. Alprazolam
B. Buspirone
C. Chloral hydrate*
D. Diazepam*
E. Propofol B. Buspirone
1) Concept: Buspirone apart from other sedative hypnotic drugs is used to alleviate anxiety does
NOT cause depression of the central nervous system.
2) Buspirone
a. does NOT impair cognitive and motor coordination as observed from other anxiolytic drugs
b. It also does NOT cause physical dependence and any form of withdrawal syndrome
c. is an anti anxiety drug that is used primarily in generalized anxiety disorder. However this
drug is NOT known to be effective in controlling panic disorders.
What factor it the most likely cause for an early recovery from an ultra-short acting barbiturate in
a patient undergoing surgery?
1) Concept: The redistribution of ultra-short acting barbiturates into all body tissues explains the
rapid recovery time.
2) Barbiturates
a. are eliminated from the bloodstream as they redistribute into body tissues. The excess drug
may also be stored within body fat.
b. If the fat becomes saturated with too much barbiturate, the only way to eliminate this excess is
through drug metabolism.
c. With slow metabolisms, barbiturates may stay longer in the body causing prolonged effects,
delayed anesthetic recovery, and a possibility for overdose
Phenytoin is indicated for treatment of epilepsy and...
A. Barbiturates
B. Monoamine oxidase inhibitors
C. Phenothiazine antipsychotics
D. Tricyclic antidepressants
E. Macrolides C. Phenothiazine antipsychotics
1) Concept: Tardive dyskinesia is a condition were the patient exhibits slow involuntary and
repetitive muscle movements.
2) Tardive dyskinesia is a condition were the patient exhibits slow involuntary and repetitive
muscle movements.
a. results from neuroleptic-induced dopamine super sensitivity in the nigrostriatal pathway, with
the D2 dopamine receptor being most affected.
3) Neuroleptics
a. act primarily on this dopamine system, and older generations of neuroleptics like
phenothiazine antipsychotics have greater affinity for the D2 binding site, and are associated
with a high risk for developing tardive dyskinesia
Administration of which of the following drugs is indicated to treat a grand map seizure.
A. Chlorpromazine (Thorazine)
B. Ethosuximide (Zarontin)
C. Phenytoin (Dilantin)
D. Thioridazine (Mellaril)
E. Trimethadione (Tridione) C. Phenytoin (Dilantin)
1) Concept: Phenytoin is the drug most indicated in managing grand mal seizures
2) Phenytoin
a. reduces the brain stem's unusual activity involved in causing the tonic stage of a tonic-clonic
or gran map seizure
b. stabilizes the brain activity and prevent hyper excitability that occurs due to over stimulation
and environmental stimuli that reduces the membrane sodium gradient
Which opioid analgesic can create a serious life threatening adverse drug reaction when given to
a patient on monamine oxidase inhibitors (MAOI)?
A. Fentanyl
B. Meperidine
C. Morphine
D. Propoxyphene
E. Codeine B. Meperidine
1) Concept: Meperidine when combined with a MAO inhibitor drug can cause life threatening
effects
a. These effects are hyperpyrexia, too much sweating, excitement, and respiratory depression
which can lead to unconsciousness
b. Meperidine is a drug that helps to control the amount of serotonin and dopamine in the blood.
Excessive amounts of these substances may cause hypertensive crisis.
A. Alpha-adrenergic blockade
B. Anticonvulsant effect
C. Antiemetic effect
D. Potentiation of the action of narcotics
E. Sedation B. Anticonvulsant effect
1) Concept: Phenothiazine
a. as a drug DOES NOT function as an anticonvulsant.
b. it is present in several antihistamine and antipsychotic medications
c. is an antipsychotic that also has demonstrates antiemetic and sedation properties
d. known to have sedative effects like prochlorperazine and chlorpromazine, are used in treating
migraines and headaches in emergency rooms.
Which opioid analgesic can create a serious life threatening adverse drug reaction when given to
a patient on a monamine oxidase inhibitor (MAOI)?
A. Fentanyl
B. Meperidine
C. Morphine
D. Propoxyphene
E. Codeine B. Meperidine
1) Concept: Meperidine
a. when combined with a MAOI can cause life threatening effects
b. Among these effects are fever, too much sweating, nervous system excitability, and
respiratory depression, which can lead to unconsciousness
c. Meperidine is a drug that helps to control the amount of serotonin and dopamine in the blood.
Excessive amounts of these substances may cause hypertensive crisis.
c. Substances that increase serotonin, norepinephrine, or dopamine activity can result in severe
acute consequences, including serotonin syndrome, hypertensive crisis, and psychosis.
Which of the following drug class is the currently the first line treatment of depression?
A. Amphetamines
B. Monamineoxidease Inhibitors (MAOIs)
C. Phenothiazines
D. Selective Serotonin Reuptake Inhibitors (SSRIs) *
E. Tricyclic anti-depressants (TCAs) * D. Selective Serotonin Reuptake Inhibitors (SSRIs)
2) SSRI or Selective Serotonin Reuptake Inhibitors increase the serotonin levels extracellularly
by not allowing its reuptake on the presynaptic cleft.
3) Through the increased amount of serotonin level in the synaptic cleft, more serotonin are able
to bind with the postsynaptic end thereby prolonging its effect.
A. Carbamazipine
B. Hydrochlorothiazide
C. Phenytoin
D. Vanlafaxine
E. Valproic Acid E. Valproic Acid
1) Concept: Valproic acid is use to treat seizures and abruptly stopping its use will increase the
risk of bleeding, hemorrhage complicating hemostasis.
2) Thrombocytopenia
a. may develop in patients taking valproic acid because it inhibits the secondary phase of platelet
aggregation and causes abnormal coagulation.
3) Patients should be advised slowly and decrease their dose over 2 weeks and not to stop
valproic abruptly.
5) Presence of hemorrhage, bruising, hemostatic disorder are indications that valproic acid
should be withdrawn or the disease should be reduced.
Administration of which of the following drugs will result in LEAST psychomotor impairment
and central nervous depression?
A. Alprazolam
B. Buspirone
C. Chloral hydrate
D. Diazepam
E. Propofol B. Buspirone
1) Concept: Buspirone
a. a sedative hypnotic drugs use to alleviate anxiety that does NOT cause depression of the
central nervous system
b. does NOT impair cognitive and motor coordination as observed from other anxiolytic drugs
c. it also does NOT cause physical dependence and any form of withdrawal symptoms
d. is an anti anxiety drug that is used primarily in generalized anxiety disorder. However, this
drug is not known to be effective in controlling panic disorder.
The blood-brain barrier is most easily penetrated by which of the following barbiturates?
A. Barbital
B. Pentobarbital
C. Phenobarbital
D. Secobarbital
E. Thiopental E. Thiopental
1) Concept: Thiopental easily crosses the blood brain barrier because it is lipophilic.
2) Thiopental:
a. short acting drug that has a rapid onset of effect
b. it is a lipid soluble drug that is usually redistributed to muscles and fat as it moves away from
the central circulation
c. previously used for the general anesthesia induction phase but proposal is now used in its
place
d. known to induce medical comas and it was used as a drug for lethal injection along with other
medications
Why is phenytoin indicated over phenobarbital for grand mal seizures?
2) Phenobarbital
a. an effective anticonvulsant but has a longer half-life is stored within body fat in an accidental
overdose
b. main side effect is drowsiness and is associated with over dosage. It also has a tendency to
cause medullary depression that could endanger the patient's life.
All of the following drugs achieve skeletal muscle relaxant through depressing he polysynaptic
reflex arc except...
A. D-tubocurarine (Tubarine)
B. Diazepam (Valium)
C. Lorazapam (Ativan)
D. Meprobomate (Equanil) A. D-tubocurarine (Tubarine)
2) D-Tubocurarine
a. used as an agent in diagnosing myasthenia gravis
b. its use harbors many disadvantages including a ver slow onset of action and an unnecessary
prolonged drug duration of about one to two hours
The drug-receptor activity of naloxone is BEST CHARACTERIZED by which of the following
pairs?
1) Concept: Naloxone exhibits an extremely high affinity for mu-opioid receptors present in the
central nervous system and negative intrinsic activity.
2) Naloxone
a. mu-opioid receptor competitive antagonist that causes rapid blockage of mu-opioid receptors,
producing rapid onset of withdrawal symptoms
Which of the following is NOT an advantage of midazolam (Versed) over diazepam (Valium)?
2) Flumazenil
a. benzodiazepine antagonist drug that can be used to treat an overdose of midazolam, as well as
to reverse sedation.
Pain experience from tic douloureux (trigeminal neuralgia) is best managed with which of the
following pharmaceutical agents?
A. Carbamazepine
B. Hydrocortisone
C. Ibuprofen
D. Oxycodone
E. Acetylsalicylic acid A. Carbamazepine
1) Concept: Trigeminal neuralgia (tic doloreux) is most commonly treated through the
prescription of anticonvulsant drugs like carbamazepine.
2) Carbamazepine
a. proven to be effective in reducing the pain caused by tic dolorous
b. dosage administered is usually very low but will gradually increase until the dosage becomes
sufficient to completely control the pain without causing side effects.
c. same effective dose is continued for the next two weeks until the drug dose is slowly reduced
back to minimal dose while providing the same effect.
Which of the following pharmaceuticals is known to reverse the effects of benzodiazepines?
A. Aminophylline
B. Flumazenil
C. Midazolam
D. Naloxone
E. Physostigmine B. Flumazenil
2) Aminophylline
a. is a bronchodilator that is a nonselective adenosine receptor antagonist and phosphodiesterase
inhibitor capable of reversing ischemia-induced bradyasystole.
3) Midazolam
a. short-acting benzodiazepine
b. used to treat seizures, moderate to severe insomnia, and for inducing sedation and amnesia
before medical procedures
4) Naloxone
a. opioid inverse agonist used to counter the effects of opiate overdose specifically used to
counteract life-threatening depression of the central nervous system and respiratory system
5) Physiostigmine
a. parasympathomimetic alkaloid that acts as a reversible cholinesterase inhibitor
For oral sedation by a dentist, the most favored class of drugs are...
A. Antihistamines
B. Benzodiazepines
C. Muscle relaxants
D. Opioids
E. Barbiturates B. Benzodiazepines
1) Concept: Benzodiazepines are a class of drugs that can help alleviate anxiety in patients
during dental surgery.
2) Benzodiazepines
a. popular anti-anxiety drugs used in the dental surgical field due to their effectiveness in
calming an anxious patient as well as its ability to produce anterograde amnesia so that patients
does not remember any unpleasant feeling after the surgical procedure is completed.
b. effectiveness of these drugs can be chased since it has short acting, intermediate acting and
long acting type that may suit the length of dental procedure
The duration of action for diazepam is directly related to...
1) Concept: Diazepam
a. duration of action of diazepam is due to the long half life of its main active metabolite known
as desmethyldiazepam, which may last from 3 to 7 days.
b. fast acting agent with a long duration of action. It is lipid-soluble, binds to protein, and is
widely distributed throughout the body after administration.
c. has a long duration of action, this drug is available in low doses to prevent drug accumulation
and an unnecessarily prolonged effect
Why does Levodopa (L-dopa) therapy diminish in effectiveness over time in the treatment of
patients suffering from Parkinsons' disease?
A. Cell loss in the Substantia nigra portion of the brain is continuous and progressive over time
B. Dopadecarboxylase activity increases with age.
C. Dopamine receptors are down-regulated over time with the presence of excess dopamine from
L-dopa
D. Patients develop a tolerance to L-dopa over time due to induction of metabolic enzymes in the
liver A. Cell loss in the Substantia nigra portion of the brain is continuous and progressive
over time
1) Concept: Parkinson's disease signs increase over time with Levodopa use because of an
increase in severity of the disease, not a decrease in effectiveness of the drug.
2) Levodopa
a. delayed the occurrence of the symptoms of Parinson's disease
b. provides patients with Parkinson's disease a longer moment of time to live a normal life
c. only has a certain degree in diminishing Parkinson's disease symptoms but it cannot cure the
disease nor stop its progression.
The muscle relaxation experienced by drugs under diazepam has a similar mechanism of action
to which other drug?
A. Gallimine
B. Ketamine
C. Meprobamate
D. Succinylcholine C. Meprobamate
1) Concept: Meprobamate and diazepam are both anxiolytic and hypnotic agents.
2) Meprobamate
a. barbiturate subgroup and is a non-selective central nervous system (CNS) depressant that can
induce surgical anesthesia
3) Diazepam
a. benzodiazepine and is a selective neuronal depressant
b. have replaced barbiturates due to their non-selective effect on CNS and high potential for
addiction
A. Hyperlacrimation
B. Hypersalivation
C. Rash *
D. Skeletal muscle fasciculation *
E. Diarrhea C. Rash
1) Concept: Organophosphate poisoning causes several types of signs and symptoms which
occurred due to the excessive amount of acetylcholine along the different receptors and nerve
fibers within the body.
2) Excessive amounts of acetylcholine (ACh) is brought about by the blockage of
acetylcholinesterase.
3) The nicotinic expression becomes overstimulated due to the increased ACh along the motor
nerves causing muscle cramps, fatigue, fasciculation, muscle weakness and paralysis.
A. Amphetamine salts
B. Atropine
C. Carbemazipine *
D. Dopamine *
E. Physostigmine E. Physostigmine
2) Tricyclic anti-depressants (TCA) drugs enhance the anticholinergic activity of the body.
3) Physostigmine is also used to treat atropine overdose, myasthenia gravis, and glaucoma.
Coadministration of which of the following agents is necessary to block the cardiovascular
effects of accidental administration of a sympathomimetic drug?
3) Propranolol (a beta blocker) and prazosin (alpha blocker) when administered together create
vasodilation and blocks the cardiovascular actions of the sympathomimetic drug.
Which of the following drug classes contains amphetamines, ephedrine, and tyramine?
A. Direct-acting parasympathomimetics *
B. Indirect sympathomimetics *
C. Irreversible anticholinesterases
D. Reversible anticholinesterases
E. Alpha-adrenergic blocking agents B. Indirect sympathomimetics
2) Indirect acting sympathomimetic drugs like the MAOIs, reuptake inhibitors, and released
stimulants can increase the amount of endogenous catecholamines in the body.
3) These drugs have been used to treat low blood pressure, cardiac arrest, and delaying
premature labor.
Atropine is able to
2) Atropine
a. competitive inhibitor of muscarinic receptors M1-M5.
b. causes
3) Myasthenia Gravis
a. autoimmune neuromuscular disease that leads to fluctuating muscle weakness and fatigability.
The symptoms are caused by circulating antibodies that block acetylcholine receptors at the
postsynaptic neuromuscular junction which inhibits of the excitatory effects of the
neurotransmitter acetylcholine on nicotinic receptors throughout neuromuscular junction.
An overdose of cholinergic agents can create each of the following condition EXCEPT one.
Which condition is the EXCEPTION?
A. Bradycardia
B. Hypersalivation
C. Mydriasis *
D. Polydipsia
E. Diaphoresis C. Mydriasis
2) Mydriasis is a sympathetic reaction of the pupil, causing it to dilate and allow more light to
pass through the eye.
4) Cholinergic effect can also cause a slow heart beat or low heart beat rate also known as
bradycardia.
DFP and organophosphate pesticide function through
1) Concept: DFP and organophosphate allow Cholinergic reactions to occur so must inhibit
cholinesterase
2) Cholinesterases are substances that allow for the breakdown of acetylcholine when in the
body, stopping the acetylcholine from sending electrical impulses and therefore regulates
movement of the body.
4) This causes an uncontrollable and continuous firing of electrical impulses that results to
uncontrollable muscle twitching. Severe cases cold lead to inability to breathe due to muscle
paralysis and even death.
Sweat glands are innervated in which of the following innervation types?
A. Parasympathetic - adrenergic
B. Parasympathetic - cholinergic
C. Sympathetic - adrenergic
D. Sympathetic - cholinergic
E. Adrenergic - cholinergic D. Sympathetic - cholinergic
1) Sweat glands are classified as either eccrine and apocrine glands.
2) Eccrine sweat glands are coiled and unbranched glands that serve in thermoregulation and
function to cool down the body through the evaporation of sweat. They are innervated by the
cholinergic nerve fibers.
3) Apocrine glands secrete oily compounds that act as pheromones and also sweat when they are
stimulated by adrenaline.
Which of the following physiologic effects can occur after administration of a cholinomimetic
drug?
2) Stimulation of nicotinic and/or muscarinic receptors can initiate and increase salivation
4) Cholinomimetic drugs are similar in action to acetylcholine an can cause stimulation of the
nicotinic acid and muscarinic receptors.
Succinylchline inhibits neuromuscular transmission through which of the following means?
2) Phase I
a. Succinylcholine acts like acetylcholine because it binds to the ACh receptor and causes
muscular twitches or contractions during Phase I.
3) Phase II
a. In Phase II, due to the repetitive excitation and depolarization, the motor end plates become
resistant to acetylcholine activation
4) The resistance of motor end plates from acetylcholine activation prevents neuromuscular
transmission and thus, prevents muscle contraction.
Which of the following side effects might a patient experience if they are prescribed atropine to
reduce their salivary flow?
A. Bradycardia
B. Diarrhea
C. Gastrointestinal upset
D. Sedation
E. Blurred vision E. Blurred vision
2) Atropine
a. is an anticholinergic agent used to reduce salivary flow
b. Common side effects:
1) blurred vision
2) photophobia
3) tachycardia
4) anhidrosis = inability to sweat normally
The recommended pharcologic treatment for xerostomia is...
A. 1 mg Malathion
B. 10mg Dilantin
C. 5 mg Levonordefrin
D. 5 mg Pilocarpine
E. 1 mg Epinephrine D. 5 mg Pilocarpine
1) Concept: Pilocarpine
a. direct acting cholinergic agonist = SLUD
b. parasympathomimetic alkaloid that is considered a non-selective muscarinic receptor agonist
c. stimulates the secretion of large amounts of saliva and sweat through muscarinic receptor
stimulation
d. used in the treatment of chronic open-angle glaucoma
1) Concept: Nicotinic antagonist are a type of anticholinergic agent that inhibit the action of
acetylcholine (ACh) at nicotinic ACh receptors and are used for peripheral muscle paralysis
during surgery.
2) Quarternary ammonium compounds can result in a range of health effects like mild skin and
respiratory irritation up to severe caustic burns on skin and gastrointestinal lining, hypotension
and death.
3) They are the chemical group thought to be responsible for anaphylactic reactions to occur with
use of neuromuscular blocking drugs during the use of general anesthesia in surgery.
A. Catecholamines
B. Epinephrine
C. Norepinephrine
D. Oxytocin
E. Belladonna alkeloids E. Belladonna alkeloids
1) Belladonna Alkaloids
a. like atropine are derived from the Atropa Belladonna or "deadly nightshade" plant and
function as anticholinergic drugs.
b. are contraindicated to patients predisposed to narrow-angle glaucoma because they:
3) Atropine causea
a. Pupil dilation by paralysis of the ciliary muscle, preventing lens accommodation
b. Prevents action of acetylcholine on muscarinig receptors M1-M5, causing an increase in
sinoatrial (SA) node output
2) Glauacoma
a. pathology where an increase in fluid pressure in the aqueous humor of the eye causes pain
could result in blindness if not treated.
Which of the following doses of epinephrine is considered the maximum safe dose that could be
administered to a patient with a history of significant cardiovascular impairment?
A. 1cc, 1:100,000
B. 1cc, 1:50,000
C. 2cc, 1:100,000
D. 2cc. 1:50,000
E. 5cc, 1:1000 D. 2cc. 1:50,000
3) The dosage of epinephrine should not exceed the limit of 2cc or 2mL and the concentration
used should be 1:50,000.
Cyclopegia, or paralysis of the ciliary muscle of the eye can be caused by...
A. Acetylcholine
B. Amphetamine
C. Ephedrine
D. Homatropine bromide
E. Pilocarpine D. Homatropine bromide
2) Diaphragm and intercostal muscles expel air out of the lungs during expiration
3) The other effect of an anti cholinesterase overdose include
a. Bradycardia
b. Death due to bronchoconstriction
c. GI motility and secretion problems
d. Miosis
A. DFP (Disoofluorophate)
B. Neostigmine (Prostigmine)
C. Physostigmine (Antilirium)
D. Pilocarpine (Pilocar) A. DFP (Disoofluorophate)
3) DPF became useful in ophthalmology for its ability to induce miosis (pupillary constriction)
for the treating of chronic glaucoma and in neurological experiments focusing on neuropathy.
Ephedrine, tyramine, and amphetamine are classified as which of the following pharmacological
classes?
2) Sympathomimetic drugs that act indirectly in the body and have the capability of increasing
catecholamine production endogenously
A. Anti-cholinergic activity
B. Bradycardia
C. Vagal stimulation
D. Alpha adrenergic inhibition D. Alpha adrenergic inhibition
1) Concept: Chlorpromazine effects various types of receptors along the central nervous system,
causing anti-dopaminergic, anti-cholinergic, anti-histaminic and some traces of anti-adrenergic
effect.
2) The alpha adrenergic inhibition of Chorpromazine may cause the lowering of the blood
pressure, which is later on accompanied by dizziness.
3) Chlorpromazine inhibits the alpha1 and alpha2 adrenergic receptors which results to
symptoms including reflex tachycardia, sedation, vertigo, hyper salivation, and a possibility of
causing sexual dysfunction.
Which statement is true about anti cholinesterase?
1) Concepts: Organophosphates are included among the most toxic substances that can enter the
body easily.
2) Organophosphates
a. active substances in some pesticides that could enter a body by ingestion, skin absorption and
mostly through inhalation
b. capable of affecting cholinesterase activate within the blood
3) Cholinesterases
a. are substances that cause the breakdown of acetylcholine when in the body, stopping the
acetylcholine from sending electrical impulses and therefore regulates movement of the body
b. in the presence of cholinesterase inhibitor such as DPF and organophosphate, acetylcholine is
not broken down resulting to acetylcholine build up
c. this causes an uncontrolled and continuous firing of electrical impulses that results to
uncontrollable muscle twitching. Severe cases could lead to inability to breathe due to muscle
paralysis and even death.
Which statement is CORRECT concerning directly-acting cholinomimetics?
A. All of these
B. Bethanechol is predominantly selective for gastrointestinal and urinary bladder smooth
muscle
C. Methacholine has more prominent action on the cardiovascular system than carbachol
D. Bethanechol and Carbachol almost completely resist the action of ACHE A. All of these
3) Drugs like bethanechol acts in the management of urinary retention and pilocarpine is use in
treating glaucoma.
A. Antagonist
B. Congener
C. Isomer
D. Vehicle
E. Agonist B. Congener
1) Concept: Congeners are substances that are closely related in composition, function, or origin
3) Methacholine and acetylcholine are both cholinergic agonists. However, the duration of action
of methacholine is longer than that of acetylcholine.
The most potent bronchodilator is which of the following sympathomimetics?
A. Isoproterenol
B. Methoxamine
C. Norepinephrine
D. Phenylephrine
E. Amphetamine A. Isoproterenol
1) Concept: Isoproterenol
a. a sympathomimetic that is similar to epinephrine in its action of cardiac excitatory but is
different from epinephrine in its property of vasodilation.
b. it is a potent bronchodilator when used in sulfate and hydrochloride forms
2) Methoxamine
a. a sympathomimetic used for the management of hypotension due to its vasopresive activity
3) Norepinephrine
a. a catecholamine that has vasopressive properties and is used to raise blood pressure to normal
levels in causes of acute hypotension
4) Phenylephrine
a. an adrenergic drug with strong vasoconstrictive properties
b. usually used as a nasal decongestant.
5) Amphetamines
a. psychostimulant drugs that stimulate the CNS. Their overuse can lead to addiction
Which of the following describes how neostigmine differs from physostigmine?
1) Concept: Neostigmine
a. is a synthetic drug that is poorly absorbed when taking orally and is useful for managing
myasthenia gravis.
b. can also directly affect neuromuscular junctions
2) Physostigmine
a. unlike neostigmine is a naturally occurring lipid soluble drug hat is absorbed very when taking
orally
Physostigmine
a. Lipid Soluble
b. Miotic
c. Natural
d. Orally absorbed well
e. Physostigmine
A. Cholinergic
B. Adrenergic blocking
C. Anticholinergic
D. Canabinoids
E. Adrenergic C. Anticholinergic
2) Atropine causes
a. pupil dilation by paralysis of the ciliary muscle, preventing lens accommodation
b. prevents action of acetylcholine on muscarinic receptors M1-M5, causing an increase in
sinoatrial (SA) node output
3) Glaucoma
a. pathology where an increased fluid pressure in the aqueous humor of he eye causes pain could
result in blindness if not treated
Cardiovascular Cardiovascular Answers
Cardiac glycosides are known to decrease the concentration of which ion in cardiac muscle?
A. Chloride (Cl-)
B. Potassium (K+)
C. Sodium (Na+)
D. Calcium (Ca+2) B. Potassium (K+)
2) Cardiac Glycosides
a. inhibit Na+/K+ ATPase, the transition state stabilizes and the sodium ions are not extruded
thereby increasing intracellular sodium concentration (assume Na+ is inside and K+ is outside)
b. By inhibiting the ion transportation, the concentration of potassium in the cell is decreased.
c. inhibit Na+/K+ ATPase causes an increase in the heart's contraction and consequently, cardiac
output.
Heparin functions by preventing the conversion of...
A. Factor IX to Factor X
B. PTA to PTC
C. Prothrombin to thrombin
D. Fibrinogen to fibrin D. Fibrinogen to fibrin
d. Heparin activates and potentiates the activity of antithrombin, which inhibits the conversion of
fibrinogen into fibrin by thrombin
Digitalis should be prescribed to patients suffering from atrial fibrillation and already on
Quinidine to prevent...
2) Digitalis regulates the heart beat of patients with atrial fibrillation by slowing down the
ventricular contraction rate.
3) Digitalis is often prescribed for those patients suffering from congestive heart failure.
Administration of amyl nitrite for a prolonged period of time may result in...
A. Aplastic anemia
B. Thalassemia
C. Methemoglobinemia
D. Thrombocytopenia C. Methemoglobinemia
2) Hemoglobin
a. Hemoglobin with the presence of a ferric heme group is called methemoglobin, which cannot
transport oxygen.
b. The blood has normally 1% methemoglobin
c. causes methemoglobinemia include exposure to benzocaine, benzene, and nitrites
3) Oxyhemoglobin
a. reduced form of iron, ferrous found in the heme group combines with oxygen to produce
oxyhemoglobin
b. oxyhemoglobin distributes oxygen to the different tissues in the body and is changed back to
hemoglobin after delivering the oxygen
Digitalis functions primarily on cardiac muscle by increasing which of the following?
A. Rate of conduction
B. Refractory period of the muscle of the atrium
C. Refractory period of the muscle of the ventricles
D. Force of contraction D. Force of contraction
1) Concept: Digitalis is a drug that is considered a cardiac glycoside. It increases the contractile
force of cardiac muscle.
A patient receiving Warfarin presents for an elective tooth extraction with a prolonged
prothrombin time (PT). Which of the following methods of reducing the PT to a level acceptable
for surgery is indicated?
1) Concept: If a patient is on Warfarin and wants to go for tooth extraction, he will be asked by
the dentist to stop taking Warfarin 2 days prior the day of extraction.
2) The reason for this instruction is that once the tooth is pulled out, it will be difficult to bring
the bleeding under control due to the thinning of the blood by Warfarin.
3) Prothrombin time is the time required by your blood to form a clot and is measured in
seconds.
Which of the following describes the mechanism through which propranolol functions as an
antianginal?
1) Concept: Propranolol is the first non-selective beta blocker developed and is used to treat
hypertension, anxiety, and panic attacks
2) Propranolol
a. blocks the action of epinephrine and norepinephrine on the beta-1 and beta-2 adrenergic
receptors and exhibits little intrinsic sympathomimetic activity.
3) Due to its high penetration across the blood brain barrier, lipophilic beta blockers such as
propranolol and metoprolol are more likely to cause sleep disturbances such as insomnia, vivid
dreams, and nightmares.
Propranolol functions as an antianginal through which of the following mechanisms?
1) Concept: Propranolol is the first non-selective beta blocker developed and is used to treat
hypertension, anxiety, and panic attacks
2) Propranolol
a. blocks the action of epinephrine and norepinephrine on the beta-1 and beta-2 adrenergic
receptors and exhibits little intrinsic sympathomimetic activity.
3) Due to its high penetration across the blood brain barrier, lipophilic beta blockers such as
propranolol and metoprolol are more likely to cause sleep disturbances such as insomnia, vivid
dreams, and nightmares.
Which of the following drugs is indicated for use in patients suffering from congestive heart
failure?
A. Etotolac
B. Nitroglycerine
C. Procainamide
D. Digitalis D. Digitalis
1) Concept: Digitalis drugs are used to treat patients with congestive heart failure and cardiac
dysrhythmias
2) Digitalis
a. make the cardiac muscle to contract stronger and to pump more efficiently improving blood
circulation and reducing edema
A. Epinephrine
B. Hydrochlorothiazide Diuretic
C. Vasodilators
D. Atropine D. Atropine
1) Atropine
a. is considered to be the first line drug to be used to treat bradycardia
b. increases the heart rate by blocking the action of vagus nerve and increasing the firing of SA
node.
c. intravenous injection of atropine is only a temporary solution for bradycardia.
d. Installation of a pacemaker is a better and more effective measure.
1) Concept: Atenolol is a selective beta-1 receptor antagonist used to treat low grade essential
hypertension.
b. currently recommended only in special circumstances as complementary medication in
hypertension
3) Valsartan
a. is an angiontensin II receptor antagonist (ARB or angiotensin receptor blocker)
4) Verapamil
a. calcium channel blocker
5) Hydralazine
a. direct-acting smooth muscle relaxant
b. used to treat hypertension by relaxing vascular smooth muscle and dilating arteries and
arterioles decreasing peripheral resistance and lowering blood pressure and decreasing after load
6) Dilantin
a. antiepileptic drug
Which of the following does low-dose aspirin therapy preferentially inhibit to prevent the
formation of thromboemboli?
1) Concept: Aspirin causes the irreversible inactivation of the enzyme cyclogenase (COX) which
is responsible for the production of prostaglandin and thromboxane.
2) Thromboxane
a. a vasoconstrictor that is responsible for platelet aggregation and is responsible for
thromboemboli
b. Thromboxane synthetase is the enzyme that mediates the reaction of formation of
thromboxane
Which of the following is the most dangerous effect of Digoxin overdose?
A. Atrial fibrillation
B. Bradycardia
C. Tachycardia
D. Ventricular fibrillation
E. Renal toxicity/failure C. Thromboxane synthetase of platelets
2) A very narrow window between its therapeutic effect and toxic effect (Narrow therapeutic
Index) makes toxicity fairly common.
3) Toxicity reveals various electrolytes abnormalities and imbalances affect the normal rhythm
of the heart beat.
A. Hydrochlorothiazide (HCTZ)
B. Metoprolol
C. Valsartan
D. Hydralazine D. Hydralazine
1) Concept: Hydralazine acts to directly relax the vascular smooth muscles in the arteries and
arterioles causing vasodilation, which decreases blood pressure.
2) Hydralazine
a. not a primary drug in the management of hypertension since it also stimulates the baroreceptor
reflex, increasing the patient's heart rate and cardiac output
b. is contraindicated for patients with coronary artery disease because it could trigger angina
pectoris or possibly a myocardial infarction
Which of the following tests is the MOST VALUABLE for evaluating the surgical risk of a
patient on Warfarin that needs a tooth extracted?
A. Clotting time
B. Complete blood cell count with differential
C. Prothrombin time
D. Sedimentation rate
E. Bleeding time C. Prothrombin time
1) Concept: Prothrombin time (PT) is a good diagnostic tool to be used for a patient on Warfarin
before tooth extraction.
a. Prothrombin time (PT) measures the clotting tendency of blood. The normal range is 12-13
seconds.
2) International Normalized Ratio (INR) is also used in conjunction with PT. It should come with
a range of 0.8-1.2
3) Warfarin
a. is an anticoagulant and it prolongs PT and the INR comes in the range of 2-3
Which of the following physiologic changes does NOT occur due to amyl nitrite administration?
A. Cl-
B. K+
C. Mg+2
D. Na+1
E. Ca+2 B. K+
2) Potassium (K) and hydrochlorothiazide are used in combination in order to reduce the
patient's blood pressure and prevent the occurrence of hypokalemia.
3) Potassium regulates intracellular osmoregulation and helps in reducing unneeded water and
salt inside the body.
Antihypertensive drugs often cause postural hypertension because they interfere with...
3) Baroreflex and autonomic pathways normally ensure that blood pressure is maintained despite
various stimuli including postural change.
Which of the following effects are produced by selective beta-1 adrenergic agonists?
A. Gluconeogenesis
B. Glycogenolysis
C. Increased cardiac output
D. Relaxation of bronchial smooth muscle
E. Decreased peripheral resistance C. Increased cardiac output
1) Concept: B1 adrenergic agonists cause an increase in heart rate and contractile force
3) The heart has both B1 and B2 adrenergic receptors, but B1 adrenergic receptors are the
predominant receptor present.
Local Anesthetics Local Anesthetic Answers
Cross-allergy is most likely to happen with which anesthetic agents?
1) Concept: IgE-mediated reactions with amide group local anesthetics are considered extremely
rare, but have been documented with lidocaine and mepivacaine.
A. 108 mg
B. 216 mg
C. 540 mg
D. 54 mg B. 216 mg
1) Concept: Multiplying the percentage of articaine against the total volume of anesthetic
solution in milligrams will determine the amount of articaine in the anesthetic solution.
2) Articaine
a. well known dental anesthetic drug that contains an additional ester group that can be
metabolized with the esterase within the blood and tissues of the body
b. less toxicating than other anesthetic drugs because it is quickly hydrolyzed in the blood
Which of the following describes how salivary flow is decreased by the use of local anesthetics
during operative procedures?
1) Concept: Before an operative procedure, patients experience anxiety, causing them to sweat
and increase salivary flow. As the patient feels more at ease, their emotion stabilizes and salivary
rate decreases.
3) As the anesthesia numbs the area where treatments performed, pain and anxiety is reduced,
which also reduces perception of touch and sensation which also causes the decrease in salivary
flow later.
In inflamed tissues, local anesthetics are known to...
1) Concept: Local anesthetics are less effective in inflamed tissues because they have a decreased
pH
2) When the Henderson-Hasselbach equation is applied, the decreased pH makes the local
anesthetic molecule more likely to be protonated. Protonation of the anesthetic molecule
prevents the molecule from passing through the membrane of the nerve cell where it can block
sodium influx to prevent nerve firing.
Which of the following properties of local anesthetics increase as hydrophobicity increase?
A. Half-life
B. Neurotoxicity
C. Potency
D. Allerginicity C. Potency
1) Concept: Increase in hydrophobicity of a local anesthetic increases the potency and duration
of the anesthetic drug.
2) Allergic reactions have been mainly seen during the administration of ester group of local
anesthetics and are due to the release of PABA (para amino benzoic acid) or PABA related
products.
3) PABA is a strong antigen and may sensitize the lymphocytes and induce the production of
antibodies
Which of the following local anesthetics possess intrinsic vasoconstrictive action?
A. Bupivacaine
B. Cocaine
C. Lidocaine
D. Prilocaine
E. Articaine B. Cocaine
1) Concept: Cocaine is an ester and is the only local anesthetic that is an intrinsic
vasoconstrictor.
a. Cocaine is used in the form of sprays during ENT surgeries to keep the surgical field bloodless
2) Amides
a. Articaine
b. Bupivacaine
c. Lidocaine
d. Prilocaine
Vasoconstrictors are usually incorporated into local anesthetics primarily for which of the
following reasons?
1) Concept: Vasoconstrictors
a. help to lengthen the duration of effect of anesthesia by decreasing absorption of the anesthetic
into the bloodstream
b. vasoconstrictors make the blood vessel diameter smaller, causing the slower removal of the
anesthesia in the tissues
c. because anesthesia duration is longer with vasoconstrictors, the amount of anesthetic necessary
is decreased.
Chemotherapy Chemotherapy ANswers
Which of the following tetracycline class drugs should only be taken once daily due to its long
half-life?
A. Chlortetracycline
B. Demethylchlortetracycline
C. Doxycycline
D. Oxytetracycline C. Doxycycline
1) Concept: Doxycycline
a. has the longest half life of tetracycline group and is used prophylactically and therapeutically
b. used to treat malaria, as well as to treat Lyme disease, Rocky Mounted spotted fever, and acne.
c. Taking doxycycline with dairy antacids, calcium supplements, iron products, and laxative
containing magnesium may decrease the effectiveness of the drug.
Which of the following agents is prescribed as an anti-Parkinson's drug?
A. Amantadine
B. Amphotericin B
C. Fluconazole
D. NovobiocinA. Amantadine
1) Concept: Amantadine
a. is a weak antagonist of the NMDE type glutamate receptor which increases dopamine release
and blocks dopamine reuptake.
b. has been used as an antiviral agent against Influenza A until 2009.
Prolonged tetracycline therapy is associated with each of the following adverse effects EXCEPT
ONE. Which of the following side effects is the EXCEPTION?
2) Tetracyclines
a. is incorporated into the tooth structure during the mineralization of the tooth because it forms a
chelate with calcium
A. Ethambutol and isoniazid, because both inhibit bacterial folic acid synthesis
B. Griseofulvin and streptomycin because both prevent protein production
C. No answers are correct
D. Streptomycin and chloramphenical because both are hydrophobic
E. Isoniazid (INH) and rifampin, because they function by different mechanisms E. Isoniazid
(INH) and rifampin, because they function by different mechanisms
1) Concept: Isoniazid inhibits the synthesis of my colic acid a component of the mycobacterial
cell wall
2) Rifampin
a. inhibits bacterial DNA-dependent RNA polymerase, stopping bacterial RNA production
4) Mnemonic
Tuberculosis Treatments: "If you forget your TB drugs, you'll die and might need a PRIEST"
P: Pyrazinamide
R: Rifampin
I: Isoniazid (INH)
E: Ethambutol
ST: Streptomycin
Which anti fungal drug is prescribed for oral administration to treat vaginal candidiasis
A. Fluconazole (Diflucan)
B. Griseofulvin (Grifulvin)
C. Miconazole (Monistat)
D. Nystatin (Mycostatin)
E. Clotrimazole Troche (Mycelex) A. Fluconazole (Diflucan)
1) Concept: Fluconazole
a. is an oral triazole antifungal agnet prescribed to treat and prevent superficial and systemic
fungal infections by inhibiting the fungal cytochrome P450 enzyme.
b. Inhibition of P450 prevents the conversion of lanosterol to ergosterol, and essential component
of the fungal cytoplasmic membrane.
3) Griseofulvin
a. primarily used to treat hair and nail fungal infections
The oral antibiotic most likely to cause failure of oral contraceptive is...
A. Cephalosporins
B. Macrolides
C. Penicillins
D. Tetracyclines
E. Rifampin E. Rifampin
1) Concept: Rifampin
a. an antibiotic that affects the metabolism of oral contraceptive drugs within the body
b. induces the cytochrome P-450 enzyme, so drugs that use this metabolic pathway undergo
accelerated elimination
c. oral contraceptive failure during rifampin treatment can be prevented by adjusting the dosage
of oral contraceptive drugs.
d. Rifampin problems can be prevented by:
1) Using drugs that are not metabolized by P-450
2) Choose non-hormonal birth control methods
The therapeutic function of nalidixic acid is best characterized as an...
A. Antifungal agent
B. Antiseptic for the urinary tract
C. Antituberculous agent
D. Antityphoid agent B. Antiseptic for the urinary tract
A. Chloramphenicol
B. Penicillin
C. Streptomycin
D. Sulfonamide
E. Cephalsporin C. Streptomycin
1) Concept: Streptomycin
a. is a bacteriocidal aminoglycoside IV/IM antibiotic
b. has been reported to possess neuromuscular blocking properties. Extremely high doses of
streptomycin have allegedly resulted in lethal neuromuscular blockage of the phrenic nerve
c. is typically prescribed for Tuberculosis, infective endocarditis, and plague.
Which antibiotic is bactericidal and is prescribed specifically to treat Pseudomonas infections?
A. Carbenicillin
B. Dicloxacillin
C. Penicillin Vk
D. Tetracycline
E. Doxycycline A. Carbenicillin
1) Concept: Carbenicillin
a. is a bacteriolytic antibiotic belonging to the carboxypenicillin subgroup of the penicillins
b. has Gram (-) coverage which includes Pseudomonas aeruginosa but limited to Gram (+)
coverage
c. Carboxypenicillins are susceptible to degradation by beta-lactamase enzymes
Which of the following agents is associated with auditory nerve deafness?
A. Chloramphenicol
B. Gentamycin
C. Lidocaine
D. Tramodol
E. Amphotericin B B. Gentamycin
1) Concept: Gentamycin
a. powerful antibiotic but has to be administered with extreme caution due to its adverse effects
on its auditory nerve
b. is an aminoglycoside used in treatment of several infections
c. it may cause ototoxicity and renal dysfunction
d. Symptoms of eighth cranial nerve damage are tinnitus, ataxia, vertigo and dizziness.
Which of the following oral medications is indicated to treat a staphylococcal infection that is
known to produce penicillinase?
A. Moxalactam
B. Oxacillin
C. Penicillin G
D. Streptomycin
E. Penicillin VB. Oxacillin
A. Dicloxacillin
B. Methicillin
C. Penicillin Vk
D. Amoxicillin B. Methicillin
1) Concept: Methicillin
a. narrow-spectrum parenteral beta-lactam antibiotic of the penicillin class agent used to treat
infections caused by bacteria beta-lactamase-producing Gram (+) organisms
b. has been replaced by flucloxacillin and dicloxacillin due to its high frequency of adverse
effects.
c. Methicillin-resistant Staphylococcus aureus (MRSA) is still use to describe Staphylococcus
aureus strains resistant to all penicillins.
In the case of a diabetic patient with an apical abscess requiring an extraction where penicillin
Vk is indicated, which of the following antibiotics should be prescribed for a patient if he/she is
allergic to penicillin?
A. Clindamycin
B. Doxycycline
C. Erythromycin
D. Fluroquinolones
E. Cephalosporin A. Clindamycin
1) Concept: Clindamycin
a. lincomycin antibiotic that can be used if patient is allergic to penicillin and is very effective in
fighting gram positive bacteria including Staphylococcus auerus which is responsible for
pus/abscess formation.
2) Erythromycin
a. a macrolide antibiotic with a similar mechanism of action to penicillin
b. typically prescribed when a penicillin allergy is suspected.
3) Cephalosporins
a. are similar in effect and chemical structure as penicillin, so this drug is not prescribed for
patients with a penicillin allergy
A. Candida albicans
B. Herpes simplex
C. Histoplasma capsulatum
D. Staphylococcus aureus
E. Streptococcus viridans
F. Aggregatibacter Actionmycetemcomitans A. Candida albicans
1) Concept: Radiotherapy is one of the treatment modalities used in the treatment of oral cancer.
2) Radiotherapy
a. may create an imbalance in the oral microflora and a marked decrease in the production of
saliva and alteration of the oral lining
b. all of these factors contribute to the development of candidiasis, an opportunistic fungal
infection caused by Candida albicans.
Which of the following agents are prescribed to treat HIV patients?
A. Amantadine (Symmetrel)
B. Ribavarin (Virazole)
C. Zidovudine (Rerovir)
D. Isoniazid (Nydrazid)
E. Acyclovir (Zovirax) C. Zidovudine (Rerovir)
1) Concept: Zidovudine (AZT) is a nucleoside analog reverse-transcriptase inhibitor (NRTI)
antiretroviral drug used for the treatment of HIV/AIDS.
2) AZT
a. is the first U.S. government-approved treatment for HIV therapy and can also be used to
prevent HIV transmission, such as from mother to child during the period of birth or after a
needle stick.
b. if used by itself in HIV-infected patients, AZT safely slows HIV replication, but generally
does not stop it entirely.
3) Acyclovir
a. is a guanoside analogue that is used in the treatment of herpes simplex infections
4) Amantadine
a. is an anti-Parkinson's drug that is no longer recommended for use as an antiviral agent against
influenza
5) Isoniazid
a. is an antibiotic used to treat M. tuberculosis infections
Which of the following pharmaceuticals is most closely associated with dermal photosensitivity?
A. Cephalexin
B. Demeclocycline
C. Erythromycin
D. Nystatin
E. Penicillin Vk B. Demeclocycline
1) Concept: Demeclocycline
a. is a tetracycline antibiotic used in the treatment of Lyme disease, acne, and bronchitis
b. all members of this drug class may induce photosensitivity, interfere with bone development,
and discolor teeth
c. is the only tetracycline known to cause nephrogenic diabetes insipid us
d. acts by binding to the 30S and 50S ribosomal subunits, impairing protein synthesis by
bacteria.
Prolonged use (14+ days) of clindamycin (cleocin) is discouraged because...
1) Concept: Clindamycin
a. is a lincoamide antibiotic used to treat anaerobic bacterial infections and its use is associated
with pseudomembranous colitis.
b. is prescribed to treat anaerobic bacterial infections and some protozoal disease, such as
malaria and is also a common topical treatment for acne.
c. the potency for oral clindamycin leads to widespread loss of normal gut flora, allowing
Clostridium difficult to take over the gut, causing pseudomembranous colitis
d. may prolong the effects of neuromuscular-blocking drugs, such as succinylcholine
Which of the following antibiotics is considered a "3rd generation" cephalosporin?
A. Cephalexin
B. Cephamandole
C. Clindamycin
D. Moxalactam
E. Amikacin D. Moxalactam
1) Concept: Moxalactam is a 3rd generation cephalosporin that has been associated with
prolonged bleeding time, and several cases of coagulopathy
b. Moxalactam is no longer marketed in the United States
c. Other 3rd generation cephalosporins include
1) Cefcapene
2) Cefdaloxime
3) Cefdinir
4) Cefixime
1st - generation rich girls are Zoli, Roxi and Lexi are irreplaceable.
Cefazolin, Cephalexin, CefadRoxil for Total joint replacement.
2nd - generation Ana is a afraid of her Fox Fur
Cefuroxime, Cefoxitin good for anaerobes.
3rd - generation Fix the T in three
CeFixime, CefTriaxone, CefoTaxime
4th - generation is Prime for Pseudomonas
CefePime used for Pseudomas and gram +
Which of the following drugs is most potent against a Mycobacterium tuberculosis infection?
A. Isoniazid
B. Methacillin
C. Penicillin Vk
D. Vancomycin A. Isoniazid
1) Concept: Isoniazid
a. is considered one of the most potent and is the most common antibiotic prescribed to treat
Mycobacterium tuberculosis infections.
b. very effective against actively multiplying bacteria
c. proscribed alone or co-administered with other antibiotics
d. Isoniazid treatment takes 6-12 months to completely eradicate tuberculosis
e. Isoniazid is usually administered orally or IM (intramuscular)
Tuberculosis Treatments: "If you forget your TB drugs, you'll die and might need a PRIEST"
P: Pyrazinamide
R: Rifampin
I: Isoniazid (INH)
E: Ethambutol
ST: Streptomycin
The relative insolubility in water of which drug may lead to an increased incidence in
renalithiasis (kidney stones)?
A. Clindamycin
B. Erythromycin
C. Sulfamethoxazole (Bactrim)
D. Tetracycline metabolites
E. Acetaminophen C. Sulfamethoxazole (Bactrim)
2) Because of the risk of kidney stones, it is usually prescribed with trimethoprim, creating a
synergistic combination that allows less Bactrim to be given, thereby decreasing kidney stone
risk.
4) Sulfa drugs are structural analogs and competitive antagonists of para-aminobenzoic acid
(PABA), which is used in the bacterial synthesis of folic acid. Interfering with folic acid
synthesis prevents bacterial DNA replication.
Sulfa Drugs
A. Antifungal agent
B. Antiseptic for the urinary tract
C. Antituberculous agent
D. Antityphoid agent
E. Antiviral agent C. Antituberculous agent
1) Concept: Isoniazid is the first line medication in the prevention and treatment of tuberculosis
b. is a prodrug that must be activated by a bacterial catalase-peroxidase enzymes
c. inhibits the synthesis of mycolic acid a component of the mycobacterial cell wall
Tuberculosis Treatments: "If you forget your TB drugs, you'll die and might need a PRIEST"
P: Pyrazinamide
R: Rifampin
I: Isoniazid (INH)
E: Ethambutol
ST: Streptomycin
Which of the following is true therapeutically when comparing penicillin G to penicillin V?
Penicillin V has a...
1) Concept: Antibiotics are substances derived from bacteria, fungi, or other organisms that have
the ability to disrupt or destroy the development and growth of other microorganisms.
2) Antibiotics
a. are procured by means of biosynthesis, wherein a living organism creates the antibiotic in a
controlled environment setup by the laboratory to be harvested.
3) The substances derived from these microorganisms are then studied and modified to improve
their qualities and make them last longer.
The therapeutic function of ethambutol is best characterized as an...
A. Antifungal agent
B. Antiseptic for the urinary tract
C. Antituberculous agent
D. Antityphoid agent
E. Antiviral agent C. Antituberculous agent
Tuberculosis Treatments: "If you forget your TB drugs, you'll die and might need a PRIEST"
P: Pyrazinamide
R: Rifampin
I: Isoniazid (INH)
E: Ethambutol
ST: Streptomycin
The mechanism of action for the tetracycline family of drugs relates to the inhibition of...
A. Cell lysis
B. Cell wall synthesis
C. DNA/RNA synthesis
D. Protein synthesis D. Protein synthesis
A. Clortetracycline
B. Doxycycline
C. Tetracycline
D. Oxytetracycline B. Doxycycline
1) Concept: Doxycycline has the longest half life of tetracycline group and is used
prophylactically and therapeutically
2) Doxyccline
a. used to prevent malaria, as well as to treat Lyme disease, Rocky Mountain spotted fever, and
acne
b. taking doxycycline with dairy antacids, calcium supplements, iron products, and laxatives
containing magnesium may decrease the effectiveness of the drug.
Which of the following medications is removed from the body primarily via secretion from the
renal tubules?
A. Ciprofloxicin
B. Penicillin-G
C. Streptomycin
D. Tetracycline B. Penicillin-G
3) Pen G will be excreted slower in neonates and babies with compromised kidney function.
Which of the following antibiotic agents if found in considerably lower concentrations in serum
than in crevicular fluid?
A. Metronidazole
B. Oxacillin
C. Penicillin
D. Tetracycline
E. Clindaycin D. Tetracycline
1) Concept: The most important feature of tetracycline is that it attains a higher level of
concentration in gingival crevicular fluid than in serum.
b. is a broad spectrum bacteriostatic antibiotic that functions by inhibiting protein synthesis
c. used to treat periodontal diseases caused by pathogen like Aggregatibacter
Actinomycetemcomitans and Porphyromonas gingival is because of the high concentration in
crevicular fluids
Penicillin derivatives can lead to which of following classes of hypersensitivity reactions?
A. Type IV only
B. Types I, II, III, and IV
C. Types I, II, and IV
D. Type I only B. Types I, II, III, and IV
1) Concept:
A: Anaphlyaxis (Type I)
C: Cytotoxic-Mediated (Type II)
I: Immune-Complex Mediated (Type III)
D: Delayed Hypersensitivity (Type IV)
A: Anaphlyaxis
B: AntiBody Mediated
C: Immune Complex Mediated
D: Delayed Hypersensitivity
Which of the following erythromycin compounds is enterically coated and has prolonged action?
A. E.E.S
B. ERYC
C. Erythrocin
D. Liosone B. ERYC
1) Concept: ERYC capsules are enteric-coated erythromycin which is created for oral
administration
2) The enteric coating serves as a protective barrier of the erythromycin base against the
inactivating action of the gastric acids of the stomach.
3) The small size of the enteric coated capsules allows it to pass intact as it goes through the
stomach and into the intestines, allowing the erythromycin to be dissolved and absorbed in a
uniform manner.
The 1997 American Heart Association recommendations for prevention of bacterial endocarditis
suggest antibiotic premedication be used for which of the following dental procedures?
3) The orthodontic adjustments and placement rubber dams do not usually cause any significant
amount of bleeding in the process.
4) Local anesthetic injections which do not penetrate too deep into the mucosa would also not
cause significant amount of bleeding.
Nystatin (Mycostatin) is indicated to treat infections caused by which microbe?
A. Candida albicans
B. Porphrymonas gingivalis
C. Streptococcus mutans
D. Aggregatibacter actinomycetemcomitans A. Candida albicans
1) Concept: Nystatin
a. an anti fungal drug that is most effective against
infection caused by Candida species
b. very effective against candida albicans and is activated by binding to the cell membrane of
fungi and forming porosities which result in the leakage of K+ and eventually cell death.
2) Candida albicans
a. an opportunistic fungi that is considered as normal human flora specifically in the mouth, skin,
gastrointestinal and genitourinary tract. Candida albicans is opportunistic and can cause fungal
infections inimmunocompromised patients.
Crystallurea is less likely to occur with sulfonamide treatment if which of the following is used?
A. Coadministered probenecid
B. Concurrent ammonium chloride
C. Sulfonamide cocktail method
D. Coadministered corticosteroids C. Sulfonamide cocktail method
1) Concept: Adequate fluid intake may lessen the chances of urolithiasis while taking
Sulfonamids.
Sulfa Drugs
2) Clindamycin
a. prescribed to treat anaerobic bacterial infections and some protozoal diseases, such as malaria
and is also a common topical treatment for acne.
b. potency of oral clindamycin leads to widespread loss of normal gut flora, allowing
Clostridium difficult to take over the gut, causing pseudomembranous colitis.
c. may prolong the effects of neuromuscular-blocking drugs, such as succinylcholine.
Renal tubular secretion is the primary method of excretion for which of the following drugs?
A. Benzylpenicillin
B. Polymysin
C. Streptomycin
D. Tetracycline
E. Bacitracin A. Benzylpenicillin
1) Concept: Benzylpenicillin (Pen G) is the gold standard form of penicillin and is given
parenterally due to it being unstable in stomach acid.
3) Because Pen G is given parenterally higher tissue concentration of Pen G can be achieved than
is possible with Pen V.
4) Penicillin G is effective mainly against Gram (+) organisms and some Gram (-) organisms
such as Neisseria gonorrhoeae and Neisseria meningitides are also reported to be susceptible to
Pen G.
Pseudomonas infections indicate proscription of which of the following penicillins?
1) Concept: Pseudomonas are bacteria that most commonly cause nosocomial infections.
2) Carbenicillina nd Ticarcillin are two penicillin derived antibiotic drugs that are effective
against pseudomembranous and enterobacter infections.
3) Pseudomembranous easily multiply in the most uncommon places which include soaps, tubs,
sinks and stocked distilled water.
The fluoroquinolone antibiotic Ciprofloxacin (Cipro) is...
2) Pseudomonas aeruginosa
a. effectively treated by Ciprofloxacin because of its effectiveness against gram (-) organisms.
Endocrines/Immunosuppressants Endocrines/ Immunsuppressants Answers
Which of the following pharmaceuticals was the etiology agent in the remission in acute
leukemia in children?
A. Aminopterin
B. Carmustine
C. Mechlorethamine
D. Mercaptopurine
E. Streptozocin A. Aminopterin
1) Concept: Aminopterin is a 4-amino analog of folic acid that acts as an anti-neoplastic agent
with immunosuppressive properties.
2) Aminopterin
a. replaced by methotrexate due to its more favorable therapeutic index
b. competes for the folate binding site of the enzyme dihydrofolate reductase, blocking
Tetrahydrofolate (THF) resulting in the depleting of nucleotide precursors and inhibition of
DNA, RNA, and protein synthesis
Corticosteroid therapy would be contraindicated for a patient suffering from which of the
following conditions?
A. Cardiovascular disease
B. Glomerular Nephritis
C. Megaloblastic Anemia
D. Peptic ulcers
E. Renalithiasis
F. Alcoholism D. Peptic ulcers
A. Hepatotoxicity
B. Hypotension
C. Thromboembolic disorders
D. Uterine neoplasia
E. Clitoral enlargement C. Thromboembolic disorders
2) The activity of fibrinogen and coagulation factors VII, VIII, and X are increased due to the
increase in the blood levels of estrogen and progesterone.
4) Thrombus formation may block blood flow and result in severe debilitating conditions like
myocardial infarction and strokes.
A 53 year old male presents for a full mouth extraction and admits taking 10mg oral prednisone
daily to control his ulcerative colitis. After consoling with the prescribing physician, which is the
most likely course of action?
A. Ask the patient to continue taking the prednisone and consider temporarily increasing the
dose.
B. Decrease the patient's dose of prednisone by half to 5 mg on the day of surgery
C. Discontinue the patient's steroid therapy preoperatively
D. Send the patient for serum prednisone levels
E. Change the patient to another steroid for the week before the surgery A. Ask the patient to
continue taking the prednisone and consider temporarily increasing the dose.
1) Concept: Prednisone is an immunosuppresing steroid drug that can affect the health condition
of the patient during and after the surgical treatment.
2) Intake of corticosteroid drugs like prednisone should not be immediately terminated. The
patient should be advised by the physician to temporarily increase the dose he takes to help him
cope with the stress of surgery.
3) Sudden reduction or total absence of prednisone may induce a fatal crisis among patients who
take it regularly.
Which of the following is not a mechanism of action for oral diabetes drugs?
1) Concept: Oral diabetic drugs do not act as insulin analogues and do not bind to insulin
receptors
2) Sulfonureas and Meglitides stimulate insulin release from B cells in the pancreas.
3) Exenatie and Liraglutide, and Pramlintide, block glucagon release from the pancreas.
1) Concept: Morphine
a. is a very potent substance considered as the gold standard of opioid analgesics in alleviating
moderate to severe pain
b. is very useful in medicine because its analgesic property is used for managing pains caused by
myocardial infarction and labor.
2) Codeine
a. a less potent compared to morphine and is used to alleviate mild and moderate pain
Each of the following acts as a significant anti-inflammatory EXCEPT one. Which agent is the
EXCEPTION?
A. Acetaminophen
B. Acetylsalicylic acid
C. Cortisol
D. Ibuprofen
E. Ketorolac A. Acetaminophen
1) Concept: Acetaminophen
a. Acetaminophen or also known as paracetamol is an analgesic drug that also has antipyretic
property.
b. It is popularly used in relieving headaches, fever, and mild pains.
c. It also has an anti-inflammatory property but is weaker as compared with NSAIDs.
d. The antipyretic property of acetaminophen makes it very useful in controlling fever. Most of
flu and cold medications incorporate acetaminophen in their formulation for this reason.
e. Acetaminophen is also combined with opioid analgesics in managing post surgical and severe
types of pain.
2) NSAID
a. Aspirin and Ibuprofen are among the NSAIDs while cortisol is a steroid hormone that is
released by the adrenal cortex. They all provide significant anti-inflammatory effect.
Stimulation of which of the following is responsible for the feelings of nausea and vomiting
associated with opioid analgesic administration?
A. Ethyl alcohol
B. Methanol
C. Propylene glycol
D. Sodium metabisulfite
E. Benzoic acid C. Propylene glycol
A. Articaine (Septocaine)
B. Carbocaine (Polocaine)
C. Lidocaine (Xylocaine)
D. Procaine (Novocaine)
E. Benzocaine D. Procaine (Novocaine)
A. Ethylene oxide
B. Methane
C. Nitric oxide
D. Cyclohexane C. Nitric oxide
1) Concept: Oxycodone
a. is an opiate drug that is mainly used for pain control.
b. Prolonged use is NOT advised since it increases the tendency for drug dependence and
addiction to occur.
c. Oxycodone is an extended-relief drug that is typically indicated for patients suffering from
moderate, severe, and spontaneous pain because it stays long in the blood and provides relief
over a longer period of time.
d. The increased tendency of drug dependence with oxycodone use also increases the risk for
withdrawal syndrome if the drug intake is drastically stopped.
Which of the following patient conditions is the administration of opiates
CONTRAINDICATED?
A. Bronchial asthma
B. Myocardial infarction
C. Renal dysfunction
D. Severe cranial trauma
E. Allergy to meperidine D. Severe cranial trauma
1) Concept: Patients suffering severe cranial trauma are advised NOT to take opiates because of
the possible increase in intracranial pressure.
2) Opiates have the ability to significantly elevate the intracranial pressure which may cause each
of the following in cranial trauma patients:
A. Intracranial bleeding
B. Blood clot
C. Brain damage
D. Shifting of brain structures
E. Herniation of the brain
F. Impeded supply of blood to the brain
Blood dyscrasias are MOST COMMONLY caused by which of the following non steroidal anti-
inflammatory drugs (NSAIDs)?
A. Acetaminophen
B. Aspirin
C. Etotolac
D. Ibuprofen
E. Indomethacin
F. Ketorolac E. Indomethacin
1) Concept: Blood dyscrasias
a. Blood dyscrasias like leukopenia, aplastic anemia, and neutropenia are rarely caused by
NSAID but is sometimes caused by the use of indomethacin.
2) Indomethacin
a. Indomethacin is a drug that provides anti-inflammatory, antipyretic, and analgesic effect.
b. It is proven to be useful in managing conditions like chronic arthritis.
c. The use of Indomethacin is limited due to its ability to inhibit the aggregation of platelets.
d. Indomethacin inhibits the aggregation of platelets and could cause tendencies of increased
bleeding time. Therefore, utmost caution must be observed when indomethacin is used for
patients suffering with coagulation defect.
The preservative Methylparaben most likely demonstrates cross sensitivity with which of the
following agents?
1) Concept: Methylparaben
a. Methylparaben can sometimes induce a cross-sensitivity reaction with the esters of Para-
aminobenzoic acid (PABA ester).
b. The cross sensitivity reaction of PABA ester with methylparaben occurs because the hydroxyl
group of paraben is located in the para position which can eventually react with the para-amino
structure of PABA ester.
c. The para position of amino group in PABA ester is a free amino group on the benzene ring
that can react with the hydroxyl group of the paraben and cause the cross-sensitivty reaction.
Which of the following DOES NOT describe Tramadol (Ultram)?
2) Tramadol
a. is indicated as a pain reliever for moderate to severe pain
b. causes the release of serotonin and inhibition of norepinephrine reuptake mechanisms at the
same time
c. Tramadol and codeine are both metabolized in the liver following the same hepatic pathway
Which of the following opioid receptor subtypes is the primary receptor in the medication of the
supra spinal analgesic action during morphine administration?
A. Epsilon
B. Kappa
C. Mu
D. Sigma
E. Delta C. Mu
1) Concept: Delta, Kappa, and Mu are the three basic opioid receptors, each of which has a
different mode of action
3) Delta receptors
a. are responsible for spinal anesthesia.
M: Myosis
O: Out of it (sedation)
R: Respiratory Depression
P: Pneumonia (Aspiration)
H: Hypotension
I: Infrequency (constipation, urinary retention)
N: Nausea
E: Emesis
Which of the following clinical signs is NOT the characteristics of opioid overdose?
A. Comatose state
B. Dilated pupils
C. Pin-point pupils
D. Decreased respiration rate B. Dilated pupils
A. Carbocaine
B. Mepivacaine
C. Articaine
D. Cocaine
E. Lidocaine D. Cocaine
1) Concept: Cocaine
a. Cocaine causes an increase in the amount of norepinephrine in synapses by blocking the
reuptake of norepinephrine along the peripheral sympathetic nerve endings, resulting in an
increased in heart rate.
b. Cocaine can also cause an increased blood pressure level through increasing epinephrine
levels which induces a rapid heart rate and an increase in cardiac output.
c. Cocaine is also the only anesthetic drug that can induce vasoconstriction of blood vessels
which can also increase blood pressure.
Which of the following is most effective as a topical anesthetic?
A. Prilocaine
B. Bupivacaine
C. Lidocaine
D. Procaine
E. Articaine C. Lidocaine
1) Concept: Lidocaine
a. Lidocaine is proven to be an effective topical anesthetic drug that can effectively numb the
mucosal surfaces of the oral cavity.
b. It is a strong anesthetic drug usually delivered in gel, liquid, lotion, spray or cream form
c. Lidocaine topical anesthetic can penetrate approximately 2-3mm deep into the mucosal layer
when applied properly.
The concentration of which ion is most closely associated with an opioid agonist or antagonist's
binding affinity with the opioid receptor?
A. Chloride (Cl-)
B. Potassium (K+)
C. Sodium (Na+)
D. Calcium (Ca+2) C. Sodium (Na+)
1) Concept: Sodium ions regulate the binding affinity of opioid agonists and antagonists to
opioid receptors
2) The pharmacodynamic effects of opioids are dependent on their ability to inhibit the release of
neurotransmitters.
3) Opioids inhibit neurotransmitter release through:
a. Reducing entry of calcium ions into the nerve
b. Increasing the outward movement of potassium ions
c. Inhibiting adenylate cyclase.
A. 10mg
B. 15mg
C. 20mg
D. 30mg
E. 60mg
F. 7.5mg
G. 5mg D. 30mg
1) Concept: Tylenol is a proprietary name for the drug paracetamol/acetaminophen. Tylenol has
antipyretic and analgesic effects and is sold in several formulations containing codeine
1) Concept: Ketorolac
a. Ketorolac is an anti-inflammatory that can be administered through intravenous, intramuscular
and oral route.
b. Ketorolac is primarily used to relieve moderate levels of pain. It is usually used prescribed as
post-operative pain reliever or after any other painful procedures.
c. The administration of Ketorolac injection together with ketorolac tablets should not exceed or
go beyond 5 days to avoid the increased risk of experiencing severe adverse effects.
Antihistamine and Autocoids Antihistamine and Autocoids Answers
Xerostomia is most likely to occur after taking...
A. Chloral hydrate
B. Hydroxyzine
C. Phenobarbital
D. Diphenhydramine B. Hydroxyzine
2) Hyodroxyzine functions
a. act as a tranquilizer in dental procedures where the patient manifests uncontrolled anxiety and
tension
b. use can cause xerostomia or dry mouth due to its antimuscarinic effect.
Which of the following would be indicated as an effective and safe infiltrative local anesthetic
agent for a patient who is allergic to both amide and ester anesthetic derivatives?
A. Bupivacaine
B. Diphenhydramine
C. Ethylaminobenzoate
D. Nitrous oxide
E. Phenylephrine B. Diphenhydramine
2) Diphenhydramine
a. can be applied topically as an antipruritic and anesthetic drug.
b. its ability to provide local anesthesia is probably because of its chemical structure that is
similar to some of the known local anesthetic drugs.
Which of the following describes the way the effects of histamine is antagonized by epinephrine
administration?
1) Concept: The physiologic response of the body to epinephrine is the opposite to the effects of
histamine release.
2) Histamine release causes contraction of the smooth muscle of the lungs, bronchoconstriction,
swelling, difficulty breathing, and anaphylaxis
3) Adrenaline release or epinephrine administration produces bronchodilation, blood vessel
constriction, and an increase in cardiac output of the hurt.
4) Epinephrine is the best drug for managin anaphylaxis due to its ability to counteract the effects
that cause anaphylaxis.
A serious drug may occur involving the cardiovascular system of patient taking erythromycin
that may cause death in certain individuals. Which antihistamine drug is contraindicated for use
with erythromycin due to that interaction?
A. Chlorpheniramine
B. Diphenhydramine
C. Promethazine
D. Pseudophedrine
E. Terfenadine
F. Hydroxyzine E. Terfenadine
1) Concept: Terfenadine is a relatively safe antihistamine that may cause cardiac arrhythmias
with overdose.
2) Terfenadine
a. became popular because of its less sedating effect compared to other antihistamines
b. Erythromycin is a macrolide antibiotic able to inhibit the metabolism of terfenadine, making
overdose and cardiac arrhythmia more likely.
Static positional records can be utilized to adjust posterior articular controls. In order to set the
RIGHT condylar inclination and the RIGHT side-shift , which of the following are minimally
required for setting posterior controls?
1) Right lateral excursive record may be used as a guide in setting up the left condylar inclination
with an ARCON stimulator
2) left and right condylar inclinations are both important for copying the condylar movements of
the patient during excursive movements
3) jaw movement during the right lateral excursive movement allows for left side shifting to
occur. With these, the left condylar inclination can be determined
True/False: The long-term prognosis of a single-abutment cantilever fixed partial denture (FPD)
with a single abutment may have a compromised long term prognosis. The term prognosis may
be compromised because occlusal forces for multiple teeth are only accommodated by
periodontal structures when directed along the long axis of the single tooth. Both the
statement and the reason are correct and related
1) Residual wax
a. left surrounding denture teeth during processing, acrylic is not able to adequate flow around
the tooth to locket into place optimally, making it more like that the tooth will fall out
Which of the following is the most valuable aid in determining the psychological prognosis for a
complete denture patient?
1) Evaluation the appearance of a patient's dentures at present will provide an insight in how they
use their dentures
2) Examine the condition of the denture informs the dentist about the oral hygiene status of the
patient as well as their eating and chewing habits
3) Quality of dentures will also show how the patient maintains his set of denture teeth
The location of the maxillary anterior teeth of a complete denture will be most esthetic if based
off of which of the following anatomical landmarks?
1) Incisive papilla
a. stable landmark that does not change its position with the palate
b. used as a guide in placing and positioning of the maxillary anterior teeth during denture tooth
placement
c. incisive papilla is expected to be lingually positioned in between the maxillary central incisors
d. most labial surface of the maxillary central incisor denture tooth should be placed
approximately about 8-10mm anterior to the incisive papilla
Dentists usually send their metal and ceramic restorations to dental laboratories for fabrication.
The most common complaint of the technicians at the lab is:
1) important to set teeth denture teeth in a bilateral crossbite position in order to maintain the
normal occlusal harmony during mastication
2) arrangement of teeth and their intercuspation greatly affects the occlusion of teeth during
mastication
3) adjusting teeth out of their normal position in the arch could cause occlusal disharmony and
TMJ problems
4) arranging teeth following the normal occlusal relationship of upper and lower arch can help
achieve balance articulation and reduce the patient's difficulty of adjusting to a new set of
dentures
How far should the tray extend posteriorly when selecting an impression tray for a preliminary
maxillary impression?
2) vibrating line is a denture landmark that designates where the soft palate and hard palate join
and where the posterior palatal border of the denture should be placed
3) Extending beyond the vibrating line can cause the activation of the gag reflex when making
the impression
Why is it indicated that you dispense the liquid component of cement immediately before
commencing mixing?
1) liquid component of a cement is very volatile and dispensing it too early before mixing
commences will lead to evaporation of some of it, causing incomplete wetting of the cement
powder during spatulation
2) Having deficient liquid in proportion to cement powder results in a grainy consistency and
premature setting of the cement mixture
Each of the following is true about addition silicones (polyvinyl siloxanes) EXCEPT one. Which
one is this EXCEPTION?
A. They can be poured after 24 hours after being made and still remain accurate
B. They produce ethyl alcohol during their setting reaction
C. They remain accurate after the first pour
D. They can rebound from undercuts without permanent deformation B. They produce ethyl
alcohol during their setting reaction
1) Addition silicones
a. impression materials that remain accurate for several days even after the initial pour
b. can accurately pour the details of tooth preparations while displaying low dimensional change
once the material has set
2) Condensation silicones
a. release alcohol as by-product during the setting reaction
General Considerations General Considerations Answers
Which of the following is the best description of a Bennett angle?
A. It is the angle that is formed by the non-working condyle and the sagittal plane during lateral
movements
B. It is the difference in condylar inclination between protrusive and lateral movements
C. It is the difference between the condylar and incisal inclinations
D. It is the angle that is formed by the condyle and the horizontal plane during protrusive
movements A. It is the angle that is formed by the non-working condyle and the sagittal plane
during lateral movements
1) Bennett angle
a. The angle obtained after the non-working side condyle has moved anteriorly and medially
relative to the sagittal plane. The flatter the cusp the greater the side shift.
2) Bennet shift
a. The lateral movement of the mandible towards the working side during lateral excursions
3) Bennett movement
a. The left and right condylar motions caused by lateral movements of the mandible
Adding silver (Ag) to ceramo-metal alloy will...
1) Silver
a. Silver causes green discoloration of porcelain
b. PFM crowns incorporate silver to balance to increase thermal expansion coefficient to account
for the properties of Palladium
c. Silver balanced the red color of copper and gold in the metal alloy and decrease the melting
point.
d. New types of porcelain are color stable and not greened by incorporation of silver.
The physical property of cast gold to be burnished is...
A. Modulus of elasticity
B. Modulus of thermoplasticity
C. Percentage elongation
D. Compressive strength A. Modulus of elasticity
1) Concept: Gold has a relatively low modulus of elasticity meaning that it can easily be
deformed, shaped, and burnished using an adequately controlled force.
A. Ductile
B. Malleable
C. Resilient
D. Tough
E. Brittle E. Brittle
2) Sprue
a. conduit where molten metal may flow into the mold when the wax pattern is already gone
b. sprue formers should be attached to the bulkiest part of the wax pattern to ensure the smooth
flow of the alloy
c. diameter of the sprue former must be larger than the area of the wax pattern it is attached with
to minimize distortion of the thinnest portion of the wax pattern
d. The thinnest portion of the wax pattern must be found in the deepest part of the ring or farthest
from the sprue base to ensure that the margins of the wax pattern will not be insufficient when
contraction occurs.
Which term describes a material that possess a high compressive strength and low tensile
strength?
A. Brittle
B. Malleable
C. Resilient
D. Ductile A. Brittle
2) Ductile Materials
a. like wires are resistant to permanent deformation when exposed to tensile stress
3) Malleable Materials
a. are resistant to permanent deformation and are resilient to compressive stress
4) Resilience
a. amount of energy that a material has to absorb for the material to be deformed
Which of the following is the best method for evaluating centric occlusion on an onlay that was
just cemented?
A. Acylic monomer
B. Petroleum jelly
C. Water
D. Glycerin C. Water
1) Zinc-oxide eugenol (ZOE) sets through acid-base reaction that yields zinc eugenolate chelate
that can be accelerated by adding water.
A. Decreased accuracy
B. High stiffness
C. Long working time
D. Stick to teeth
E. Tear easily B. High stiffness
1) Concept: The main drawback of using polyether impression material is its high stiffness.
2) Polyethers
a. main drawback is high stiffness
b. Polyether impression material is difficult to remove sometimes compared to other elastomeric
materials.
c. Polyether is also more expensive than other impression materials except for addition silicones
d. Polyether impression material has adequate tear strength and can be poured multiple times
e. The hydrophilic nature of polyethers makes it worthy to use it in conditions where moisture
control cannot be achieved
PFM crowns with a high-noble base typically have the highest percentage of...
A. Chrome-Cobalt
B. Gold
C. Palladium
D. Platinum
E. Silver
F. Nickel B. Gold
1) Gold
a. High noble alloys contain a minimum of 60% noble metals with gold approximating 40% of
the noble metal content.
1) Concept: Flux
a. Flux functions in 3 ways during the soldering process
b It acts to dissolve oxides along he adjoining metal surface and become a protective barrier
against oxygen
c. Flux is a chemical agent responsible for preventing corrosion along the metals being soldered
during the soldering process. It helps in preventing the oxidation of metals.
d. Flux dissolves oxides and facilitates the wetting of the surface of the molten metal which
makes the metal joint stronger and more durable
Patients with natural dentition generate the most occlusal load during...
A. Mastication
B. Protrusion
C. Swallowing
D. Centric relation A. Mastication
1) Concept: During mastication, the natural teeth occlude against each other and generate most
occlusal load as they function to tear and grind food
2) Centric Relation
a. is a jaw position used as a stable guide in complete denture fabrication
b. is defined as the position of the mandible when the condyle is in its most anterior and superior
position
3) Protrusion
a. is the sliding motion of the mandible and it does not require heavy occlusal load
4) Swallowing
a. The force of occlusion between upper and lower arch during swallowing is less when
compared to the force of mastication.
Which of the following terms describes the length of a patient's face when the occlusion rims and
central bearing point are in contact while the mandible is in centric relation?
A. Freeway space
B. Interocclusal rest space
C. Leeway Space
D. Physiologic rest position
E. Vertical dimension of occlusion E. Vertical dimension of occlusion
The buccal cusp height should be kept low in order to provide proper protrusive disclusion.
Statement is correct but reasons in incorrect
1) Concept: Canine guidance allows the disclusion of posterior teeth during lateral protrusive and
excursive jaw movement
2) The buccal cusp height should not be altered because anterior and canine guided occlusions
should be adduced to provide proper protrusive disclusions on he posterior teeth
3) Anterior guidance encompasses the proper positioning of the anterior teeth in harmony with
the mandibular envelope of motion that allows proper disclusion of posterior teeth while lateral
excursive movement are performed.
When casting Chrome-Cobalt, how much shrinkage should you expect?
A. 1.6%
B. 1.8%
C. 2.2%
D. 2.6%
E. 1.2% C. 2.2%
1) Concept: Base metal alloys such as Chrome-Cobalt (Cr-Co) have a very high casting
temperatures, and prone to increased casting shrinkage.
2) CrCo alloy has a casting shrinkage of 2.2%
3) CrCo alloy has can be used as a denture framework, in all metal restorations, and in porcelain
fused to metal restorations.
4) Other base metal alloys used in dentistry include nickel-chromium-berrylium and nickel-
chromium alloys.
When casting gold, shrinkage porosity is associated with...
1) Concept: Shrinkage porosity is associated with the diameter of the sprue being used
2) Sprue
a. sprue is the channel that allows the molten alloy to reach the mold within the investing
material after the wax out procedure
b. too narrow of a sprue will prevent the smooth flow of the molten material into the mold,
allowing the molten alloy to harden without flowing into all areas of the mold, resulting in
shrinkage porosities
3) Placement of sprue
a. The placement of sprue is also important to proven shrinkage porosities. The sprue must be
placed ideally where the wax pattern has its greatest bulk at about 45 degrees perpendicular to
the flat surface of the wax pattern.
Which of the following records is the minimum requirement to set the left condylar inclination
and left side shift after the posterior controls have been set on an ARCON articulator?
1) The right lateral excursive record may be used as a guide in setting up the left condylar
inclination with an ARCON articulator
2) The left and right condylar inclinations are both important for copying the condylar movement
of the patient during excursive movements.
3) The jaw movement during the right lateral excursive movement allows for left side shifting to
occur. With these, the left condylar inclination can be determined.
Each of the following are characteristics of addition silicone (Polyvinyl siloxane) impressions
EXCEPT one. Which of the following is the EXCEPTION?
A. They can be poured after 24 hours after being made and still remain accurate
B. They produce ethyl alcohol during their setting reaction
C. They remain accurate after the first pour
D. They can rebound from undercuts without permanent deformation B. They produce ethyl
alcohol during their setting reaction
2) Condensation Silicones
a. Condensation silicones NOT addition silicones release alcohol as a by-product during their
setting reaction.
How far should an impression tray extend posteriorly when making a maxillary impression for
diagnostic casts?
1) Impression Trays
a. Ideally, impression trays should only extend beyond the vibrating line to provide coverage
beyond functional limit
2) Vibrating Line
a. is a denture landmark that designates where the soft palate and hard palate join and where the
posterior palatal border of the denture should be placed.
b. extending beyond the vibrating line can cause the activation of the gag reflex when making the
impression
Which of the following describes a property of a material to resist fracture under bending BEST?
A. Flexural Strength
B. Force/Load
C. Fracture Toughness
D. Strain
E. Stress A. Flexural Strength
1) Flexural Strength
a. can be BEST described as a property of a material which is critical in thin layers or sections
such as margins of a restoration
b. It is the ability of a material to resist fracture under bending.
c. The main significance of flexural strength in restorative dentistry is observed in Class V
cervical restorations
d. Cervical flexure in Class V preparations is the major reason for the failure of these
restorations.
Blade and root form dental implants are examples of which class of implants?
A. Endosseous
B. Glass
C. Subperiosteal
D. Transosteal A. Endosseous
1) Concept: Root form implants are the most popularly used end osseous implants today.
2) Endosseous Implants
a. placed directly into the bone and act as an anchor or root that will hold the crown, bridge or
implant-supported denture in place
3) Transosteal Implants
a. less likely to be used because of the complicated and very extensive surgical procedure that
the patient undergoes
4) Subperiosteal implants
a. Placement of subperiosteal implants is technique sensitive and is quite expensive
b. They are indicated for patient who want implants but have inadequate bone height and width
True/False
Light sources have an effect on the perception of color BECAUSE light sources must contain the
wavelength of color to be matched if the color is to be seen by the eye. Both statements are
True
1) Concept: For the perception of color through the light sources, these must contain matching
wavelength of the colors. It makes the color visible to the eye.
2) Metamerism
a. matching of apparent color of objects with different spectral power distributions
b. colors that match this way are called me tamers
What is the purpose of using a liner when casting gold with a casting ring?
2) Liners
a. allow investment expansion and prevents distortion of the wax pattern during investment,
b. act as a spacer that prevents pressure from building up between the investment material and
the casting ring during the expansion of the investment
c. are usually placed 3mm shorter than the casting ring and demonstrate a thickness of 1mm
Anterior occlusion is determined by...
1) Concept: Anterior occlusion is determine by both the horizontal and vertical overlap of
anterior teeth.
2) Overbite:
a. Vertical overlap of maxillary incisors over the mandibular incisor during maximum
intercuspation
b. Ranges from 3-5mm depending on tooth size and the occlusion type of the patient
3) Overjet
a. Horizontal overlap of maxillary incisors over the mandibular incisors during maximum
intercuspation
b. Ranges from 2-4mm depending on the type of skeletal facial profile and the occlusion type of
the patient
Which of the following properties of base alloys is lower than gold alloys in numerical value?
A. Fusion temperature
B. Hardness
C. Modulus of elasticity
D. Specific Gravity
E. Tensile Strength D. Specific Gravity
1) Concept: Density of pure substance and metal mixture are different since gold is heavier and
more dense than base-metal alloys
a. Specific Gravity: ratio between the density of one material against the density of another
material which is considered as a standard as their densities are weighed in air
2) The properties shown below are lower in numerical value compared to base alloys
a. tensile strength
b. hardness
c. fusion temperature
d. modulus of elasticity
Elastomeric impression material works best when the tooth preparation is...
2) Each material differs in their setting mechanism and their physical and chemical properties
3) Surface moisture is not good for elastomeric impression materials because the moisture
decreases the accuracy of the impression.
The pickling procedures involves heating a gold alloy restoration to redness then plunging it into
an acid bath that can lead to which of the following?
1) Concept: Dipping a red hot gold alloy restoration into an acid bath causes a sudden change in
temperature of the heated metal resulting in an unwanted warping of the restoration
2) The heating of gold alloy restoration until it is cherry red causes the metal molecules to
expand. During this phase the metal is easier to shape and contour.
3) If the reddish heated metal is suddenly soaked in an acid bath of different temperature, the
molecules will suddenly contract and this rapid cooling results to thermal shock.
4) In order to avoid warping of the restoration during pickling, it is best to let the metal cool
down a bit prior to plunging it to an acid bath. Adding to this, using a warm acid bath is also a
good way to lessen the difference of temperature between the hot metal and the acid bath
solution.
Backpressure porosity...
A. Can be diagnosed by rounded edges of the casting when they should be sharp
B. Describes the same phenomena as occluded gas porosity
C. Is caused by too large of sprue size
D. Is caused by excessive burnout A. Can be diagnosed by rounded edges of the casting when
they should be sharp
1) Concept: Back pressure porosity is suggested by the presence of rounded edge of the casting
instead of sharp and angled edges.
2) Rounded edges of the casting suggesting gas was still present within the area, so the material
could not flow in.
3) Too short of sprue is also a cause of back pressure porosity since inadequate length causes
incomplete venting of gas.
Wax patterns for cast restoration should be invested as soon as possible after they are completed
to minimize distortion caused by...
1) Concept: Wax patterns build up internal stress through with continuous heating, molding,
carving, and pressing.
2) Internal stress
a. introduced into the wax pattern during wax manipulation will slowly release their internal
tension and undergo relaxation after the wax cools down
3) Relaxation
a. results in distortion in the shape and contour of the wax, and may decrease the accuracy of fit
of the final restoration
Which of the following outcomes may result from a tray lacking occlusal stops that is to be used
for a polysulfide impression?
A. An inaccurate final impression due to distortion incurred during the removal of the impression
tray from the patient's mouth
B. An inaccurate final impression due to permanent distortion incurred during the setting
reaction
C. Increased setting time in the mouth before the tray can be removed
D. The clinician holding the ray during the entire time of the polymerization procedure A. An
inaccurate final impression due to distortion incurred during the removal of the impression tray
from the patient's mouth
1) Concept: Permanent distortion may occur in a final impression made with polysulfide
impression material if occlusal stops are not present in the tray.
2) Polysulfides require custom trays containing occlusal stops for the making of the impression.
1) Concept: Hemostasis should be achieved by placing a new retraction cord before the final
impression is made
2) Retraction cord
a. should be placed to ensure displacement of gingiva so the gingival margins of the preparation
can be recorded by the final impression
b. sulcular hemorrhage prevents the impression material from accurately recording the gingival
margin of the tooth preparation
Which of the following factors should a clinician give the greatest consideration when selecting
which dental base to utilize in a case?
A. It's biocompatibility
B. It's strength
C. The thickness of the remaining dentin
D. Which tooth is being restore C. The thickness of the remaining dentin
1) Concept: The thickness of the remaining layer of dentin that protects the pulp is the MOST
important thing to consider when selecting the type of base material because some materials can
cause pulpal irritation as it approximates the pulp.
2) Dental Bases
a. are used in order to provide pulpal protection specifically on teeth having deep cavities
b. may provide pulpal protection
c. provide thermal insulation
d. provide sedative effects which give the pulp enough time to recover
e. The strength of the material and its biocompatibility are also important things to consider
when choosing a dental base but they will only be considered after evaluating the thickness of
the remaining dentin.
Which of the following syringe-delivered impression materials is the most rigid and difficult to
remove from the mouth?
A. Condensation silicones
B. Polyether
C. Polysulfide
D. Reversible hydrocolloid
E. Addition Silicone (poly-vinyl siloxane) B. Polyether
1) Concept : Polyether
a. Polyether is a non-aqueous hydrophilic elastomeric impression material that is considered the
most rigid impression material
b. It is the stiffest among the elastomeric impression materials and will fracture when forcefully
removed when it is engaged in an undercut
c. It is a stable impression material and can be used in a moist environment since it is
hydrophilic.
When Gypsum-bonded casting investments are mixed thin, you should expect...
A. Decreased porosity
B. Decreased setting expansion
C. Decreased thermal expansion
D. Increased thermal expansion
E. Increased setting expansion B. Decreased setting expansion
3) As gypsum-bonded casting investment sets, crystals are formed from the nuclei of
crystallization, and continue to expand in an outward direction
4) Thick mix = setting expansion is increased due to the saturation of nuclei of crystallization
5) Thin mix = setting expansion is decreased since the nuclei of crystallization are less dense
When using an ARCON articulator, which of the following jaw-relation records should be
utilized to set both the medial and superior condylar guides?
A. Centric relation
B. Lateral interocclusal records
C. Maximum intercuspation
D. Protrusive interocclusal records B. Lateral interocclusal records
1) Concept: Lateral interocclusal records should be utilized in order to achieve both the medial
and superior condylar guides. The arcon articulator resembles the human anatomy correctly.
2) The arcon articulator contains the condylar element attached to the lower member and
condylar guidance attached to the upper member.
Group function is distinguished by having multiple of which of the following?
A. Ductility or malleability
B. Stiffness or rigidity
C. Tensile strength
D. Ultimate strength
E. Yield strength B. Stiffness or rigidity
1) Concept: Modulus of elasticity is the measure of stiffness or rigidity of a metal that describes
the tendency of a substance to undergo elastic or non-permanent deformation
2) A stiffer or rigid substance will have a higher elastic modulus and vice versa
A. Condensation impression materials expand as they absorb water from the air if left unpaired
B. Condensation polymers begin reacting with the impression tray, which may cause distortion
over time
C. Evaporation of volatile by-products result in shrinkage of the impression
D. The amount of polymerization is initially high then decreases with time, making the
impression less accurate C. Evaporation of volatile by-products result in shrinkage of the
impression
1) Concept: Condensation silicones produce volatile by-products (alcohols) after reacting which
are vaporized into air, leaving behind gaps in the impressions.
3) Shrinkage occurs in it and details are lost rendering the impression defective if the impression
is kept without pouring.
A. Elastic modulus - ability to sustain deformation without permanent change in size or shape
B. Flexural strength - measures the ability of a material to resist fracture under bending loads
C. Fracture toughness - ability to resist the propagation of a crack
D. Tensile strength - volume loss due to abrasion and opposing contact area D. Tensile
strength - volume loss due to abrasion and opposing contact area
2) Elastic modulus
a. ability to sustain deformation without permanent change in size or shape
3) Flexural strength
a. measure the ability of the material to resist fracture under bending loads
4) Fracture toughness
a. ability to resist the propagation of a crack
Increasing the proportion of water to Class IV gypsum die stone will most likely result in...
1) Concept: When the water concentration is increased in the mixture, the distance between
gypsum particles increase, thereby increasing the setting time.
2) The porosity in the final mixture and the gap in between the gypsum particles increases as
more water is added in the mix. This will result to a more soluble and weaker cast.
3) Increased expansion compromises stone strength because excess water makes the die stone
less dense and less compact.
Which of the following conditions makes it critical that the patient casts are mounted on the true
hinge axis?
1) Concept: Changing the vertical dimension of occlusion through fixed restorations require the
mountain of patient's cast in a true hinge position.
2) Determining the hinge axis is essential in constructing dental prostheses and correcting
occlusal interferences.
3) A true hinge axis is a line that passes through the left and right mandibular condyles and
coincides with the center of rotation of the mandible.
Complete Denture Prosthodontics Complete Denture Prosthodontics Answers
Which anatomical structure is used as a guideline to provide the most esthetic result for the
location of the maxillary anterior teeth in a complete denture?
1) Concept: The incisive papilla is a stable landmark that does not change its position within the
palate.
2) Incisive papilla
a. used as a guide in placing and positioning of the maxillary anterior teeth during denture tooth
replacement
b. is expected to be lingually positioned in between the maxillary central incisors
3) The most labial surface of the maxillary central incisor denture tooth should be placed
approximately about 8-10mm anterior to the incisive papilla
Which of the following characteristics a prominent disadvantage of immediate complete dentures
as a treatment option?
1) Concept: Immediate dentures are delivered immediately after the teeth are extracted, which
therefore gives NO ezra time for dentist and patient to have an anterior try-in.
2) Immediate dentures
a. are indicated for when anterior teeth are to be extracted and the patient still wants to appear
"normal" after the extraction
b. typically become loose and ill-fitting after a few weeks because the pre-extraction ridge is
very different from the totally-healed alveolar ridge a month later
3) The difference in the pre and post extraction ridge often necessitates that the immediate
dentures are either relined or sometimes remade.
Which of the following is associated with a flabby maxillary anterior ridge under a complete
denture?
1) Concept: Combination syndrome: is a condition that usually occurs when retained mandibular
anterior teeth opposes a maxillary complete denture
2) Combination Syndrome
a. anterior aspect of upper maxillary ridge becomes highly resorbed and flabby due to the biting
force against its natural tooth antagonist
3) Since the occlusal force of a natural tooth is stronger than the force of a denture supported by
an alveolar ridge, the area under pressure will exhibit higher resorption pattern than the rest of
the denture.
Which of the following 3 factors have an effect on the correct positioning of the lips of complete
denture patients? Select all that apply.
1) Concept: The anterior thickness of the denture flange and the position of the anterior teeth in
relation to the alveolar ridge greatly affects the lip profile of the patient.
2) Denture flanges
a. that are made too thick and too labially positioned cause the teeth to make the lips appear more
protruded, creating a convex lip profile.
b. that are made too thin, together with denture teeth positioned too far lingually will make the
lips appear unsupported, thin, and sunken. Unsupported lips typically make the patient appear
older.
3) Attaining the correct vertical dimension restores proper lip and facial profile by lifting
unsupported soft tissues up and brining the natural look of the face and lips back to when the
teeth were still present.
4) Decreased vertical dimension results in the formation of deep labiomental grooves and
deepening of the angles of the mouth
Which of the following factors is the most likely reason for a midline fracture of a denture that
has been used for many years?
1) Concept: Advanced resorption of the alveolar ridge causes the dentures to rock or move in a
seesaw motion using the palatal area of the denture as a fulcrum.
2) As the dentures move back and forth, the force of mastication creates stress along the midline
of the denture
3) Through time, the stress created along the midline of the ill fitting denture causes it to crack
then fracture completely
Accurate adaptation of anterior maxillary denture flange helps which of the following the
MOST?
A. Esthetics
B. Retention
C. Speech
D. Stability
E. Support A. Esthetics
1) Concept: Accurate adaptation of anterior maxillary denture flange improves esthetics the most
because it restores the facial profile and lip profile of the patient
2) When anterior denture flanges are made to accurately adapt to the labial ridge within the
functional limit, the profile of the lip may appear natural and wearing the dentures will cause less
bother to the patient.
3) Peripheral seal along the labial aspect is also achieved following accurate denture adaptation.
This promotes better retention and stability, as well as a decreased chance of food debris getting
stick between the denture and mucosa.
4) Speech is also improved when dentures fit perfectly since the patient doesn't feel any fear that
the denture may fall off while speaking.
Which of the following is indicated to correct a facial discrepancy where an edentulous patient
has a lower 1/3 of their face that is considered too short and a lack of vermillion border?
1) Unsupported lips and absence of vermilion border together with a relatively short lower 1/3 of
the face is indicative of an incorrect vertical dimension of occlusion.
2) Presence of labial commissure and deep labiomental groove are also indications of a short and
incorrect vertical dimension of occlusion.
3) Increasing the vertical dimension of occlusion can help achieve adequate lip support,
esthetically pleasing and properly proportioned facial profile and satisfactory phonetics.
4) Too high of a vertical dimension of occlusion may cause straining of the muscles of
mastication and facial pain.
Which suture technique is indicated for closure of an immediate denture case?
A. Continuous
B. Horizontal mattress
C. No use sutures because the immediate dentures acts as a stent
D. Vertical mattress
E. Interrupted E. Interrupted
1) Concept: Interrupted sutures are more stable and provide better adaptation of the wound edge
b. Interrupted sutures are placed individually
2) Continuous sutures
a. pose a greater possibility of coming loose under frictional and occlusal forces from the tissue
side of immediate dentures
b. if continuous sutures unwind and become loose, the stabilization of the wound is altered.
c. disturbing the closure of the wound could result in the reopening of the wound.
An 89 year-old patient, Adam, reports to you that he has not been wearing the mandibular partial
the dentist you bought your practice from made for him 20 years ago when his maxillary
complete denture was made because it bothered him. What is the finding you would most likely
make after examining Adam's mouth?
1) Concept: Combination syndrome (CS) is observed in patients with a maxilla complete denture
occluding against a Kennedy Class I partial denture (only anterior teeth remain).
2) The compressive force from the lower anterior teeth is transmitted by the tissue-borne upper
denture to the anterior maxillary residual ridge causing bone loss and replacement of the bone
with hypertrophic fibrous soft tissue.
A. A lot of extra resin being attached to the denture that will take a long time to trim
B. Higher porosity than normal
C. Incomplete picking up of anatomical details
D. The denture would have an increased VDO C. Incomplete picking up of anatomical
details
1) Concept: Packing and compressing acrylic during denture fabrication should be done in its
doughy stage.
2) Doughy stage
a. is the ideal for packing acrylic resin because it is the moment when acrylic is most packable
and workable
3) Rubbery stage
a. Rubbery stage of acrylic denotes the start of the setting when heat is released from the setting
acrylic
b. Rubbery acrylic also has a tendency to revet back to its original position regardless of the
forces applied to it during packing, resulting in incomplete packing
Dentists should include post palatal seals in complete maxillary dentures to compensate for
which of the following factors?
A. Errors in fabrication
B. Inaccuracy of the impression material
C. Polymerization and cooling shrinkage of the acrylic
D. Tissue displacement C. Polymerization and cooling shrinkage of the acrylic
1) Concept: Posterior palatal seals are crated and incorporated into a fabricated denture to
compensate for the shrinkage of acrylic after the processing of dentures.
2) Processed acrylic dentures exhibit polymerization shrinkage and cooling shrinkage which may
cause the denture to have a slight clearance from soft tissue contact.
4) Alternative method
a. Another method is to place IOWA wax along the area where the soft movable tissue meets the
hard palate and the body heat will melt the wax to create an impression of the area with extra
bulk
Which of the following is most important factor when evaluating how a patient will
psychologically adapt to a new set of complete dentures?
2) Examining the condition of a denture informs the dentist about the oral hygiene status of the
patient as well as their eating and chewing habits.
3) Quality of dentures will also show how the patient maintains his set of denture teeth.
Which of the following should a dentist consider when fabricating a set of complete dentures for
a patient with a knife-edge mandibular ridge that is chronically tender?
A. A broad occlusal table to provide firmer contact during eccentric jaw movements
B. Decreased vertical dimension of occlusion to decrease masticatory forces
C. Maximum extension of the denture distally to distribute the masticatory forces over a broader
area
D. Minimal distal extension of he denture to limit the amount of tender area covered by the
denture. C. Maximum extension of the denture distally to distribute the masticatory forces
over a broader area
1) Concept: Maximizing the denture coverage helps to balance the distribution of forces,
especially when the remaining alveolar ridges are already compromised.
2) Through maximizing the area covered by the denture bases, the forces of occlusion will be
carried by a larger area, thus reducing the stress along the knife-edge mandibular ridge.
3) Another way of reducing the stress load along the knife edge mandibular ridge is by utilizing
the selective pressure impression technique.
4) Through this impression technique, knife edge margins are relieved and the occlusal load is
transmitted to the solid cortical bone of the buccal shelves.
Which of the following factors regulate(s) the path of the condyles in mandibular movements
during denture fabrication?
1) The Concept: The path of the condyles in mandibular movements during the fabrication of a
denture is regulated by the following factors:
a. size and shape of the fossae
b. size and shape of the menisci
c. muscular influences and movements
Which of the following reasons describes why mandibular denture molars should NOT be placed
over the ascending portion of the ramus?
A. Teeth placed here would interfere with the contraction of the masseter muscle
B. The molars would interfere with the retromolar pad.
C. The occlusal forces over the inclined ramus would dislodge the mandibular denture
D. The teeth would encroach on the tongue space
E. The denture base terminates where the mandible ascends C. The occlusal forces over the
inclined ramus would dislodge the mandibular denture
1) Concept: As the ramus of the mandible ascends, it approximates the bulbous maxillary
tuberosity which makes the placement of denture teeth more difficult
2) Denture molar teeth will not occlude properly along the ascending ramus because of their
angulated position and stress from strong forces from the muscles of mastication.
3) Denture molar teeth are best positioned along the residual ridge before the ascending ramus
and retromolar pad.
In balanced complete denture occlusion, the Buccal cusps of maxillary posterior teeth on the
working side contacts which of the following areas of mandibular posterior teeth?
1) Concept: The lingual inclines of the maxillary posterior teeth on the non-working side
contacts the lingual inclines of the buccal cusps of mandibular posterior teeth.
2) Simultaneously, the buccal and lingual cusp of the maxillary posterior teeth on the working
side contacts their respective buccal and lingual mandibular cusp counterparts
3) Setting up denture teeth to achieve balanced articulation prevents the denture from being
dislodged or tipped off during masticatory function. The presence of contacts between the cusps
of maxillary and mandibular posterior denture teeth enables the denture to stay in balance during
mastication.
Increasing the vertical dimension of occlusion may incur which of the following adverse effects?
A. The closing muscles may become too relaxed and create wrinkles
B. The closing muscles may experience strain
C. The corners of the mouth may exhibit soreness
D. The opening muscles may become strained B. The closing muscles may experience
strain
1) Concept: Masticatory muscles will experience excessive strain on closing the mouth due to an
increased vertical dimension of occlusion.
2) This will adversely affect the muscular movements during eating, talking, and other functions.
4) Unnecessary increases in the vertical dimension of occlusion will cause stress and muscular
pain.
Excess height of the posterior palatal seal of a complete maxillary denture will usually result in
which of the following?
A. Gagging
B. Increased retention
C. Unseating of the denture
D. A tingling or tickling sensation C. Unseating of the denture
1) Concept: Overcontouring or excessive beading on the posterior palatal seal causes too much
pressure to be exerted on the palatal tissues resulting in the unseating of upper dentures
2) The posterior palatal seal is typically placed approximately on the vibrating line between the
hard and soft palate and proves a physiologically acceptable tissue pressure within the
compressible portion of the soft palate to attain retention and peripheral seal.
3) Over extending the coverage of seal will cause haggling and painful swallowing for the part of
the patient.
A patient presents to your office with dreams of having a removable partial denture fabricated.
The floor of the mouth is 6mm to the free gingival margin and the only mandibular teeth present
are the 6 mandibular anterior teeth with a diastema between each tooth. Which major connector
design is appropriate for this patient's case?
A. Kennedy bar
B. Lingual plate
C. Lingual plate with interruptions in the plate between the diastemas
D. Lingual bar C. Lingual plate with interruptions in the plate between the diastemas
1) Concept: Lingual plate major connector is the best option for patients with shallow lingual
vestibule.
2) Patients with a 6mm total vestibular depth with respect to the free gingival margins must be
restored with the lingual plate major connector.
3) The free gingival margin connector must be about 6mm away from a major connector. Since
this distance is not possible with a shallow vestibule, the placement of a lingual plate is
indicated.
4) Interruptions in major connectors are supposed to prevent plaque deposition and facilitate
cleaning.
The strict acrylic processing temperature guidelines during denture fabrication are meant to
ensure...
1) Concept: Heat cured acrylic must be processed slowly to prevent immediate vaporization of
the monomer
a. The boiling point of the monomer is 100.3oC
b. Polymerization of the acrylic occurs effectively at 70oC
c. Temperature may reach 100oC since conversions is an exothermic process
2) Longer curing allows for gradual polymerization gradually, so a smaller amount of monomer
is available for vaporization.
3) Short curing times requires large amount of monomer to account for vaporization due to
additional heat. Boiling off monomer causes porosities which render the denture less durable and
more prone to plaque accumulation.
An incorrect vertical dimension of occlusion causes patient to over close and exhibit a poor
facial profile. Which of the following should the clinician do to correct this?
A. DECREASE the vertical dimension of occlusion and INCREASE the interocclusal distance
B. DECREASE the vertical dimension of rest and DECREASE the interocclusal distance
C. DECREASE the vertical dimension of rest and INCREASE the interocclusal distance
D. INCREASE the vertical dimension of occlusion and INCREASE the interocclusal distance
D. INCREASE the vertical dimension of occlusion and INCREASE the interocclusal
distance
1) Concept: Increasing the vertical dimension of occlusion will result in the correction of facial
profile in this case. It will prevent them from over closing the mouth during normal occlusion.
3) Determination of the vertical dimension of occlusion is very important during the fabrication
of complete dentures.
1) Concept: Surgical reduction of the severely undercut tuberosity is indicated in this case.
2) Severe undercut present in the tuberosity presents serious problems for the placement of an
immediate denture.
3) The moderate undercut in the anterior region can be overlooked at this stage.
After packing acrylic resin into the denture flasks, one should wait to cure the resin to...
1) Concept: Allowing the dental flask to be packed with acrylic to remain under the bench press
until equilibrium in temperature is achieved will give enough time for the acrylic to achieve
better monomer-polymer interaction and create stronger chemical bond.
2) The curing of rain should be uniformly completed to lessen any chances of distortion before
and during the time the flask is immersed in a water bath.
Which of the following should be done to correct protrusive disclusion of posterior teeth during a
try-in appointment of balanced occlusion complete dentures?
1) Concept: Increasing the compensating curve (which includes the curves of Spee and Wilson)
help to establish a more balance occlusion during lateral excursive and protrusive movements.
2) Protrusive disclusion occurs when the denture teeth are set up without following the
compensating curve of the patient.
3) Compensating curves follow the anatomical positioning of the natural dentition accordion go
their relation to the condylar and incisal inclination.
4) Following the correct compensating curves will help reduce or eliminate the Christensen's
phenomenon observed when upper and lower incisors are in protrusive contacts due to improper
posterior tooth setups.
5) Increasing the incisal guidance causes deepening of the bite, and a wider protrusive disclusion
of posterior teeth.
6) Altering the condylar inclination and the use of flat plane cusps for posterior teeth does NOT
help to proven the Christensen phenomenon.
Which of the following speech sounds bring the maxilla and mandible in the closest proximity?
1) Concept: The "S" sound is created when there is very slight space in between the upper and
lower teeth where the air can escape and create a sibilant sound or a hissing sound.
2) "F" and "V" sounds can only be made when the air escapes out of the mouth while the upper
anterior teeth slowly closes down and touches the lower lip.
3) "T" and "Th" sounds are formed with the mouth slightly open and the tongue contacts with the
tip or lingual surface of the upper anterior teeth.
The coronoid process can do which of the following in edentulous patients?
1) Concept: The thickness of the denture flange in the maxillary buccal vestibule needs to be
reduced due to the presence of coronoid process of mandible.
2) This is required for the stability and retention of denture in edentulous maxilla.
1) Concept: During the border molding process, the tongue has to move and mimic its
physiologic function limits of the tongue.
2) Creating denture that follow the functional limit allows for normal movement of muscles
during function without causing denture dislodgment.
3) The palatoglossus muscle and mylohyoid muscle both help in elevating the tongue
1) Concept: Increasing the compensating curve (which includes the curves of Spee and Wilson)
help to establish a more balance occlusion during lateral excursive and protrusive movements.
2) Protrusive disclusion occurs when the denture teeth are set up without following the
compensating curve of the patient.
3) Compensating curves follow the anatomical positioning of the natural dentition accordion go
their relation to the condylar and incisal inclination.
4) Following the correct compensating curves will help reduce or eliminate the Christensen's
phenomenon observed when upper and lower incisors are in protrusive contacts due to improper
posterior tooth setups.
5) Increasing the incisal guidance causes deepening of the bite, and a wider protrusive disclusion
of posterior teeth.
6) Altering the condylar inclination and the use of flat plane cusps for posterior teeth does NOT
help to proven the Christensen phenomenon.
Which of the following muscles is the pterygomandibul raphe a tendon between?
1) Concept: Pterygomandibular rap he acts as a tendon between the buccinator and superior
constrictor muscle.
2) It is a landmark used often for the identification of the pterygomandibular space for the
administration of an inferior alveolar nerve block.
3) The injecting needle pierces the buccinator muscle to inject the local anesthetic solution in the
pterygomandibular space.
True/False:
The hamular notch is important to the fabrication of complete dentures BECAUSE it helps the
dentist position the maxillary posterior teeth.The statement is correct, but the reason is NOT.
1) Concept: The hamular notch helps in determining the distolateral border of the maxillary
denture
2) The arrangement of maxillary posterior teeth is NOT directly influenced by hamular notch. In
an ideal occlusion, the lingual cusps of maxillary posterior teeth are set-up pointing towards the
alveolar crest of lower arch.
1) Concept: Porcelain has no ability to bond to acrylic, so mechanical retention must be achieved
with use of pins and diatorics.
4) Mechanical retention is achieved when the pins and the diatorics become embedded in the
acrylic
6) Porcelain is very strong, so it may cause severe abrasion of the opposing dentition
Which of the following should a dentist do when making an impression of an edentulous patient
with hyper plastic and mobile tissue in their maxillary anterior region?
1) Concept: Hyperplastic and mobile tissues should be recorded in a passive position because
passive tissues are fully relaxed.
2) In their active position, tissues are contracted, and the resulting prosthesis will NOT be able to
compensate for when the tissue are in their relaxed state.
A denture that is fabricated with excessive vertical dimension of occlusion (VDO) may result
in...
A. Inefficient mastication
B. Sagging oral commisures
C. Trauma to supporting/underlying soft tissue
D. Perioral rhytides (wrinkles) C. Trauma to supporting/underlying soft tissue
1) Concept: excessive vertical dimension of occlusion (VDO) causes pain in the soft tissue under
the denture because excessive force is created during occlusion.
3) Perioral rhytides, sagging oral commisures and deep labiomental groove is an indication that
the vertical dimension of occlusion is insufficient.
Following a reline of a maxillary denture, the patient returned repeatedly with erythematous
areas on the crest of their alveolar ridge for adjustment. Which of the following is the most likely
reason for the need for repeated adjustments?
1) Concept: Loss of even contacts account for the need of repeated adjustments in the denture
when the mouth is in centric relation.
2) Erythematous areas result in high pressure spots making the denture uncomfortable for the
patient.
3) For comfortable seating of the denture, even contacts are desired in the centric relation.
4) Centric relation
a. is the mandibular jaw position in which the head of the condyle is situated as far anterior and
superior as it possibly can within the mandibular fossa/glenoid fossa and is the most retruded
position of the mandible.
Which of the following should be done to correct protrusive disclusion of posterior teeth during a
try-in appointment of balanced occlusion complete dentures?
1) Concept: Increasing the compensating curve (which includes the curves of Spee and Wilson)
help to establish a more balance occlusion during lateral excursive and protrusive movements.
2) Protrusive disclusion occurs when the denture teeth are set up without following the
compensating curve of the patient.
3) Compensating curves follow the anatomical positioning of the natural dentition accordion go
their relation to the condylar and incisal inclination.
4) Following the correct compensating curves will help reduce or eliminate the Christensen's
phenomenon observed when upper and lower incisors are in protrusive contacts due to improper
posterior tooth setups.
5) Increasing the incisal guidance causes deepening of the bite, and a wider protrusive disclusion
of posterior teeth.
6) Altering the condylar inclination and the use of flat plane cusps for posterior teeth does NOT
help to proven the Christensen phenomenon.
Excessive temperatures during acrylic processing may result in...
A. Discoloration of acrylic
B. Evaporation of acrylic monomer
C. Excessive expansion
D. Excessive shrinkage B. Evaporation of acrylic monomer
1) Concept: Excessive temperature during the acrylic processing will make the monomer boil,
causing it to evaporate, creating porosities.
2) Porosities created by monomer evaporation will make the acrylic denture base weaker in both
its chemical composition and physical durability
3) The end result is a poorly fabricated denture with voids and an inaccurate fit.
It was determined during the wax try-in appointment that the patient's denture teeth should be
adjusted to correct an improper centric occlusion. Which of the following should the clinician do
to accomplish this?
1) Concept: The best method for managing an incorrect centric occlusion of a denture is by
making a new centric relation record to serves as a guide of remounting the casts.
2) Using the new centric relation record as a guide, the artificial teeth should be repositioned and
re-articulated to achieve proper occlusion
Partial Denture Prosthodontics Partial Denture Prosthodontics Answers
Removable partial dentures frames made of base metals are resistant to tarnish and corrosion due
to it's
A. Malleability
B. Noble metal content
C. Surface oxide layer
D. Grain structure C. Surface oxide layer
1) When residual was is left surrounding denture teeth during processing, acrylic is not able to
adequately flow around the tooth to lock it into place optimally, making it more likely that the
tooth will fall out.
Where should the tip of the retentive clasp arm be placed?
A. At the junction of the middle and occlusal 1/3 of the clinical crown
D. At the junction of the gingival and middle 1/3 of the clinical crown D. At the junction of
the gingival and middle 1/3 of the clinical crown
1) Retentive clasp
a. placed at the junction of the cervical and middle 1/3 of the clinical crown where it can provide
retention
b. junction of the cervical and middle 1/3 of a tooth is usually the place where the desirable
natural tooth undercut is located
c. undercut is the location where only the retentive clasp should engage to avoid damaging the
tooth structure
Which of the following removable partial denture direct retainers is considered the most
esthetic?
A. Bar clasp
B. Circumferential clasp
C. Embrasure clasp
D. Intracoronal attachment
E. Round, wrought wire claspD. Intracoronal attachment
1) Intracoronal attachment
a. type of direct retainer that uses a precision attachment material that is built within the crown
portion of an abutment tooh
b. esthetically pleasing since they are NOT seen along the labial aspect of the patient (unlike
regular direct retainers)
c. ability to provide great retention due to their key and keyhole precision attachments
d. disadvantages
1) remaining abutment has to be prepared before it can be placed.
Which of the following factors commonly causes interferences for removable partial denture
major connectors?
2) Bony exostoses along the buccal surface, buccally tilted molars and premolars do not pose
problems in placement of major connectors since the major connector is in the palatal or lingual
position
Why is a lingual/cingulum rest preferred to an incisal rest on a maxillary canine for a removable
partial denture?
A. The force is more evenly distributed by the lingual/cingulum rest
B. The morphology of the canine cingulum is almost already in the shape of the rest
C. There is more enamel on the lingual surface, so it is considered a more conservative
preparation
D. The pulp is less irritated by a lingual/cingulum preparation A. The force is more evenly
distributed by the lingual/cingulum rest
1) Cingulum rest
a. maxillary canine rests are placed within the cingulum instead of the incisal because occlusal
force is more evenly distributed by the cingulum rest
b. more prominent, allowing them to distribute occlusal load better
c. more esthetically pleasing than incisal rests
d. stronger because they are closer to the major connector
e. forces transmitted to the cingulum rest is directed to the long axis of the tooth sine the rest is
centered on the tooth
Which of the following situations would a lingual plate be preferred over a lingual bar major
connector for a mandibular removable partial denture?
1) The space between the floor of the mouth and the marginal gingiva is the primary factor when
determining the type of major connector to be used for the lower arch.
2) Lingual bar major connector requires a minimum of 4mm in cervicoocclusal height and
should be approximately 6mm away form the marginal gingiva
3) Because of a very limited space, a lingual plate of adequate width is preferred over a lingual
bar.
Which of the following reasons explains why the tripod marks are made on casts after being
surveyed?
1) Tripod marks
a. are meant to keep a record of the casts in relation to the surveyor
b. made at three different places on the cast when it is placed on the surveyor
c. will guide the dentist or lab tech to place the cast back in the same relation once it has been
removed
2) Dental surveyor
a. instrument which is used to determine the relative parallelism of 2 or more surfaces of the
teeth or other parts of the cast of a dental arch
3) Surveyor
a. determine the path of insertion and removal of a removable partial denture
Acrylic teeth are used primarily in removable partial dentures because they are...
1) Acrylic teeth
a. are retained better than other denture teeth (porcelain and metal) because they are able to bond
to the acrylic resin of the denture base
b. NOT stain resistant and are NOT as color stable as porcelain teeth
A patient requires a reline of both their maxillary complete denture and their mandibular
Kennedy Class I removable partial denture (RPD). Which of the following describes the proper
method to complete these procedures?
1) Presence of teeth that support the mandibular partial denture make it more stable than a
loosely adapted complete maxillary denture whose support is determined by the palate and
reabsorbed alveolar ridge.
2) The remaining teeth help to establish correct vertical dimension during a reline procedure
since its form and position does not change (unlike the residual ridge).
3) When a mandibular RPD is placed correctly within its abutment teeth, the amount of ridge
resorption is easily determine and corrected.
Which of the following is the BEST way to record centric relation for a patient needing a
Kennedy Class I mandibular removable partial denture replacing the 2nd premolars and molars?
A. Manually articulate the casts and secure them with stick way
B. Place an occlusal rim on the framework and record the registration with soft wax
C. Utilize a plaster record of the interdigitation of teeth
D. Utilizing occlusal rims made on the master cast with soft wax to record the registration
E. Utilizing wax registration that covers the anterior teeth and premolars of the mandibular arch
B. Place an occlusal rim on the framework and record the registration with soft wax
1) Centric relation
a. best way to correctly record the centric relation in this case is to establish first the correct
vertical dimension of the patient before taking the centric record with a soft wax
b. centric relation record may vary depending on the established vertical dimension of the patient
c. by placing an occlusal rim on the framework, the vertical dimension of the patient is correctly
established and a correct centric relation may be recorded.
Tips of clasp arms are placed in undercuts for retention. This is because flexible arms are
required for reciprocation The statement is correct, but the reason is NOT.
A. Indirect retainers are not seated when the distal extension are depressed
B. Loss of retention
C. Soreness on the crest of the alveolar ridges
D. The acrylic resin teeth are abraded and there is a loss of the vertical dimension of occlusion
A. Indirect retainers are not seated when the distal extension are depressed
1) Indirect retainers
a. will NOT seat properly when the distal extensions are depressed due to the loss of support
along the distal alveolar ridge
b. presence of bone resorption causes instability to the removable partial denture
c. improper seating of indirect retainers indicates that there is already a noticeable amount of
bone loss along the residual bone underlying the distal extension base and that the denture has to
be relined
d. designed to provide stability, limit the tissue ward movement of the denture and prevent the
destructive anterior-posterior twisting of dentures during the function
e. act as a fulcrum when the distal extension based is no longer adapted to the residual ridge and
cause the instability and displacement of denture against forces acting on it.
Which of the following occlusion schemes would a patient with bilateral posterior crossbite will
most likely require their denture teeth set in?
A. Bilateral crossbite
B. Class I normal horizontal overlap
C. Class II occlusion
D. Unilateral crossbite A. Bilateral crossbite
1) Bilateral crossbite
a. important to set denture teeth in a bilateral crossbite position in order to maintain the normal
occlusal harmony during mastication
b. arrangement of teeth and their intercuspation greatly affect the occlusion of teeth during
mastication
c. adjusting teeth out of their normal position in the arch could cause occlusal disharmony and
TMJ problems
d. arranging teeth following the normal occlusal relationship of upper and lower arch can help
achieve balance articulation and reduce the patient's difficulty of adjusting to a new set of
dentures
The quantity of adjustment for base metal clasp arms on removable partial dentures (RPDs) is
limited by which of the following mechanical properties?
A. Elongation
B. Hardness
C. Malleability
D. Stiffness
E. Tensile Strength A. Elongation
1) Elongation
a. degree of elongation of metal limits the number of times a base metal clasp can be adjusted
before it breaks or fractures
b. elongation of metal is a property related to its ductility and tensile strength
c. base metal clasps are casted and designed to follow a particular form
d. during the casting process, the metal becomes hard and rigid
e. basemetal clasps are designed to be rigid and semi-rigid. The ductility of metal is limited and
therefore, elongation is also limited.
f. excessive adjustment of the clasp may cause it to be deformed beyond the correction or it may
fracture.
Fixed Prosthodontics Fixed Prosthodontics Answers
Each of the following patient situations is considered a contraindication for an all-ceramic crown
EXCEPT one. Which one is the EXCEPTION?
2) People who chew hard foods and brux severely will place the all-ceramic crown under strong
occlusal forces that may cause it to fracture or overly wear the opposing teeth.
3) Amalgam restorations
a. extensive and faulty amalgam restorations that are displayed or are not placed esthetically can
be better replaced with an all-ceramic crown
b. with marginal leakage and/or breakdown can be replaced in the core build-up for the PFM
crown
Which of the following factors is most common reason for porosities to be found in porcelain
restorations?
1) Concept: Inadequate condensation of porcelain allows for voids between particles, causing
porosities during sintering.
2) Controlled and gentle mechanical condensation of porcelain allows the particles to settle and
become closer, eliminating voids.
3) Surface tension condensation allows the drawing of the porcelain particles together by
draining the excess fluid from the mixture.
When preparing a partial veneer crown for tooth #8, the proximal grooves are placed parallel to
the...
1) Placement of the proximal grooves parallel to the incisal 2/3 of the facial surfaces ensure that
the partial veneer crown has only one path of insertion.
2) Proximal grooves and flares should be made continuous with the facial wall to provide
retention, resistance and structural durability.
3) Proximal grooves created in a proper way also relieves the tooth of unsupported enamel.
Which of the following dimensions is the recommend optimal incisal reduction for a porcelain
fused to metal crown preparation?
A. 1.5mm
B. 2.0mm
C. 2.5mm
D. 3.0mm
E. 1.0mm B. 2.0mm
1) Concept: The optimal incisal reduction for a porcelain fused to metal crown is 2mm.
2) The porcelain fused to metal crown requires a minimum of 1.5mm incisal reduction to provide
adequate thickness of metal and porcelain.
3) Porcelain thickness can be 1.2mm to 1.5mm thick, while the metal thickness should be at
about 0.5mm to 0.3mm minimally.
Most dentists utilize dental laboratories for the fabrication of porcelain fused to metal (PFM)
restorations. What is the most common difficulty experiences by the laboratories?
1) Position of the contact areas of the upper and lower arch are considered greatly prior to
designing the buccolingual width of hygienic pontiffs.
2) The buccolingual width of a hygienic pontic must be thick enough to withstand the occlusal
force exerted by the antagonist during mastication.
3) Narrowing the occlusal table of the pontic can lessen the force exerted by its antagonist.
What is the most common reason for a crown not to fully seat upon delivery?
A. Excessive proximal contacts
B. Over extended margins
C. Undercuts on the axial surfaces of the prepared tooth
D. Positives on the intaglio surface A. Excessive proximal contacts
2) The respective tooth preparations on the die casts are sawed to separate each component and
provide better visualization of the prep. Dental technicians may accidentally scrape a portion of
the contact area of the adjacent teeth causing a future excessive contact in the final crown
restoration.
Which of the following is orange stain used for?
2) Staining methods
a. used to change the monochromatic nature of porcelain veneers
3) The most common esthetic problem associated with porcelain veneers their lack of color
differentiation between the gingival and incisal portions of the restoration.
4) Staining methods are used to transform a monochromatic porcelain veneer into polychromatic
restoration restoring the beauty of natural tooth.
A 3-unit fixed partial denture (FPD) from tooth #28 to tooth #30 is treatment planned for a 75-
year-old patient. Tooth #30 is tipped 30 degrees mesially. The long-term prognosis for this FPD
would be most diminished by which of the following possible concerns?
1) Concept: A mesially tilted crown decreases the length of the distal axial wall and may increase
the risk of excessive tooth reduction on the mesial wall during the tooth preparation.
2) When preparing a 3-unit FPD to have a single path of insertion, the tilted tooth needs to be
prepared with the same path of insertion as the other abutment tooth, decreasing the distal wall in
the process.
3) A reduction in the height of abutment tooth will cause problems in crown retention and may
compromise the success of the FPD restoration.
Which of the following alterations would increase the strength of a soldered connector of a fixed
partial denture most?
1) Concept: Increasing connector heigh increases the strength of the connector due to the
cervicoocclusal reinforcement.
2) Connectors for PFM fixed partial dentures should demonstrate a minimum 3mm
cervicoocclusal height ideally to ensure adequate bulk and strength to resist the occlusal forces
without failure.
3) Increasing the gap in-between artificial teeth increases the stress on solder joint, thereby
weakening the connector.
A clinician plans to make an impression of a crown preparation after using an electrosurgery unit
to prepare the tissues. When used as intended, an electrosurgery unit will...
1) Concept: electrosurgery unit can remove a thin layer of crevicular gingival tissue required to
take an impression of the crown preparation
3) An electrosurgical unit can carry out sub gingival tissue preparation for impression taking
with fineness and delicacy.
When trying in a full gold fixed partial denture (FPD), you evaluate proximal contacts, Intaglio
fit, contour, surface finish, marginal adaptation, and occlusion. What should you do next?
A. Cement the FPD with temporary cement and reassess the fit
B. Fabricate a plaster soldering index
C. Polish the FPD with rouge
D. Mix glass ionomer cement A. Cement the FPD with temporary cement and reassess the fit
1) Concept: After evaluating the fit of a fixed partial denture (FPD), the next step is to
temporarily cement the FPD and reassess the occlusion, fit, and marginal adaptation.
2) Cementing the FPD with temporary cement allows for rechecking the overall bridge form and
its effect on the occlusion.
3) Temporarily cementing the FPD enables the dentist to practice the proper insertion since there
are two abutments to contend with.
Cantileverd fixed partial dentures (FPD) with a single abutment may have a compromised long
term prognosis. The prognosis may be compromised because occlusal forces for multiple teeth
are only accommodated by periodontal structures when directed along the long axis of the single
tooth. Both the statement and the reason are correct and related
A. Bi-directional concavity
B. Contact with the residual ridge
C. Faciolingual concavity
D. Mesiodistal convexity A. Bi-directional concavity
2) Pontics
a. should be designed in such a way that is appears similar to a natural tooth
b. must maintain proper height and tightness of contact areas between teeth and must be easy to
clean
What is the best reason for why the liquid component of a cement to be dispensed immediately
before mixing is commenced?
2) Having deficient liquid in proportion to cement powder results in a grainy consistency and
premature setting of the cement mixture.
Which of the following MOST ACCURATELY describes osseointegrated dental implants?
A. They are attached directly to living bone as determined by analysis by radiographs and light
microscopy.
D. They possess a direct structural and functional connection with bone only at the radiographic
level of detection A. They are attached directly to living bone as determined by analysis by
radiographs and light microscopy.
2) Osseointegration: the bone directly attaches to the implant material because the titanium
dioxide fuses with the surrounding bone.
b. no scar, fibrous or connective tissues get in between the bone and the implant material.
Osseointegration can be verified through microscopic and radiographic images as well as by
tapping the implant with a mirror and hearing a sharp metallic ring (not a dull thud).
The path of insertion of the key into the keyway should be parallel to the path of insertion of
which of the following objects when using a non-rigid connector for a fixed partial denture?
A. Both retainers
B. Neither retainer
C. The retainer NOT carrying the keyway
D. The retainer carrying the keyway C. The retainer NOT carrying the keyway
1) The path of insertion of the key portion of the non-rigid connector should always be parallel to
the retainer that is NOT carrying the keyway.
2) Use of a non-rigid connector is indicated for fixed partial dentures having tilted abutments or
teeth with different angulation and path of placement
3) Using non-rigid connectors in a fixed partial dentures relieves the tilted and upright abutments
from stress and strain of occlusal forces acting over the bridge restoration.
Which of the following is the BEST way to avoid porcelain failure in all-ceramic restorations?
A. Minimal occlusal forces
B. Porcelain is 3.5mm thick
C. Porcelain is not more than 0.5mm thick
D. Rounded angles of the preparationD. Rounded angles of the preparation
1) Concept: All-ceramic restorations should include rounded angles in the tooth preparation in
order to reduce stress concentration along these areas.
2) Sharp angles within tooth preparations are areas where stress is concentrated, and may cause
fracturing
3) Porcelain thickness
a. all-porcelain crowns should have a minimum thickness of 1mm circumferentially and about
1.5mm along the occlusal/incisal to achieve strength (Not including the framework of the
restoration.)
4) Proper case selection and occlusal load analysis is also an important factor in preventing
failure of an all ceramic restoration.
The most important reason zinc oxide eugenol cements are better than zinc phosphate cements
for crown delivery is because zinc oxide cements demonstrate...
1) Concept: Zinc oxide eugenol cement is a dental material capable of providing sedative effects
to the pulp
3) Zinc phosphate cement uses phosphoric acid for its chemical reaction and is irritating to the
pulp.
Which of the following is the MOST PROBABLE explanation for when the margins of a metal
framework for PFM crown are sealed during the framework try-in, then are NOT sealed after
porcelain is applied 2-days later?
1) Placement of over contoured proximal surfaces in a PFM crown results in premature contact
with the proximal surface of adjacent teeth, preventing the crown from being properly fitted.
2) Concept: Most over contoured crowns tend to have tight proximal contact but has open
margins. In order to correct this order, articulating paper may be used on the proximal contacts of
PFM crown during its placement to pinpoint and trim the premature contact.
3) Overcontouring of crowns during the placement of porcelain may be prevented if the proximal
surfaces adjacent to the tooth preparation is NOT trimmed or altered in the master cast.
Which of the following determines the parallelism of abutment preparation for a Fixed Partial
Denture (FPD)?
A. Amount of chamfer
B. Angulation of finish lines
C. Degree of convergence
D. Long axis of the preparations D. Long axis of the preparations
1) Concept: Long axis of the abutments should be prepared parallel to each other in order to
achieve the same path of insertion/displacement.
2) The abutments should ideally be prepared parallel to each other in order to prevent problems
in placement of the final crown restoration.
3) Degree of convergence does NOT determine parallelism of the abutments but rather, it
provides guidance in creating slightly converging parallel walls of individual tooth preparation
that is needed for the retention form.
4) Angulation of finish lines and amount of chamfer is NOT at all related to parallelism of
abutment teeth.
Which of the following locations are the initial interferences encountered when first seating a
cast restoration?
A. Axial walls
B. Margins
C. Occlusal surface
D. Proximal contacts D. Proximal contacts
1) Concept: Proximal contacts are where initial interferences occurs when seating a cast
restoration because these areas are usually over contoured.
2) Over countered proximal contacts are usually related to some errors in fabrication.
3) There are instances when laboratories tend to over contour the proximal in hope of achieving
tight proximal contacts.
4) A simple chip or a trim along the proximal surface of the tooth adjacent to the cavity
preparation on the master cast may provide significant change in the fabricated proximal contact
of a cast restoration.
5) Overcontoured proximal areas will result in premature contacts that will prevent proper
seating of the restoration.
Which of the following would be the result of a dentist placing a crown on tooth #11 that altered
the existing canine-guided occlusion in left-lateral excursive movement to a group function
occlusion scheme?
A. Decreased clearance on the right side and a greater possibility on a non-working contact
B. Increased clearance on the right side with less possibility for a non-working contact
C. No effect on the non-working side clearance A. Decreased clearance on the right side and
a greater possibility on a non-working contact
1) Concept: The decrease in clearance occurs due to the placement of the crown on the left upper
canine without restoring the canine guidance. Group function occlusion due to this crown will
decrease the vertical distance on the right side.
2) During lateral excursions, there is disocclusion of all the teeth except for the canine in canine
guided occlusion. In group function occlusion, multiple tooth contacts occur during lateral
excursion on the working side only.
What is the minimum amount of occlusal clearance necessary for a PFM crown?
A. 1.0mm
B. 1.5mm
C. 2.0mm
D. 2.5mm
E. 3.0mm
F. 0.5mm B. 1.5mm
1) Concept: The minimum occlusal clearance during tooth preparation for a PFM crown also
corresponds to the combined thickness of porcelain and the metal coping.
3) The porcelain layer and the metal coping used in fabricating PFM crowns should account for
at least:
a. 0.5mm metal coping
b. 1.0mm porcelain
2) Fixed partial dentures carry occlusal load which is transmitted to its abutment teeth
3) If one of the abutments DO NOT show any degree of mobility as of an implant material, the
force exerted onto the natural abutment tooth will elicit a cantilevering effect to the implant,
breaking the cement seal.
4) Osseointegrated implants are directly attached to bone and therefore doesn't have a
periodontal ligament which provide a cushioning effect for natural teeth. This will increase the
torque forces between the abutment teeth.
5) The periodontal ligament of the natural tooth exhibit slight compression and cushion to
compensate for the occlusal load. However, this is NOT possible for the implant material.
What is the primary reason why dentists splint adjacent abutment teeth in a fixed partial denture?
1) Concept: Abutment teeth are included in a fixed partial dentures to provide retention and help
disperse the occlusal load placed on the restoration
3) Abutment teeth allows better distribution of the occlusal forces acting on all teeth and pontic
in the fixed partial denture
When soldering a fixed partial denture before porcelain application, the greatest risk of failure
is...
1) Concept: greatest risk of failure occurs if there is overheating of precious metal solder and
wire during the soldering process
2) Overheating
a. cause diffusion between solder and wire, and may also lead to recrystallization and grain
growth
b. a single-orifice oxygen gas/oxygen torch is usually used before soldering with the flame
focused only on the soldering site prevents overheating or unevenly heating the material.
3) Surface pitting, internal porosity, and other microstructure changes are caused by overheating
and all result in a weak joint.
4) High-fusing precious metal solder is necessary to maintain structural form and avoid melting
or distortion during the firing of porcelain for pre-ceramic soldering.
Radiographically, the size of the focal spot of the x-ray tube influences which of the following?
A. Definition
B. Density
C. Distortion A. Definition
1) Definition
a. Definition and detail of the radiographic image are influenced by the focal spot size
b. The smaller the size of the focal spot, the better is the detail, definition or sharpness of the
radiographic image created
c. The larger the size of the focal spot, the wider the coverage of the beam and more penumbra is
created in the radiograph. This results in an unclear demarcation of the image outline and an
increase in the blurriness of the image.
d. proper angulation of the beam and size of the cone of an x-ray machine affects the size of the
focal spot
Which of the following types of cells are the LEAST likely to die from exposure to radiation and
are the MOST radio resistant?
A. Erythroblasts
B. Granulocytes
C. Lymphocytes
D. Muscle cells
E. Epithelial cells D. Muscle cells
1) immature cells that are highly active or dividing rapidly are MORE sensitive to radiation than
mature cells
2) cells that are more radiosensitive while they are undergoing the late G1 phase up until the
early S-phase in the cell cyle
3) Cellular Radiosensitivity
a. Low
1) Muscle cells
2) Chondrocytes
3) Nerve cells
b. Moderate
1) Osteoblast
2) Fibroblast
3) Spermatids
4) Endothelial cells
c. High
1) Erythroblast
2) Lymphocyte
3) Granulocyte
4) Epithelial cells
5) Spermatozoid
The radiographic density of which of the following materials varies the MOST?
A. Amalgam
B. Composite
C. Gold
D. Soft tissue
E. Acrylic B. Composite
3) Acylic
a. typically does not possess any opaquers
b. totally radiolucent
4) Soft tissue
a. fairly radiolucent
Which of the following is the greatest risk for a patient who needs teeth #18 and 19 extracted
after receiving radiotherapy for cancer in their jaw 6 months ago?
1) Osteoradionecrosis
a. tooth extraction in patients who have previously received radiotherapy 6+ months ago may
pose greater risk for having osteoradionecrosis
b. may not manifest symptoms immediately during the radiotherapy but could manifest months
or years after the treatment
c. probability of osteoradionecrosis is higher with mandibular extractions because there is limited
source of blood compared to the maxilla
d. patients who had radiotherapy and poor oral hygiene are at higher risk for osteoradionecrosis
Which of the following interactions is responsible for the creating of Bremsstrahlung/Braking
radiation?
1) Bremsstrahlung radiation
a. created when high-speed electrons interact with the Tungsten nuclei at the target
b. fast-moving electron loses kinetic energy when it interacts with the nuclei, coverting the lost
kinetic energy into a photon
Incorrect horizontal angulation of the x-ray tube head while making posterior molar bite wings
will probably result in...
A. Elongation of teeth
B. Foreshortening of crowns
C. Foreshortening of roots
D. Overlapping of interproximals
E. Overexposure of film D. Overlapping of interproximals
1) Intensifying films
a. MUST be used with extraoral radiographic films in order to decrease the dose of radiation to
the patient
b. when used with x-ray films using emulsions, make them more sensitive to blue or green light
c. X-ray photons are converted to visible light photons when they strike the screen.
Which of the following does the term "latent period" describe in radiology. The time between...
1) Latent period
a. time period from the moment a person is initially exposed to radiation up to the moment when
the clinical symptoms begin to manifest
b. irradiated person may experience long term or short term effects varying in severity depending
on the amount of radiation a person has absorbed
2) Prodromal syndrome
a. symptoms that immediately manifests after exposure to any radiation
Which of the following materials is responsible for making gutta-percha radiopaque?
A. Barium salts
B. Silver
C. Titanium dioxide
D. Zinc oxide
E. Acrylic A. Barium salts
1) Gutta percha
a. rigid natural latex that is
1) inert
2) biocompatible
3) radiolucent materials used to obturate root canals
2) Barium salts
a. added to the gutta-percha to add radiopacity to the material so it can be visualized
radiographically
Which of the following describes the etiology of cone-cutting?
A. Excessive kVp
B. Inadequate exposure time
C. Incorrect placement of X-ray machine
D. Incorrect source-object distance
E. Excessive mA C. Incorrect placement of X-ray machine
1) Cone cutting
a. occurs when x-ray machine is not lined up properly with the X-ray sensor or film
2) Correct position
a. film or sensor should be placed perpendicular to the X-ray collimator to ensure that all of the
necessary information is picked up
A dentist makes a radiograph of a patient's 3rd molar at 0o vertical angulation that looks like the
superior border of the mandibular canal contacts the apices of the tooth. The dentist then makes
another radiograph at a -20 vertical angulation that suggest that the mandibular canal is separated
from the apices of the 3rd molar by several millimeters. Using the information provided by these
2 radiographs, which of the following is true about the relation of the mandibular canal to the
root apices of the 3rd molar? The mandibular canal is...
1) When the tube head of the x-ray machine was tilted in a (-) vertical angulation, the mandibular
canal followed the position of the tube head and became more inferior to the apex of the 3rd
molar
2) SLOB rule
a. the anatomical structure that follows the position of the tube head is in the lingual position
while the other structure opposite the tube head is positioned toward the buccal
b. by angulating the tube head in a -2 vertical angulation, the more superiorly positioned
structure will move at the opposite direction of the tube head while the inferior anatomical
structure will move in a similar direction with the tube head
3) BOMM rule
a. stands for (buccal object moves most) when thinking about the 3rd molar roots
Osteoradionecrosis is more likely in patients who exhibit damage to which of the following?
A. Lymph vessels
B. Muscles
C. Nerves
D. Salivary glands
E. Blood vessels E. Blood vessels
1) Osteoradionecrosis
a. occurs in patients with damaged blood vessels because the blood needed for bone healing
CANNOT circulate properly to heal the wound
b. disrupts normal blood circulation within the bone, causing severe damage to the blood vessels
by endarteritis and thrombosis that eventually results in the blockage or obliteration of the blood
flow.
c. MORE LIKELY to occur in cases where bone exposed during radiation
d. oral mucosal tissues exhibit a more rapid turnover of cells than alveolar bone, making it more
affected by radiation
e. radiation causes free radical formation and immature development of cells that are supposedly
needed for the remodeling and healing of body tissues
A periapical radiographs suggest an opaque mass over the apex of the maxillary right 2nd molar.
A second periodical radiograph is made with the X-ray head adjusted in a more medial direction.
The second periodical suggests that the object in question has moved distally compared to the 1st
radiograph. Which of the following directions describes the location of the object?
A. Buccal to the tooth
B. In-between the roots
C. Not enough information is provided
D. Lingual to the tooth A. Buccal to the tooth
1) SLOB
a. Same Lingual Opposite Buccal rule suggest that the object is buccal to the tooth.
b. because the object moved opposite to the positioning of the X-ray device for the 2nd
radiograph it demonstrates buccal positioning
c. if the object move medially with the head of the X-ray head being moved medially, it would
have demonstrates lingual/palatal positioning
The anode of an X-ray machine is composed of which of the following materials?
B. Lead
C. Tin
D. Tungsten
F. Aluminum D. Tungsten
1) X-ray machines
a. have an anode made from Tungsten because it has a high atomic number and is highly
resistant to heat
2) Tungsten
a. has relatively high atomic number (74), which allows it to make relatively high energy x-rays
b. has the highest melting point of any metal, and because over 99% of the energy put into the x-
ray tube is turned into heat energy, the ability to dissipate the heat is critical.
3) Elements
a. Lead = used as a collimator to focus the beam
b. Aluminum = used as a filter to reduce the exposure of the patient by removing the low-energy
X-rays
c. Europium is often used in digital radiographic sensors
The recommend vertical angulation when making bite-wing radiographs of the posterior teeth
may vary from
1) Recommended angulation
a. for bite-wing radiographs usually ranges from +5 to +10 degrees because the upper and lower
portion of the film contacts the palate and the lingual of lower posterior teeth at a different angle
b. the upper part of the film is usually positioned at an angle of +20 degrees while it contacts the
palate and the lower part of the film is upright
Your patient works at the local nuclear power facility and comes into your office with a tooth
ache. Why does patient not need to wear his employee radiation film badge while the
radiographs are being made?
A. Milliamperate (mA)
B. Object-film distance (OFD)
C. Exposure time
D. Kilovoltage (kVp)
E. Source-film distance (SFD) * E. Source-film distance (SFD)
2) Increased kVp
a. increases the ability of the x-ray beams to penetrate into hard and soft tissues which decreases
radiographic density
3) Decreased mA
a. decreases the quantity of x-ray photons created which also decreases radiographic density
A. Balance Billing
B. Managed care
C. No answers apply
D. Payment differential
E. Prospective reimbursement A. Balance Billing
1) Balance Billing
a. describes when the dentist charges the patient the difference between what the insurance plan
pays and the usual customary rates (UCR)
2) Prospective reimbursement
a. pays the dentist before the treatment is provided
3) Managed Care
a. when a third party negotiates payments between providers and patients for services
Which of the following describes what lead is used for in X-ray machines?
A. Filtration
B. Heat dissipation
C. No answers apply
D. X-ray production
E. Collimation E. Collimation
1) Lead
a. used for collimation or shaping of the beam due to its ability to block x-ray photons going in
directions that are not needed
b. allows the clinician to keep the radiation dose as low as reasonable achievable (ALARA) since
excess radiation is booked before it reaches the patient.
2) Aluminum
a. used to filter out low-energy x-ray beams
Accidental radiation exposure is prevented by covering X-ray film with which of the following
materials?
A. Cardboad
B. Europium
C. Lead
D. No answer is correct
E. Plastic
F. Aluminum C. Lead
1) Lead
a. X-ray film manufacturers used lead foil to prevent film from being accidentally exposed to
radiation before it is used
Which of the following describes the indicated time to take the first bite-wing radiograph of a
child that appears clinically free of caries?
2) Periapicals
a. most commonly used for assessing the presence or absence of lesions around the apex of teeth
An adult patient presents to your practice with tooth pain. A complete mouth survey was made
less than a year ago and there is no evidence of caries or periodontal disease, what treatment is
indicated (according to United States and Drug radiological guidelines).
1) No radiographs must be taken if a patient has underwent a complete mouth survey less than
one year ago without suggestion of the presence of caries or periodontal disease.
3) Tooth pain
a. can be reversible condition like a hyperemic pulp
Which of the following materials appears most radiopaque in radiographs?
A. Composite
B. Enamel
C. Glass ionomer
D. Gold
E. Porcelain
F. Acrylic * D. Gold
1) Most radiopaque
a. gold
2) Radiolucent
a. acrylic and soft tissues
3) Composite resins
a. range from completely radiolucent to radiopaque
A 6-year-old patient presents for their first dental appointment in their life. The child's permanent
1st molars have started erupting and all primer teeth are present with no proximal contacts. No
clinical evidence of caries or pathology is evident. Which of the following radiographs are
recommended for this patient?
A. 2 bite-wings
B. 2 bite-wings and a pantomograph
C. 2 bite-wings, an occlusal, and a pantomograph
D. 4 periapicals, and 2 occlusal
E. Conebeam Computed Tomography (CBCT) * A. 2 bite-wings
Which of the following radiographic view will demonstrate lesions of the maxillary sinus BEST?
A. Pantomograph
B. Periapical
C. Towne's
D. Water's
E. Bitewing D. Water's
1) Maxillary sinus
a. evaluate best using the Waters view because it provides a larger image, better angle, and
exposure of the frontal and maxillary sinus
2) Pantomographs
a. provide a wide view of teeth and other structures of the head
b. CANNOT be used to completely evaluate the location and position of lesions within the
maxillary sinus because of the image overlap
Properties Properties Answers
In radiography, a longer gray scale of contest can be accomplished through
1) Concept: Longer gray scales of contrast can be achieved by increasing the kilovoltage peak.
2) Increasing the kilovoltage causes the radiographic image to have low contrast and longer gray
scales.
3) Low kilovoltage creates low energy x-rays responsible of producing high contrast and shorter
gray scale.
* High contest = black and white --> Short scale contrast = low kilovoltage
* Low contrast = gray shades --> Long scale contrast = high kilovoltage
The tissue most sensitive to radiation is...
A. Cartilagenous
B. Endothelial *
C. Hemopoietic *
D. Muscular
E. Neural C. Hemopoietic
1) Concept: Hemopoietic cells are sensitive to radiation because they are actively dividing and
undergoing several cellular processes to form many different cell types like red and white blood
cells and their derivatives.
2) Hemopoietic cells tie rise to several types of cells in the body including myeloid and lymphoid
cells.
3) Hemopoietic cells produce blood cell components through continuous cellular processes
which can be disrupted by ionizing radiation.
Which of the following is NOT caused by exposure to radiation?
A. Abscess *
B. Oseoradionecrosis
C. Xerostomia
D. Mucositis *A. Abscess
1) Concept: Abscess
a. are formed when dead neutrophils that reacted against bacterial infection accumulate within
tissue, so radiation has no means of causing abscess formation.
A. Filtration
B. Voltage
C. kVp
D. mA A. Filtration
C. kVp
1) Concept: The wavelength of the X-ray beam is affected by the kVp and amount of filtration of
the beam.
2) The kVp affects the amount of energy in the beam, and so affects the mean energy
(wavelength) of the beam.
3) The amount of filtration determines how much of the low-energy particles are removed from
the beam, so it affects the mean energy of the beam.
4) mA affects the number of X-ray photons that are produced, which has NO EFFECT on the
mean energy of the beam.
As a Crook's tube operates, electrons carry energy from the cathode to the anode. Which of the
following is most of this energy converted into at the target?
A. Electricity
B. Heat
C. Microwaves
D. X-rays
E. Magnetism B. Heat
1) Concept: As the electrons travel in a rapid motion to hit the target, the heat is created and
photons are also formed.
2) Approximately about 99% of these electrons are converted to heat as it hits the target.
3) Only about <1% of the electrons that hit the target are converted to photons.
Which of the following types of radiation poses the greatest danger to clinicians during
radiography procedures?
A. Alpha particles
B. Direct primary-beam
C. Gamma *
D. Secondary radiation and scatter * D. Secondary radiation and scatter *
1) Concept: Secondary and scatter radiations poses the greater danger to clinicians during the
radiography procedures and is the main source of occupational radiation exposure.
2) Even though a radiologic technologist is not in the path of the radiation beam, he/she is
susceptible to scatter radiation that mainly emanates from the patient.
3) Low-energy beams are more readily absorbed by the patient's protective equipment and
produce less scatter radiation. Oblique projections increase the kilovoltage peak and result in an
increase in scatter radiation exposure to the patient and staff.
The heat of the filament in a crooks tube determines the amount of electrons produced. Which of
the following does the quantity of electrons determine?
1) Concept: The quantity of x-rays in the beam depends on the quantity of electrons that the
filament releases after being heated.
2) The quality and quantity of X-ray depends on the number of electrons and the amount of
energy they release. The control over the x-rays produced is based on the kVp and mA of the X-
ray machine.
3) Crookes tubes are able to create free electrons through the ionization of the air present within
the tube with the use of a high voltage direct current.
4) The high voltage current excites and accelerates the electrons that originated from the cathode.
The excitation of electrons causes them to move rapidly, hit the anode and produce x-rays.
Increasing the mA on an X-ray unit increases...
1) Concept: Increasing the mA or milliamperage on the x-ray unit increases the number of
photons created.
2) Higher mA results in the production of higher amounts of radiation while lowering the mA
reduces the amount of x-rays produced.
3) The mA setting will set the amount of energy that will cause the filament to become hot. As
the filament gets hotter, more electrons are released. These electrons are later or converted to
photons to create a greater quantity of x-rays.
Which of the following is not on the electromagnetic spectrum?
A. Gamma x-rays
B. Infrared radiation
C. Microwaves Radiowaves
D. Visible light
E. X-rays
F. Alpha rays F. Alpha rays
1) Concept: Alpha rays are created from the energy released by the degradation or decay of alpha
particles and is not part of the electromagnetic spectrum.
4) Radio waves
a. carry and transmit information through antennas.
b. Radio waves are very helpful in the field of communication, entertainment, and data
transmission.
5) Microwaves
a. are useful in many industrial processes and is used at home for reheating foods
6) Visible Light
a. is commonly seen as the one emitted by the sun as a clear white light
A dose of 4Gray of X-ray radiation administered locally to a patient's hand would most likely
result in...
1) Concept: The excessive amount of x-ray exposure to the hand of a patient will result to
erythema or reddening of the skin.
2) Exposure to x-ray radiation beyond the allowable limit causes the top layer of the skin to
experience tissue damage that is almost comparable with the damage of suburb.
3) The damaged skin will elicit erythema and its effect may last for a few weeks.
The amount of penetration by X-ray beams is most likely associated with...
A. Exposure time
B. Kilovoltage (kVp)
C. Milliamperage (mA)
D. Focal film distance B. Kilovoltage (kVp)
1) Concept: The amount of Kilovoltage (kVp) used for the production of X-ray beam affects the
intensity and degree of penetration of the beam.
2) Increased amount of KVp will increase the energy of X-rays therefore increasing the degree of
penetration oft the beam.
3) Milliamperage on the other hand affects the number of X-ray photons produced. Increase in
mA increases the amount of x-rays produced.
4) Exposure time only affects the quality of the image produced in the film. It varies relatively as
kVp and mA is changed.
Which of the following is the term for pain that has no organic basis and is fixed in one anatomic
structure?
A. Phantom *
B. Pseudo *
C. Psychogenic
D. Referred
E. False A. Phantom
1) Concept: Phantom pain refers to the sensations and perceptions which are experience which
are experienced in the area of a specific limb or an organ that is no longer a part of the body.
2) Such sensations are commonly experience in areas of amputated leg or arms that have no
organic basis and are confined to a specific part of the body.
Which of the following is/are considered adverse effect(s) of being exposed to high amount of
X-radiation?
1) Concept: Excessive exposure to X-radiation may cause the creation of free radicals that may
damage DNA, causing genetic mutation and cancer growth.
3) Ionizing radiation does not really affect the DNA directly, it affects it through free radical
formation.
Which of the following aspects of the X-ray beam is affected by a chance in kVp?
A. No answers apply
B. Quality of X-ray photons only
C. Quantity and quality of X-ray photons
D. Quantity of X-ray photons only B. Quality of X-ray photons only
1) Concept: The amount of kilovoltage (kVp) used for the production of X-ray beam affects the
intensity and degree of penetration, or the quality of the beam.
2) Increased amount of kVp will increase the energy (quality) of X-rays therefore increasing the
degree of penetration of the beam.
3) Milliamperage on the other hand affects the quantity of X-ray photons produced. Increase in
milliamperage increases the amount of x-rays produced.
4) Exposure time only affects the quality of the image produced in the film. It varies inversely as
kVp and mA is changed.
Which of the following describes X-ray photons?
3) Radio waves, light, and infrared light are considered low-energy waves
4) Alpha particles, beta particles, and neutrons are considered particulate radiation.
Which of the following is the function of fixing solution?
1) Concept: Fixing solution (fixer) ensures that the image on the film is fixed permanently by
removing the silver halide crystals which were unexposed or underdeveloped and by preserving
the emulsion.
c. Activator = maintains the fixer's level of acidity and also neutralizes the developer (acetic
acid)
A. Dosimetry
B. Filtration *
C. No answers apply *
D. Collimation B. Filtration
1) Concept: The half-value layer is the thickness of a material (usually aluminum) that decreases
the intensity of the X-ray beam by 1/2.
2) The higher the half-value layer, the thicker the piece of aluminum needed to block the X-ray
beam.
3) Quarter-value layer is the amount of a material that reduces the beam intensity to 1/4 of the
value obtained without any test filters.